* gdb.texinfo (Continuing and Stepping): Document the new "fin"
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
66 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
67 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
88 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
89 @sp 2
90 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
91 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
92 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
93 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
94
95 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
96 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
97 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
98 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
99 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
100 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
101
102 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
103 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
104 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
105 @page
106 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
107 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
108 software in general. We will miss him.
109 @end titlepage
110 @page
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
120 @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Stack:: Examining the stack
137 * Source:: Examining source files
138 * Data:: Examining data
139 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146 * Altering:: Altering execution
147 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
153 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158
159 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
160
161 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
162 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
163 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
164 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
165 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
166 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
167 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
168 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
169 @value{GDBN}
170 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
171 how you can copy and share GDB
172 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
173 * Index:: Index
174 @end menu
175
176 @end ifnottex
177
178 @contents
179
180 @node Summary
181 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
182
183 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
184 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
185 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
186
187 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
188 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
189
190 @itemize @bullet
191 @item
192 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
193
194 @item
195 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
196
197 @item
198 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
199
200 @item
201 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
202 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
203 @end itemize
204
205 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
206 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
207 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
208
209 @cindex Modula-2
210 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
211 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
212
213 @cindex Pascal
214 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
215 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
216 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
217 syntax.
218
219 @cindex Fortran
220 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
221 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
222 underscore.
223
224 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
225 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
226
227 @menu
228 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
229 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
230 @end menu
231
232 @node Free Software
233 @unnumberedsec Free Software
234
235 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
236 General Public License
237 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
238 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
239 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
240 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
241 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
242 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
243
244 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
245 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
246 from anyone else.
247
248 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
249
250 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
251 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
252 include with the free software. Many of our most important
253 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
254 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
255 when an important free software package does not come with a free
256 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
257 gaps today.
258
259 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
260 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
261 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
262 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
263 them from the free software world.
264
265 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
266 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
267 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
268 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
269 contract to make it non-free.
270
271 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
272 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
273 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
274 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
275 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
276 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
277 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
278
279 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
280 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
281 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
282 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
283
284 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
285 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
286 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
287 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
288 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
289 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
290 community.
291
292 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
293 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
294 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
295 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
296 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
297 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
298 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
299 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
300 of the manual.
301
302 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
303 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
304 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
305 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
306 manual to replace it.
307
308 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
309 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
310 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
311 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
312 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
313 the free software community.
314
315 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
316 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
317 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
318 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
319 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
320 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
321 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
322 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
323 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
324
325 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
326 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
327 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
328 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
329 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
330 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
331 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
332 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
333
334 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
335 published by other publishers, at
336 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
337
338 @node Contributors
339 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
340
341 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
342 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
343 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
344 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
345 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
346 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
347 blow-by-blow account.
348
349 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
350
351 @quotation
352 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
353 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
354 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
355 @end quotation
356
357 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
358 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
359 releases:
360 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
361 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
362 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
363 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
364 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
365 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
366 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
367 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
368 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
369
370 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
371 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
372
373 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
374 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
375 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
376 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
377 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
378
379 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
380 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
381 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
382
383 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
384 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
385
386 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
387
388 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
389 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
390 support.
391 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
392 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
393 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
394 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
395 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
396 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
397 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
398 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
399 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
400 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
401 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
402 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
403 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
404 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
405 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
406 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
407
408 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
409
410 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
411 libraries.
412
413 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
414 about several machine instruction sets.
415
416 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
417 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
418 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
419 and RDI targets, respectively.
420
421 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
422 command-line editing and command history.
423
424 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
425 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
426
427 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
428 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
429 symbols.
430
431 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
432 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
433
434 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
435
436 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
437 processors.
438
439 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
440
441 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
442
443 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
444
445 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
446 watchpoints.
447
448 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
449
450 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
451
452 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
453 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
454
455 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
456 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
457 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
458 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
459 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
460 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
461 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
462
463 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
464 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
465
466 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
467 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
468 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
469 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
470 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
471 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
472 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
473 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
474 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
475 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
476 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
477 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
478 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
479 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
480 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
481
482 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
483 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
484
485 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
486 Hat.
487
488 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
489 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
490 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
491 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
492 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
493 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
494
495 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
496 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
497 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
498 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
499 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
500 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
501 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
502 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
503 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
504 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
505 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
506 Weigand.
507
508 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
509 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
510 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
511 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
512
513 @node Sample Session
514 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
515
516 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
517 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
518 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
519
520 @iftex
521 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
522 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
523 @end iftex
524
525 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
526 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
527
528 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
529 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
530 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
531 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
532 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
533 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
534 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
535 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
536 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
537
538 @smallexample
539 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
540 $ @b{./m4}
541 @b{define(foo,0000)}
542
543 @b{foo}
544 0000
545 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
546
547 @b{bar}
548 0000
549 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
550
551 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
552 @b{baz}
553 @b{Ctrl-d}
554 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
555 @end smallexample
556
557 @noindent
558 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
559
560 @smallexample
561 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
562 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
563 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
564 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
565 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
566 the conditions.
567 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
568 for details.
569
570 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
571 (@value{GDBP})
572 @end smallexample
573
574 @noindent
575 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
576 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
577 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
578 that examples fit in this manual.
579
580 @smallexample
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
586 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
587 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
588 @code{break} command.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
592 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
593 @end smallexample
594
595 @noindent
596 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
597 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
598 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
602 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
603 @b{define(foo,0000)}
604
605 @b{foo}
606 0000
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
611 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
612 context where it stops.
613
614 @smallexample
615 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
616
617 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:879
619 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
620 @end smallexample
621
622 @noindent
623 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
624 the next line of the current function.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
628 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
629 : nil,
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
634 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
635 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
636 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
637
638 @smallexample
639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
640 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
641 at input.c:530
642 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
647 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
648 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
649 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
650 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
651 stack frame for each active subroutine.
652
653 @smallexample
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
655 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
656 at input.c:530
657 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
658 at builtin.c:882
659 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
660 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
661 at macro.c:71
662 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
663 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
664 @end smallexample
665
666 @noindent
667 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
668 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
669 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
670
671 @smallexample
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
673 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
675 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
676 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
678 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
679 : xstrdup(rq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
686 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
687 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
688 (@code{print}) to see their values.
689
690 @smallexample
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
692 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
694 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
699 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
700 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
704 533 xfree(rquote);
705 534
706 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
707 : xstrdup (lq);
708 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
709 : xstrdup (rq);
710 537
711 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
712 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
713 540 @}
714 541
715 542 void
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
720 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
721
722 @smallexample
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
724 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726 540 @}
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
728 $3 = 9
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
730 $4 = 7
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
735 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
736 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
737 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
738 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
739 assignments.
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
743 $5 = 7
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
745 $6 = 9
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
750 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
751 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
752 example that caused trouble initially:
753
754 @smallexample
755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
756 Continuing.
757
758 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
759
760 baz
761 0000
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
766 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
767 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
768
769 @smallexample
770 @b{Ctrl-d}
771 Program exited normally.
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
776 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
777 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
778
779 @smallexample
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @node Invocation
784 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
785
786 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
787 The essentials are:
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
791 @item
792 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
793 @end itemize
794
795 @menu
796 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
797 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
798 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
799 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
800 @end menu
801
802 @node Invoking GDB
803 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
805 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
811 The command-line options described here are designed
812 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
813 options may effectively be unavailable.
814
815 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816 specifying an executable program:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 @noindent
823 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824 specified:
825
826 @smallexample
827 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831 to debug a running process:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
841 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
842 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
846
847 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849 option processing.
850 @smallexample
851 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852 @end smallexample
853 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
856 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
857 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} -silent
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867 @noindent
868 Type
869
870 @smallexample
871 @value{GDBP} -help
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880 @samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883 @menu
884 * File Options:: Choosing files
885 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
887 @end menu
888
889 @node File Options
890 @subsection Choosing Files
891
892 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
893 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
894 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
895 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
896 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
897 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
898 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
899 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
900 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
901 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
902 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
903 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
904 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
905
906 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
907 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
908 argument and ignore it.
909
910 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
911 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
912 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
913 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
914 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
915
916 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
917 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
918 @c it.
919
920 @table @code
921 @item -symbols @var{file}
922 @itemx -s @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--symbols}
924 @cindex @code{-s}
925 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
926
927 @item -exec @var{file}
928 @itemx -e @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--exec}
930 @cindex @code{-e}
931 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
932 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
933
934 @item -se @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--se}
936 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
937 file.
938
939 @item -core @var{file}
940 @itemx -c @var{file}
941 @cindex @code{--core}
942 @cindex @code{-c}
943 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
944
945 @item -pid @var{number}
946 @itemx -p @var{number}
947 @cindex @code{--pid}
948 @cindex @code{-p}
949 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
950
951 @item -command @var{file}
952 @itemx -x @var{file}
953 @cindex @code{--command}
954 @cindex @code{-x}
955 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
956 Files,, Command files}.
957
958 @item -eval-command @var{command}
959 @itemx -ex @var{command}
960 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
961 @cindex @code{-ex}
962 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
963
964 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
965 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
966
967 @smallexample
968 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
969 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
970 @end smallexample
971
972 @item -directory @var{directory}
973 @itemx -d @var{directory}
974 @cindex @code{--directory}
975 @cindex @code{-d}
976 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
977
978 @item -r
979 @itemx -readnow
980 @cindex @code{--readnow}
981 @cindex @code{-r}
982 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
983 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
984 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
985
986 @end table
987
988 @node Mode Options
989 @subsection Choosing Modes
990
991 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
992 batch mode or quiet mode.
993
994 @table @code
995 @item -nx
996 @itemx -n
997 @cindex @code{--nx}
998 @cindex @code{-n}
999 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1000 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1001 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1002 Files}.
1003
1004 @item -quiet
1005 @itemx -silent
1006 @itemx -q
1007 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1008 @cindex @code{--silent}
1009 @cindex @code{-q}
1010 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1011 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1012
1013 @item -batch
1014 @cindex @code{--batch}
1015 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1016 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1017 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1018 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1019 in the command files.
1020
1021 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1022 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1023 make this more useful, the message
1024
1025 @smallexample
1026 Program exited normally.
1027 @end smallexample
1028
1029 @noindent
1030 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1031 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1032 mode.
1033
1034 @item -batch-silent
1035 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1036 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1037 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1038 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1039 for an interactive session.
1040
1041 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1042 messages, for example.
1043
1044 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1045 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1046
1047 @item -return-child-result
1048 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1049 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1050 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1051
1052 @itemize @bullet
1053 @item
1054 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1055 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1056 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1057 @item
1058 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1059 @item
1060 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1061 the exit code will be -1.
1062 @end itemize
1063
1064 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1065 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1066 interface.
1067
1068 @item -nowindows
1069 @itemx -nw
1070 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1071 @cindex @code{-nw}
1072 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1073 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1074 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1075
1076 @item -windows
1077 @itemx -w
1078 @cindex @code{--windows}
1079 @cindex @code{-w}
1080 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1081 used if possible.
1082
1083 @item -cd @var{directory}
1084 @cindex @code{--cd}
1085 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1086 instead of the current directory.
1087
1088 @item -fullname
1089 @itemx -f
1090 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1091 @cindex @code{-f}
1092 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1093 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1094 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1095 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1096 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1097 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1098 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1099 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1100 frame.
1101
1102 @item -epoch
1103 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1104 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1105 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1106 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1107 separate window.
1108
1109 @item -annotate @var{level}
1110 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1111 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1112 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1113 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1114 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1115 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1116 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1117 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1118 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1119
1120 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1121 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1122
1123 @item --args
1124 @cindex @code{--args}
1125 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1126 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1127 This option stops option processing.
1128
1129 @item -baud @var{bps}
1130 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1131 @cindex @code{--baud}
1132 @cindex @code{-b}
1133 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1134 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1135
1136 @item -l @var{timeout}
1137 @cindex @code{-l}
1138 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1139 for remote debugging.
1140
1141 @item -tty @var{device}
1142 @itemx -t @var{device}
1143 @cindex @code{--tty}
1144 @cindex @code{-t}
1145 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1146 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1147
1148 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1149 @item -tui
1150 @cindex @code{--tui}
1151 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1152 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1153 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1154 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1155 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1156 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1157 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1158
1159 @c @item -xdb
1160 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1161 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1162 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1163 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1164 @c systems.
1165
1166 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1167 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1168 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1169 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1170 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1171 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1172
1173 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1174 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1175 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1176 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1177 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1178 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1179
1180 @item -write
1181 @cindex @code{--write}
1182 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1183 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1184 (@pxref{Patching}).
1185
1186 @item -statistics
1187 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1188 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1189 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1190
1191 @item -version
1192 @cindex @code{--version}
1193 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1194 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1195
1196 @end table
1197
1198 @node Startup
1199 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1200 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1201
1202 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1203
1204 @enumerate
1205 @item
1206 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1207 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1208
1209 @item
1210 @cindex init file
1211 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1212 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1213 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1214 that file.
1215
1216 @item
1217 Processes command line options and operands.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1221 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1222 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1223 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1224 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1225 @value{GDBN}.
1226
1227 @item
1228 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1229 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1230
1231 @item
1232 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1233 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1234 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1235 @end enumerate
1236
1237 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1238 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1239 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1240 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1241 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1242 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1243
1244 @cindex init file name
1245 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1246 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1247 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1248 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1249 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1250 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1251 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1252 the file to the standard name.
1253
1254
1255 @node Quitting GDB
1256 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1257 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1258 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1259
1260 @table @code
1261 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1262 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1263 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1264 @itemx q
1265 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1266 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1267 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1268 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1269 error code.
1270 @end table
1271
1272 @cindex interrupt
1273 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1274 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1275 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1276 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1277 until a time when it is safe.
1278
1279 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1280 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1281 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1282
1283 @node Shell Commands
1284 @section Shell Commands
1285
1286 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1287 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1288 just use the @code{shell} command.
1289
1290 @table @code
1291 @kindex shell
1292 @cindex shell escape
1293 @item shell @var{command string}
1294 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1295 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1296 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1297 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1298 @end table
1299
1300 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1301 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1302 @value{GDBN}:
1303
1304 @table @code
1305 @kindex make
1306 @cindex calling make
1307 @item make @var{make-args}
1308 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1309 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1310 @end table
1311
1312 @node Logging Output
1313 @section Logging Output
1314 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1315 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1316
1317 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1318 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1319
1320 @table @code
1321 @kindex set logging
1322 @item set logging on
1323 Enable logging.
1324 @item set logging off
1325 Disable logging.
1326 @cindex logging file name
1327 @item set logging file @var{file}
1328 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1329 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1330 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1331 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1332 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1333 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1334 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1335 @kindex show logging
1336 @item show logging
1337 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1338 @end table
1339
1340 @node Commands
1341 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1342
1343 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1344 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1345 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1346 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1347 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1348
1349 @menu
1350 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1351 * Completion:: Command completion
1352 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1353 @end menu
1354
1355 @node Command Syntax
1356 @section Command Syntax
1357
1358 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1359 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1360 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1361 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1362 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1363 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1364
1365 @cindex abbreviation
1366 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1367 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1368 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1369 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1370 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1371 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1372 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1373
1374 @cindex repeating commands
1375 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1376 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1377 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1378 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1379 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1380 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1381 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1382
1383 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1384 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1385 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1386
1387 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1388 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1389 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1390 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1391 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1392
1393 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1394 @cindex comment
1395 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1396 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1397 Files,,Command Files}).
1398
1399 @cindex repeating command sequences
1400 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1401 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1402 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1403 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1404 for editing.
1405
1406 @node Completion
1407 @section Command Completion
1408
1409 @cindex completion
1410 @cindex word completion
1411 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1412 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1413 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1414 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1415
1416 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1417 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1418 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1419 enter it). For example, if you type
1420
1421 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1422 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1423 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1424 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1425 @smallexample
1426 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1427 @end smallexample
1428
1429 @noindent
1430 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1431 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1432
1433 @smallexample
1434 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1435 @end smallexample
1436
1437 @noindent
1438 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1439 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1440 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1441 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1442 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1443 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1444
1445 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1446 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1447 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1448 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1449 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1450 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1451 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1452 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1453 example:
1454
1455 @smallexample
1456 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1457 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1458 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1459 make_abs_section make_function_type
1460 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1461 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1462 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1463 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1464 @end smallexample
1465
1466 @noindent
1467 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1468 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1469 command.
1470
1471 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1472 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1473 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1474 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1475 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1476
1477 @cindex quotes in commands
1478 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1479 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1480 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1481 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1482 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1483 @value{GDBN} commands.
1484
1485 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1486 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1487 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1488 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1489 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1490 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1491 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1492 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1493 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1494 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1495 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1496
1497 @smallexample
1498 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1499 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1500 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1501 @end smallexample
1502
1503 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1504 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1505 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1506 place:
1507
1508 @smallexample
1509 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1510 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1511 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1512 @end smallexample
1513
1514 @noindent
1515 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1516 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1517 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1518
1519 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1520 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1521 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1522 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1523
1524
1525 @node Help
1526 @section Getting Help
1527 @cindex online documentation
1528 @kindex help
1529
1530 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1531 using the command @code{help}.
1532
1533 @table @code
1534 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1535 @item help
1536 @itemx h
1537 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1538 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1539
1540 @smallexample
1541 (@value{GDBP}) help
1542 List of classes of commands:
1543
1544 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1545 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1546 data -- Examining data
1547 files -- Specifying and examining files
1548 internals -- Maintenance commands
1549 obscure -- Obscure features
1550 running -- Running the program
1551 stack -- Examining the stack
1552 status -- Status inquiries
1553 support -- Support facilities
1554 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1555 stopping the program
1556 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1557
1558 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1559 commands in that class.
1560 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1561 documentation.
1562 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1563 (@value{GDBP})
1564 @end smallexample
1565 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1566
1567 @item help @var{class}
1568 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1569 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1570 help display for the class @code{status}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1574 Status inquiries.
1575
1576 List of commands:
1577
1578 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1579 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1580 info -- Generic command for showing things
1581 about the program being debugged
1582 show -- Generic command for showing things
1583 about the debugger
1584
1585 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1586 documentation.
1587 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1588 (@value{GDBP})
1589 @end smallexample
1590
1591 @item help @var{command}
1592 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1593 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1594
1595 @kindex apropos
1596 @item apropos @var{args}
1597 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1598 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1599 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1600
1601 @smallexample
1602 apropos reload
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 results in:
1607
1608 @smallexample
1609 @c @group
1610 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1611 multiple times in one run
1612 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1613 multiple times in one run
1614 @c @end group
1615 @end smallexample
1616
1617 @kindex complete
1618 @item complete @var{args}
1619 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1620 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1621 command you want completed. For example:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 complete i
1625 @end smallexample
1626
1627 @noindent results in:
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 @group
1631 if
1632 ignore
1633 info
1634 inspect
1635 @end group
1636 @end smallexample
1637
1638 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1639 @end table
1640
1641 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1642 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1643 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1644 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1645 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1646 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1647
1648 @c @group
1649 @table @code
1650 @kindex info
1651 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1652 @item info
1653 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1654 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1655 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1656 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1657 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1658 @w{@code{help info}}.
1659
1660 @kindex set
1661 @item set
1662 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1663 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1664 @code{set prompt $}.
1665
1666 @kindex show
1667 @item show
1668 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1669 @value{GDBN} itself.
1670 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1671 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1672 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1673 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1674
1675 @kindex info set
1676 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1677 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1678 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1679 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1680 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1681 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1682 @end table
1683 @c @end group
1684
1685 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1686 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1687
1688 @table @code
1689 @kindex show version
1690 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1691 @item show version
1692 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1693 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1694 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1695 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1696 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1697 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1698 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1699 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1700 @value{GDBN}.
1701
1702 @kindex show copying
1703 @kindex info copying
1704 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1705 @item show copying
1706 @itemx info copying
1707 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1708
1709 @kindex show warranty
1710 @kindex info warranty
1711 @item show warranty
1712 @itemx info warranty
1713 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1714 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1715
1716 @end table
1717
1718 @node Running
1719 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1720
1721 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1722 debugging information when you compile it.
1723
1724 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1725 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1726 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1727 kill a child process.
1728
1729 @menu
1730 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1731 * Starting:: Starting your program
1732 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1733 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1734
1735 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1736 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1737 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1738 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1739
1740 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1741 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1742 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1743 @end menu
1744
1745 @node Compilation
1746 @section Compiling for Debugging
1747
1748 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1749 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1750 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1751 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1752 and addresses in the executable code.
1753
1754 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1755 the compiler.
1756
1757 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1758 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1759 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1760 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1761 executables containing debugging information.
1762
1763 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1764 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1765 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1766 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1767 in pushing your luck.
1768
1769 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1770 @cindex debugging optimized code
1771 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1772 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1773 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1774 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1775 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1776 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1777
1778 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1779 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1780 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1781 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1782 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1783
1784 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1785 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1786 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1787
1788 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1789 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1790 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1791 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1792 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1793 provides macro information if you specify the options
1794 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1795 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1796 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1797 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1798 @option{-g} alone.
1799
1800 @need 2000
1801 @node Starting
1802 @section Starting your Program
1803 @cindex starting
1804 @cindex running
1805
1806 @table @code
1807 @kindex run
1808 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1809 @item run
1810 @itemx r
1811 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1812 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1813 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1814 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1815 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1816
1817 @end table
1818
1819 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1820 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1821 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1822 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1823 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1824 message like this one:
1825
1826 @smallexample
1827 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1828 Try "help target" or "continue".
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent
1832 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1833 first (@pxref{load}).
1834
1835 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1836 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1837 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1838 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1839 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1840 divided into four categories:
1841
1842 @table @asis
1843 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1844 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1845 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1846 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1847 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1848 the arguments.
1849 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1850 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1851 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1852
1853 @item The @emph{environment.}
1854 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1855 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1856 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1857 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1858
1859 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1860 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1861 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1862 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1863
1864 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1865 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1866 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1867 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1868 set a different device for your program.
1869 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1870
1871 @cindex pipes
1872 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1873 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1874 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1875 wrong program.
1876 @end table
1877
1878 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1879 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1880 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1881 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1882 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1883
1884 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1885 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1886 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1887 your current breakpoints.
1888
1889 @table @code
1890 @kindex start
1891 @item start
1892 @cindex run to main procedure
1893 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1894 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1895 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1896 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1897 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1898 procedure, depending on the language used.
1899
1900 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1901 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1902 the @samp{run} command.
1903
1904 @cindex elaboration phase
1905 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1906 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1907 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1908 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1909 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1910 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1911 will remain to halt execution.
1912
1913 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1914 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1915 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1916 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1917 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1918
1919 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1920 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1921 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1922 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1923 elaboration code before running your program.
1924
1925 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1926 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1927 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1928 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1929 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1930 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1931 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1932 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1933 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1934 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1935 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1936
1937 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1938 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1939 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1940 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1941
1942 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1943 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1944 environment:
1945
1946 @smallexample
1947 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1948 (@value{GDBP}) run
1949 @end smallexample
1950
1951 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
1952 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
1953
1954 @end table
1955
1956 @node Arguments
1957 @section Your Program's Arguments
1958
1959 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1960 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1961 @code{run} command.
1962 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1963 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1964 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1965 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1966 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1967
1968 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1969 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1970 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1971 the program, not by the shell.
1972
1973 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1974 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1975
1976 @table @code
1977 @kindex set args
1978 @item set args
1979 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1980 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1981 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1982 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1983 it again without arguments.
1984
1985 @kindex show args
1986 @item show args
1987 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1988 @end table
1989
1990 @node Environment
1991 @section Your Program's Environment
1992
1993 @cindex environment (of your program)
1994 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1995 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1996 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1997 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1998 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1999 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2000 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2001
2002 @table @code
2003 @kindex path
2004 @item path @var{directory}
2005 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2006 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2007 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2008 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2009 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2010 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2011 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2012
2013 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2014 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2015 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2016 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2017 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2018 @var{directory} to the search path.
2019 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2020 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2021
2022 @kindex show paths
2023 @item show paths
2024 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2025 environment variable).
2026
2027 @kindex show environment
2028 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2029 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2030 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2031 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2032 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2033
2034 @kindex set environment
2035 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2036 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2037 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2038 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2039 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2040 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2041 null value.
2042 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2043 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2044
2045 For example, this command:
2046
2047 @smallexample
2048 set env USER = foo
2049 @end smallexample
2050
2051 @noindent
2052 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2053 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2054 are not actually required.)
2055
2056 @kindex unset environment
2057 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2058 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2059 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2060 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2061 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2062 @end table
2063
2064 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2065 the shell indicated
2066 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2067 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2068 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2069 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2070 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2071 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2072 @file{.profile}.
2073
2074 @node Working Directory
2075 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2076
2077 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2078 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2079 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2080 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2081 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2082 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2083
2084 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2085 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2086 Specify Files}.
2087
2088 @table @code
2089 @kindex cd
2090 @cindex change working directory
2091 @item cd @var{directory}
2092 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2093
2094 @kindex pwd
2095 @item pwd
2096 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2097 @end table
2098
2099 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2100 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2101 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2102 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2103 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2104 current working directory of the debuggee.
2105
2106 @node Input/Output
2107 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2108
2109 @cindex redirection
2110 @cindex i/o
2111 @cindex terminal
2112 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2113 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2114 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2115 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2116 running your program.
2117
2118 @table @code
2119 @kindex info terminal
2120 @item info terminal
2121 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2122 program is using.
2123 @end table
2124
2125 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2126 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2127
2128 @smallexample
2129 run > outfile
2130 @end smallexample
2131
2132 @noindent
2133 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2134
2135 @kindex tty
2136 @cindex controlling terminal
2137 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2138 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2139 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2140 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2141 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2142
2143 @smallexample
2144 tty /dev/ttyb
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 @noindent
2148 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2149 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2150 that as their controlling terminal.
2151
2152 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2153 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2154 terminal.
2155
2156 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2157 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2158 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2159 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2160
2161 @cindex inferior tty
2162 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2163 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2164 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2165 program.
2166
2167 @table @code
2168 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2169 @kindex set inferior-tty
2170 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2171
2172 @item show inferior-tty
2173 @kindex show inferior-tty
2174 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2175 @end table
2176
2177 @node Attach
2178 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2179 @kindex attach
2180 @cindex attach
2181
2182 @table @code
2183 @item attach @var{process-id}
2184 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2185 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2186 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2187 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2188 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2189
2190 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2191 executing the command.
2192 @end table
2193
2194 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2195 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2196 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2197 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2198
2199 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2200 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2201 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2202 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2203 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2204 Specify Files}.
2205
2206 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2207 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2208 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2209 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2210 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2211 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2212 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2213
2214 @table @code
2215 @kindex detach
2216 @item detach
2217 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2218 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2219 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2220 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2221 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2222 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2223 executing the command.
2224 @end table
2225
2226 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2227 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2228 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2229 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2230 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2231 Messages}).
2232
2233 @node Kill Process
2234 @section Killing the Child Process
2235
2236 @table @code
2237 @kindex kill
2238 @item kill
2239 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2240 @end table
2241
2242 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2243 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2244 is running.
2245
2246 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2247 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2248 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2249 outside the debugger.
2250
2251 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2252 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2253 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2254 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2255 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2256 breakpoint settings).
2257
2258 @node Threads
2259 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2260
2261 @cindex threads of execution
2262 @cindex multiple threads
2263 @cindex switching threads
2264 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2265 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2266 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2267 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2268 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2269 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2270 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2271
2272 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2273 programs:
2274
2275 @itemize @bullet
2276 @item automatic notification of new threads
2277 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2278 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2279 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2280 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2281 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2282 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2283 messages on thread start and exit.
2284 @end itemize
2285
2286 @quotation
2287 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2288 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2289 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2290 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2291 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2292 like this:
2293
2294 @smallexample
2295 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2296 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2297 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2298 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2299 @end smallexample
2300 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2301 @c doesn't support threads"?
2302 @end quotation
2303
2304 @cindex focus of debugging
2305 @cindex current thread
2306 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2307 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2308 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2309 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2310 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2311
2312 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2313 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2314 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2315 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2316 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2317 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2318 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2319 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2320 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2321 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2322
2323 @smallexample
2324 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2325 @end smallexample
2326
2327 @noindent
2328 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2329 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2330 further qualifier.
2331
2332 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2333 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2334 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2335 @c program?
2336 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2337 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2338 @c threads ab initio?
2339
2340 @cindex thread number
2341 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2342 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2343 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2344
2345 @table @code
2346 @kindex info threads
2347 @item info threads
2348 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2349 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2350
2351 @enumerate
2352 @item
2353 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2354
2355 @item
2356 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2357
2358 @item
2359 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2360 @end enumerate
2361
2362 @noindent
2363 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2364 indicates the current thread.
2365
2366 For example,
2367 @end table
2368 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2369
2370 @smallexample
2371 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2372 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2373 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2374 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2375 at threadtest.c:68
2376 @end smallexample
2377
2378 On HP-UX systems:
2379
2380 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2381 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2382 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2383 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2384 thread in your program.
2385
2386 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2387 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2388 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2389 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2390 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2391 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2392 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2393 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2394 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2395 HP-UX, you see
2396
2397 @smallexample
2398 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2399 @end smallexample
2400
2401 @noindent
2402 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2403
2404 @table @code
2405 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2406 @item info threads
2407 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2408 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2409
2410 @enumerate
2411 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2412
2413 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2414
2415 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2416 @end enumerate
2417
2418 @noindent
2419 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2420 indicates the current thread.
2421
2422 For example,
2423 @end table
2424 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2425
2426 @smallexample
2427 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2428 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2429 at quicksort.c:137
2430 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2431 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2432 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2433 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2434 @end smallexample
2435
2436 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2437 Solaris-specific command:
2438
2439 @table @code
2440 @item maint info sol-threads
2441 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2442 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2443 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2444 @end table
2445
2446 @table @code
2447 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2448 @item thread @var{threadno}
2449 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2450 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2451 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2452 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2453 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2454
2455 @smallexample
2456 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2457 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2458 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2459 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2460 @end smallexample
2461
2462 @noindent
2463 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2464 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2465 threads.
2466
2467 @kindex thread apply
2468 @cindex apply command to several threads
2469 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2470 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2471 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2472 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2473 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2474 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2475 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2476 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2477
2478 @kindex set print thread-events
2479 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2480 @item set print thread-events
2481 @itemx set print thread-events on
2482 @itemx set print thread-events off
2483 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2484 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2485 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2486 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2487 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2488
2489 @kindex show print thread-events
2490 @item show print thread-events
2491 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2492 have started and exited.
2493 @end table
2494
2495 @cindex automatic thread selection
2496 @cindex switching threads automatically
2497 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2498 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2499 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2500 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2501 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2502 thread.
2503
2504 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2505 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2506 programs with multiple threads.
2507
2508 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2509 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2510
2511 @node Processes
2512 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2513
2514 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2515 @cindex multiple processes
2516 @cindex processes, multiple
2517 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2518 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2519 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2520 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2521 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2522 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2523 will cause it to terminate.
2524
2525 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2526 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2527 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2528 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2529 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2530 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2531 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2532 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2533 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2534 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2535
2536 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2537 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2538 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2539 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2540
2541 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2542 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2543
2544 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2545 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2546
2547 @table @code
2548 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2549 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2550 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2551 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2552 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2553
2554 @table @code
2555 @item parent
2556 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2557 unimpeded. This is the default.
2558
2559 @item child
2560 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2561 unimpeded.
2562
2563 @end table
2564
2565 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2566 @item show follow-fork-mode
2567 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2568 @end table
2569
2570 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2571 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2572 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2573
2574 @table @code
2575 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2576 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2577 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2578 retain debugger control over them both.
2579
2580 @table @code
2581 @item on
2582 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2583 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2584 independently. This is the default.
2585
2586 @item off
2587 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2588 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2589 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2590 is held suspended.
2591
2592 @end table
2593
2594 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2595 @item show detach-on-fork
2596 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2597 @end table
2598
2599 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2600 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2601 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2602 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2603 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2604
2605 @table @code
2606 @kindex info forks
2607 @item info forks
2608 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2609 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2610 position (program counter) of the process.
2611
2612 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2613 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2614 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2615 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2616 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2617
2618 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2619 @item process @var{process-id}
2620 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2621 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2622 @samp{info forks}.
2623
2624 @end table
2625
2626 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2627 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2628 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2629 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2630
2631 @table @code
2632 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2633 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2634 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2635 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2636 allowed to run independently.
2637
2638 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2639 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2640 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2641 and remove it from the fork list.
2642
2643 @end table
2644
2645 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2646 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2647 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2648 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2649 the child process's @code{main}.
2650
2651 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2652 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2653
2654 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2655 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2656 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2657 argument.
2658
2659 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2660 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2661 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2662
2663 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2664 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2665
2666 @cindex checkpoint
2667 @cindex restart
2668 @cindex bookmark
2669 @cindex snapshot of a process
2670 @cindex rewind program state
2671
2672 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2673 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2674 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2675 later.
2676
2677 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2678 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2679 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2680 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2681 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2682
2683 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2684 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2685 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2686 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2687 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2688 start again from there.
2689
2690 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2691 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2692
2693 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2694
2695 @table @code
2696 @kindex checkpoint
2697 @item checkpoint
2698 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2699 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2700 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2701
2702 @kindex info checkpoints
2703 @item info checkpoints
2704 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2705 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2706 listed:
2707
2708 @table @code
2709 @item Checkpoint ID
2710 @item Process ID
2711 @item Code Address
2712 @item Source line, or label
2713 @end table
2714
2715 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2716 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2717 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2718 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2719 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2720 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2721 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2722
2723 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2724 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2725 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2726 the debugger.
2727
2728 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2729 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2730 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2731
2732 @end table
2733
2734 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2735 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2736 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2737 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2738 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2739 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2740 previously read data can be read again.
2741
2742 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2743 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2744 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2745 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2746 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2747 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2748
2749 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2750 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2751 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2752 different execution path this time.
2753
2754 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2755 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2756 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2757 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2758 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2759 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2760 potentially pose a problem.
2761
2762 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2763
2764 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2765 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2766 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2767 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2768 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2769 next.
2770
2771 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2772 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2773 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2774 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2775 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2776
2777 @node Stopping
2778 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2779
2780 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2781 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2782 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2783
2784 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2785 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2786 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2787 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2788 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2789 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2790 explicitly request this information at any time.
2791
2792 @table @code
2793 @kindex info program
2794 @item info program
2795 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2796 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2797 @end table
2798
2799 @menu
2800 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2801 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2802 * Signals:: Signals
2803 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2804 @end menu
2805
2806 @node Breakpoints
2807 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2808
2809 @cindex breakpoints
2810 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2811 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2812 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2813 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2814 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2815 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2816 program.
2817
2818 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2819 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2820 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2821 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2822 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2823 call).
2824
2825 @cindex watchpoints
2826 @cindex data breakpoints
2827 @cindex memory tracing
2828 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2829 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2830 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2831 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2832 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2833 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2834 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2835 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2836 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2837 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2838 same commands.
2839
2840 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2841 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2842 Automatic Display}.
2843
2844 @cindex catchpoints
2845 @cindex breakpoint on events
2846 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2847 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2848 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2849 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2850 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2851 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2852 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2853
2854 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2855 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2856 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2857 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2858 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2859 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2860 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2861 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2862 enable it again.
2863
2864 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2865 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2866 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2867 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2868 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2869 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2870 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2871
2872 @menu
2873 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2874 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2875 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2876 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2877 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2878 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2879 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2880 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2881 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2882 @end menu
2883
2884 @node Set Breaks
2885 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2886
2887 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2888 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2889 @c
2890 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2891
2892 @kindex break
2893 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2894 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2895 @cindex latest breakpoint
2896 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2897 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2898 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2899 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2900 convenience variables.
2901
2902 @table @code
2903 @item break @var{location}
2904 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
2905 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
2906 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
2907 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
2908 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
2909
2910 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2911 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2912 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
2913 that situation.
2914
2915 @item break
2916 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2917 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2918 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2919 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2920 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2921 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2922 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2923 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2924 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2925 inside loops.
2926
2927 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2928 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2929 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2930 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2931 existed when your program stopped.
2932
2933 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2934 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2935 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2936 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2937 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2938 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2939 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2940
2941 @kindex tbreak
2942 @item tbreak @var{args}
2943 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2944 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2945 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2946 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2947
2948 @kindex hbreak
2949 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2950 @item hbreak @var{args}
2951 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2952 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2953 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2954 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2955 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2956 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2957 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2958 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2959 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2960 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2961 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2962 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2963 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2964 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2965 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2966 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2967 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2968 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2969
2970 @kindex thbreak
2971 @item thbreak @var{args}
2972 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2973 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2974 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2975 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2976 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2977 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2978 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2979 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2980
2981 @kindex rbreak
2982 @cindex regular expression
2983 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2984 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2985 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2986 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2987 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2988 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2989 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2990 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2991 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2992
2993 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2994 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2995 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2996 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2997 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2998 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2999
3000 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3001 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3002 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3003 classes.
3004
3005 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3006 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3007 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3008
3009 @smallexample
3010 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3011 @end smallexample
3012
3013 @kindex info breakpoints
3014 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3015 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3016 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3017 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3018 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3019 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3020 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3021 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3022
3023 @table @emph
3024 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3025 @item Type
3026 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3027 @item Disposition
3028 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3029 @item Enabled or Disabled
3030 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3031 that are not enabled.
3032 @item Address
3033 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3034 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3035 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3036 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3037 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3038 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3039 @item What
3040 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3041 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3042 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3043 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3044 @end table
3045
3046 @noindent
3047 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3048 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3049 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3050 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3051 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3052 valid location.
3053
3054 @noindent
3055 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3056 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3057 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3058 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3059 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3060
3061 @noindent
3062 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3063 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3064 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3065 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3066 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3067 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3068 @end table
3069
3070 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3071 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3072 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3073 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3074
3075 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3076 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3077 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3078 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3079
3080 @itemize @bullet
3081 @item
3082 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3083 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3084
3085 @item
3086 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3087 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3088
3089 @item
3090 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3091 several places where that function is inlined.
3092 @end itemize
3093
3094 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3095 the relevant locations@footnote{
3096 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3097 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3098 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3099 info with line numbers for them.}.
3100
3101 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3102 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3103 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3104 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3105 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3106 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3107 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3108
3109 For example:
3110
3111 @smallexample
3112 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3113 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3114 stop only if i==1
3115 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3116 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3117 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3118 @end smallexample
3119
3120 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3121 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3122 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3123 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3124 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3125 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3126 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3127 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3128 that belong to that breakpoint.
3129
3130 @cindex pending breakpoints
3131 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3132 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3133 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3134 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3135 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3136 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3137 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3138 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3139 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3140 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3141 is not yet resolved.
3142
3143 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3144 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3145 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3146 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3147 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3148 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3149
3150 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3151 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3152 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3153 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3154
3155 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3156 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3157 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3158
3159 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3160 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3161 address specification to an address:
3162
3163 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3164 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3165 @table @code
3166 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3167 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3168 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3169
3170 @item set breakpoint pending on
3171 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3172 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3173
3174 @item set breakpoint pending off
3175 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3176 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3177 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3178
3179 @item show breakpoint pending
3180 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3181 @end table
3182
3183 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3184 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3185 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3186
3187 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3188 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3189 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3190 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3191 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3192 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3193 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3194 breakpoints.
3195
3196 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3197
3198 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3199 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3200 @table @code
3201 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3202 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3203 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3204 breakpoint must be used.
3205
3206 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3207 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3208 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3209 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3210 @end table
3211
3212 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3213 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3214 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3215 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3216 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3217 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3218 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3219 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3220 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3221
3222 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3223 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3224 @table @code
3225 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3226 This is the default behaviour. All breakpoints, including newly added
3227 by the user, are inserted in the target only when the target is
3228 resumed. All breakpoints are removed from the target when it stops.
3229
3230 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3231 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3232 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3233 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3234 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3235 @end table
3236
3237 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3238 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3239 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3240 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3241 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3242 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3243 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3244 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3245
3246
3247 @node Set Watchpoints
3248 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3249
3250 @cindex setting watchpoints
3251 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3252 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3253 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3254 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3255 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3256
3257 @itemize @bullet
3258 @item
3259 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3260
3261 @item
3262 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3263 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3264 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3265
3266 @item
3267 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3268 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3269 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3270 @end itemize
3271
3272 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3273 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3274 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3275 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3276 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3277 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3278 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3279 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3280 the expression changes.
3281
3282 @cindex software watchpoints
3283 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3284 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3285 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3286 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3287 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3288 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3289 culprit.)
3290
3291 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3292 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3293 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3294
3295 @table @code
3296 @kindex watch
3297 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3298 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3299 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3300 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3301 to watch the value of a single variable:
3302
3303 @smallexample
3304 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3305 @end smallexample
3306
3307 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3308 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3309 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3310 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3311 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3312 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3313
3314 @kindex rwatch
3315 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3316 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3317 by the program.
3318
3319 @kindex awatch
3320 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3321 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3322 or written into by the program.
3323
3324 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3325 @item info watchpoints
3326 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3327 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3328 @end table
3329
3330 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3331 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3332 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3333 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3334 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3335 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3336
3337 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3338 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3339 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3340 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3341 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3342 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3343 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3344 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3345
3346 @table @code
3347 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3348 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3349 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3350
3351 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3352 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3353 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3354 @end table
3355
3356 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3357 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3358 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3359
3360 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3361
3362 @smallexample
3363 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3364 @end smallexample
3365
3366 @noindent
3367 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3368
3369 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3370 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3371 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3372 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3373 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3374 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3375 will print a message like this:
3376
3377 @smallexample
3378 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3379 @end smallexample
3380
3381 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3382 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3383 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3384 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3385 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3386 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3387 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3388 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3389
3390 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3391 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3392 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3393 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3394 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3395 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3396
3397 @smallexample
3398 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3399 @end smallexample
3400
3401 @noindent
3402 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3403
3404 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3405 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3406 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3407 expression with separately allocated resources.
3408
3409 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3410 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3411 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3412
3413 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3414 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3415 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3416 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3417 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3418 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3419 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3420 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3421 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3422
3423 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3424 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3425 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3426 watched expression from every thread.
3427
3428 @quotation
3429 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3430 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3431 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3432 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3433 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3434 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3435 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3436 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3437 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3438 @end quotation
3439
3440 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3441
3442 @node Set Catchpoints
3443 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3444 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3445 @cindex exception handlers
3446 @cindex event handling
3447
3448 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3449 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3450 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3451
3452 @table @code
3453 @kindex catch
3454 @item catch @var{event}
3455 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3456 @table @code
3457 @item throw
3458 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3459 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3460
3461 @item catch
3462 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3463
3464 @item exception
3465 @cindex Ada exception catching
3466 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3467 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3468 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3469 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3470 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3471
3472 @item exception unhandled
3473 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3474
3475 @item assert
3476 A failed Ada assertion.
3477
3478 @item exec
3479 @cindex break on fork/exec
3480 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3481 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3482
3483 @item fork
3484 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3485 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3486
3487 @item vfork
3488 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3489 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3490
3491 @item load
3492 @itemx load @var{libname}
3493 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3494 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3495 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3496
3497 @item unload
3498 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3499 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3500 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3501 @end table
3502
3503 @item tcatch @var{event}
3504 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3505 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3506
3507 @end table
3508
3509 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3510
3511 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3512 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3513
3514 @itemize @bullet
3515 @item
3516 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3517 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3518 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3519 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3520 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3521 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3522 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3523 disabled within interactive calls.
3524
3525 @item
3526 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3527
3528 @item
3529 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3530 @end itemize
3531
3532 @cindex raise exceptions
3533 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3534 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3535 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3536 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3537 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3538 out where the exception was raised.
3539
3540 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3541 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3542 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3543 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3544
3545 @smallexample
3546 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3547 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3548 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3549 @end smallexample
3550
3551 @noindent
3552 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3553 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3554 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3555
3556 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3557 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3558 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3559 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3560 raised.
3561
3562
3563 @node Delete Breaks
3564 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3565
3566 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3567 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3568 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3569 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3570 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3571 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3572
3573 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3574 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3575 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3576 their breakpoint numbers.
3577
3578 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3579 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3580 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3581
3582 @table @code
3583 @kindex clear
3584 @item clear
3585 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3586 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3587 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3588 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3589
3590 @item clear @var{location}
3591 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3592 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3593 most useful ones are listed below:
3594
3595 @table @code
3596 @item clear @var{function}
3597 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3598 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3599
3600 @item clear @var{linenum}
3601 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3602 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3603 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3604 @end table
3605
3606 @cindex delete breakpoints
3607 @kindex delete
3608 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3609 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3610 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3611 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3612 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3613 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3614 @end table
3615
3616 @node Disabling
3617 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3618
3619 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3620 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3621 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3622 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3623 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3624
3625 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3626 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3627 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3628 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3629 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3630
3631 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3632 affects all of its locations.
3633
3634 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3635 states of enablement:
3636
3637 @itemize @bullet
3638 @item
3639 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3640 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3641 @item
3642 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3643 @item
3644 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3645 disabled.
3646 @item
3647 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3648 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3649 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3650 @end itemize
3651
3652 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3653 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3654
3655 @table @code
3656 @kindex disable
3657 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3658 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3659 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3660 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3661 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3662 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3663 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3664
3665 @kindex enable
3666 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3667 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3668 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3669
3670 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3671 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3672 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3673
3674 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3675 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3676 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3677 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3678 @end table
3679
3680 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3681 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3682 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3683 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3684 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3685 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3686 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3687 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3688 Stepping}.)
3689
3690 @node Conditions
3691 @subsection Break Conditions
3692 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3693 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3694
3695 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3696 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3697 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3698 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3699 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3700 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3701 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3702 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3703
3704 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3705 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3706 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3707 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3708 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3709
3710 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3711 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3712 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3713 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3714 one.
3715
3716 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3717 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3718 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3719 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3720 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3721 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3722 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3723 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3724 conditions for the
3725 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3726 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3727
3728 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3729 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3730 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3731 with the @code{condition} command.
3732
3733 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3734 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3735 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3736 catchpoint.
3737
3738 @table @code
3739 @kindex condition
3740 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3741 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3742 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3743 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3744 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3745 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3746 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3747 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3748 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3749 prints an error message:
3750
3751 @smallexample
3752 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3753 @end smallexample
3754
3755 @noindent
3756 @value{GDBN} does
3757 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3758 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3759 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3760
3761 @item condition @var{bnum}
3762 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3763 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3764 @end table
3765
3766 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3767 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3768 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3769 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3770 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3771 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3772 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3773 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3774 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3775 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3776 your program reaches it.
3777
3778 @table @code
3779 @kindex ignore
3780 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3781 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3782 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3783 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3784 takes no action.
3785
3786 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3787 a count of zero.
3788
3789 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3790 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3791 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3792 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3793
3794 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3795 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3796 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3797
3798 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3799 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3800 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3801 Variables}.
3802 @end table
3803
3804 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3805
3806
3807 @node Break Commands
3808 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3809
3810 @cindex breakpoint commands
3811 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3812 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3813 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3814 enable other breakpoints.
3815
3816 @table @code
3817 @kindex commands
3818 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3819 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3820 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3821 @itemx end
3822 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3823 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3824 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3825
3826 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3827 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3828
3829 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3830 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3831 recently encountered).
3832 @end table
3833
3834 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3835 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3836
3837 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3838 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3839 that resumes execution.
3840
3841 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3842 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3843 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3844 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3845 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3846
3847 @kindex silent
3848 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3849 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3850 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3851 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3852 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3853 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3854
3855 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3856 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3857 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3858
3859 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3860 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3861
3862 @smallexample
3863 break foo if x>0
3864 commands
3865 silent
3866 printf "x is %d\n",x
3867 cont
3868 end
3869 @end smallexample
3870
3871 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3872 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3873 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3874 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3875 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3876 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3877 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3878
3879 @smallexample
3880 break 403
3881 commands
3882 silent
3883 set x = y + 4
3884 cont
3885 end
3886 @end smallexample
3887
3888 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3889 @node Error in Breakpoints
3890 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3891 @c
3892 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3893 @c
3894 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3895 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3896 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3897 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3898
3899 @smallexample
3900 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3901 The same program may be running in another process.
3902 @end smallexample
3903
3904 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3905
3906 @enumerate
3907 @item
3908 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3909
3910 @item
3911 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3912 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3913 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3914 Then start your program again.
3915
3916 @item
3917 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3918 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3919 to nonsharable executables.
3920 @end enumerate
3921 @c @end ifclear
3922
3923 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3924 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3925
3926 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3927 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3928 @smallexample
3929 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3930 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3931 @end smallexample
3932
3933 @noindent
3934 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3935 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3936 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3937
3938 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3939 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3940
3941 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3942 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3943 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3944
3945 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3946 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3947 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3948 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3949
3950 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3951 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3952 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3953 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3954 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3955 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3956 first in the bundle.
3957
3958 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3959 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3960 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3961 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3962 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3963 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3964 is hit.
3965
3966 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3967 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3968
3969 @smallexample
3970 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3971 @end smallexample
3972
3973 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3974 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3975 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3976 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3977 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3978 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3979 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3980 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3981
3982 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3983 adjusted breakpoints:
3984
3985 @smallexample
3986 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3987 to 0x00010410.
3988 @end smallexample
3989
3990 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3991 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3992 frequently than expected.
3993
3994 @node Continuing and Stepping
3995 @section Continuing and Stepping
3996
3997 @cindex stepping
3998 @cindex continuing
3999 @cindex resuming execution
4000 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4001 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4002 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4003 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4004 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4005 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4006 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4007 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4008
4009 @table @code
4010 @kindex continue
4011 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4012 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4013 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4014 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4015 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4016 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4017 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4018 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4019 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4020 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4021
4022 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4023 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4024 @code{continue} is ignored.
4025
4026 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4027 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4028 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4029 @code{continue}.
4030 @end table
4031
4032 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4033 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4034 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4035 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4036
4037 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4038 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4039 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4040 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4041 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4042 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4043
4044 @table @code
4045 @kindex step
4046 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4047 @item step
4048 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4049 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4050 abbreviated @code{s}.
4051
4052 @quotation
4053 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4054 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4055 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4056 @c distinction here.
4057 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4058 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4059 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4060 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4061 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4062 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4063 below.
4064 @end quotation
4065
4066 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4067 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4068 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4069 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4070 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4071 called within the line.
4072
4073 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4074 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4075 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4076 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4077 was any debugging information about the routine.
4078
4079 @item step @var{count}
4080 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4081 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4082 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4083
4084 @kindex next
4085 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4086 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4087 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4088 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4089 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4090 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4091 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4092 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4093
4094 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4095
4096
4097 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4098 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4099 @c
4100 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4101 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4102 @c function are executed without stopping.
4103
4104 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4105 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4106 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4107
4108 @kindex set step-mode
4109 @item set step-mode
4110 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4111 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4112 @itemx set step-mode on
4113 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4114 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4115 information rather than stepping over it.
4116
4117 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4118 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4119 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4120
4121 @item set step-mode off
4122 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4123 debug information. This is the default.
4124
4125 @item show step-mode
4126 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4127 source line debug information.
4128
4129 @kindex finish
4130 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4131 @item finish
4132 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4133 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4134 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4135
4136 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4137 ,Returning from a Function}).
4138
4139 @kindex until
4140 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4141 @cindex run until specified location
4142 @item until
4143 @itemx u
4144 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4145 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4146 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4147 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4148 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4149 than the address of the jump.
4150
4151 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4152 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4153 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4154 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4155 through the next iteration.
4156
4157 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4158 stack frame.
4159
4160 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4161 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4162 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4163 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4164 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4165
4166 @smallexample
4167 (@value{GDBP}) f
4168 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4169 206 expand_input();
4170 (@value{GDBP}) until
4171 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4172 @end smallexample
4173
4174 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4175 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4176 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4177 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4178 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4179 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4180 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4181
4182 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4183 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4184 argument.
4185
4186 @item until @var{location}
4187 @itemx u @var{location}
4188 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4189 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4190 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4191 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4192 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4193 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4194 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4195 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4196 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4197 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4198 invocations have returned.
4199
4200 @smallexample
4201 94 int factorial (int value)
4202 95 @{
4203 96 if (value > 1) @{
4204 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4205 98 @}
4206 99 return (value);
4207 100 @}
4208 @end smallexample
4209
4210
4211 @kindex advance @var{location}
4212 @itemx advance @var{location}
4213 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4214 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4215 @ref{Specify Location}.
4216 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4217 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4218 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4219 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4220
4221
4222 @kindex stepi
4223 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4224 @item stepi
4225 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4226 @itemx si
4227 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4228
4229 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4230 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4231 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4232 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4233
4234 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4235
4236 @need 750
4237 @kindex nexti
4238 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4239 @item nexti
4240 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4241 @itemx ni
4242 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4243 proceed until the function returns.
4244
4245 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4246 @end table
4247
4248 @node Signals
4249 @section Signals
4250 @cindex signals
4251
4252 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4253 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4254 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4255 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4256 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4257 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4258 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4259 requested an alarm).
4260
4261 @cindex fatal signals
4262 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4263 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4264 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4265 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4266 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4267 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4268
4269 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4270 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4271 signal.
4272
4273 @cindex handling signals
4274 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4275 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4276 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4277 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4278 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4279
4280 @table @code
4281 @kindex info signals
4282 @kindex info handle
4283 @item info signals
4284 @itemx info handle
4285 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4286 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4287 the defined types of signals.
4288
4289 @item info signals @var{sig}
4290 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4291
4292 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4293
4294 @kindex handle
4295 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4296 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4297 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4298 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4299 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4300 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4301 say what change to make.
4302 @end table
4303
4304 @c @group
4305 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4306 Their full names are:
4307
4308 @table @code
4309 @item nostop
4310 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4311 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4312
4313 @item stop
4314 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4315 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4316
4317 @item print
4318 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4319
4320 @item noprint
4321 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4322 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4323
4324 @item pass
4325 @itemx noignore
4326 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4327 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4328 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4329
4330 @item nopass
4331 @itemx ignore
4332 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4333 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4334 @end table
4335 @c @end group
4336
4337 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4338 program until you
4339 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4340 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4341 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4342 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4343 program sees that signal when you continue.
4344
4345 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4346 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4347 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4348 erroneous signals.
4349
4350 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4351 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4352 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4353 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4354 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4355 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4356 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4357 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4358 Program a Signal}.
4359
4360 @node Thread Stops
4361 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4362
4363 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4364 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4365 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4366
4367 @table @code
4368 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4369 @cindex thread breakpoints
4370 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4371 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4372 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4373 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4374 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4375 specify some source line.
4376
4377 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4378 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4379 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4380 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4381 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4382
4383 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4384 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4385 program.
4386
4387 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4388 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4389 breakpoint condition, like this:
4390
4391 @smallexample
4392 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4393 @end smallexample
4394
4395 @end table
4396
4397 @cindex stopped threads
4398 @cindex threads, stopped
4399 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4400 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4401 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4402 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4403 underfoot.
4404
4405 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4406 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4407 @cindex premature return from system calls
4408 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4409 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4410 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4411 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4412 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4413 stop execution.
4414
4415 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4416 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4417 style anyways.
4418
4419 For example, do not write code like this:
4420
4421 @smallexample
4422 sleep (10);
4423 @end smallexample
4424
4425 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4426 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4427
4428 Instead, write this:
4429
4430 @smallexample
4431 int unslept = 10;
4432 while (unslept > 0)
4433 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4434 @end smallexample
4435
4436 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4437 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4438 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4439 @value{GDBN}.
4440
4441 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4442 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4443 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4444 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4445
4446 @cindex continuing threads
4447 @cindex threads, continuing
4448 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4449 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4450 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4451
4452 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4453 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4454 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4455 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4456 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4457 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4458 stops.
4459
4460 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4461 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4462 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4463 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4464
4465 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4466 thread to run.
4467
4468 @table @code
4469 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4470 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4471 @cindex lock scheduler
4472 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4473 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4474 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4475 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4476 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4477 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4478 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4479 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4480 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4481 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4482 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4483
4484 @item show scheduler-locking
4485 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4486 @end table
4487
4488
4489 @node Stack
4490 @chapter Examining the Stack
4491
4492 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4493 stopped and how it got there.
4494
4495 @cindex call stack
4496 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4497 is generated.
4498 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4499 the arguments of the call,
4500 and the local variables of the function being called.
4501 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4502 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4503 stack}.
4504
4505 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4506 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4507
4508 @cindex selected frame
4509 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4510 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4511 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4512 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4513 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4514 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4515
4516 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4517 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4518 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4519
4520 @menu
4521 * Frames:: Stack frames
4522 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4523 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4524 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4525
4526 @end menu
4527
4528 @node Frames
4529 @section Stack Frames
4530
4531 @cindex frame, definition
4532 @cindex stack frame
4533 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4534 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4535 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4536 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4537 which the function is executing.
4538
4539 @cindex initial frame
4540 @cindex outermost frame
4541 @cindex innermost frame
4542 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4543 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4544 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4545 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4546 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4547 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4548 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4549 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4550
4551 @cindex frame pointer
4552 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4553 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4554 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4555 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4556 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4557 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4558
4559 @cindex frame number
4560 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4561 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4562 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4563 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4564 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4565
4566 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4567 @c underflow problems.
4568 @cindex frameless execution
4569 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4570 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4571 @smallexample
4572 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4573 @end smallexample
4574 generates functions without a frame.)
4575 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4576 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4577 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4578 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4579 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4580 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4581 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4582
4583 @table @code
4584 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4585 @cindex current stack frame
4586 @item frame @var{args}
4587 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4588 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4589 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4590 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4591
4592 @kindex select-frame
4593 @cindex selecting frame silently
4594 @item select-frame
4595 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4596 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4597 @code{frame}.
4598 @end table
4599
4600 @node Backtrace
4601 @section Backtraces
4602
4603 @cindex traceback
4604 @cindex call stack traces
4605 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4606 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4607 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4608 stack.
4609
4610 @table @code
4611 @kindex backtrace
4612 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4613 @item backtrace
4614 @itemx bt
4615 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4616 frames in the stack.
4617
4618 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4619 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4620
4621 @item backtrace @var{n}
4622 @itemx bt @var{n}
4623 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4624
4625 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4626 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4627 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4628
4629 @item backtrace full
4630 @itemx bt full
4631 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4632 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4633 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4634 number of frames to print, as described above.
4635 @end table
4636
4637 @kindex where
4638 @kindex info stack
4639 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4640 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4641
4642 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4643 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4644 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4645 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4646 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4647 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4648 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4649 multi-threaded program.
4650
4651 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4652 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4653 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4654 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4655 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4656 line number.
4657
4658 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4659 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4660
4661 @smallexample
4662 @group
4663 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4664 at builtin.c:993
4665 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4666 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4667 at macro.c:71
4668 (More stack frames follow...)
4669 @end group
4670 @end smallexample
4671
4672 @noindent
4673 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4674 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4675 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4676
4677 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4678 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4679 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4680 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4681 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4682 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4683 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4684 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4685 such a backtrace might look like:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 @group
4689 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4690 at builtin.c:993
4691 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4692 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4693 at macro.c:71
4694 (More stack frames follow...)
4695 @end group
4696 @end smallexample
4697
4698 @noindent
4699 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4700 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4701
4702 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4703 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4704 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4705
4706 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4707 @cindex program entry point
4708 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4709 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4710 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4711 @code{main}@footnote{
4712 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4713 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4714 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4715 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4716 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4717 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4718
4719 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4720 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4721
4722 @table @code
4723 @item set backtrace past-main
4724 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4725 @kindex set backtrace
4726 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4727
4728 @item set backtrace past-main off
4729 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4730 default.
4731
4732 @item show backtrace past-main
4733 @kindex show backtrace
4734 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4735
4736 @item set backtrace past-entry
4737 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4738 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4739 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4740 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4741
4742 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4743 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4744 application. This is the default.
4745
4746 @item show backtrace past-entry
4747 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4748
4749 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4750 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4751 @cindex backtrace limit
4752 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4753 unlimited.
4754
4755 @item show backtrace limit
4756 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4757 @end table
4758
4759 @node Selection
4760 @section Selecting a Frame
4761
4762 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4763 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4764 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4765 of the stack frame just selected.
4766
4767 @table @code
4768 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4769 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4770 @item frame @var{n}
4771 @itemx f @var{n}
4772 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4773 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4774 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4775 @code{main}.
4776
4777 @item frame @var{addr}
4778 @itemx f @var{addr}
4779 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4780 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4781 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4782 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4783 switches between them.
4784
4785 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4786 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4787
4788 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4789 pointer and a program counter.
4790
4791 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4792 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4793
4794 @kindex up
4795 @item up @var{n}
4796 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4797 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4798 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4799
4800 @kindex down
4801 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4802 @item down @var{n}
4803 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4804 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4805 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4806 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4807 @end table
4808
4809 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4810 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4811 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4812 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4813
4814 @need 1000
4815 For example:
4816
4817 @smallexample
4818 @group
4819 (@value{GDBP}) up
4820 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4821 at env.c:10
4822 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4823 @end group
4824 @end smallexample
4825
4826 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4827 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4828 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4829 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4830 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4831 for details.
4832
4833 @table @code
4834 @kindex down-silently
4835 @kindex up-silently
4836 @item up-silently @var{n}
4837 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4838 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4839 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4840 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4841 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4842 distracting.
4843 @end table
4844
4845 @node Frame Info
4846 @section Information About a Frame
4847
4848 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4849 stack frame.
4850
4851 @table @code
4852 @item frame
4853 @itemx f
4854 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4855 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4856 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4857 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4858 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4859
4860 @kindex info frame
4861 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4862 @item info frame
4863 @itemx info f
4864 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4865 including:
4866
4867 @itemize @bullet
4868 @item
4869 the address of the frame
4870 @item
4871 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4872 @item
4873 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4874 @item
4875 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4876 @item
4877 the address of the frame's arguments
4878 @item
4879 the address of the frame's local variables
4880 @item
4881 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4882 @item
4883 which registers were saved in the frame
4884 @end itemize
4885
4886 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4887 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4888 the usual conventions.
4889
4890 @item info frame @var{addr}
4891 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4892 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4893 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4894 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4895 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4896 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4897
4898 @kindex info args
4899 @item info args
4900 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4901
4902 @item info locals
4903 @kindex info locals
4904 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4905 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4906 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4907
4908 @kindex info catch
4909 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4910 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4911 @item info catch
4912 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4913 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4914 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4915 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4916 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4917
4918 @end table
4919
4920
4921 @node Source
4922 @chapter Examining Source Files
4923
4924 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4925 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4926 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4927 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4928 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4929 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4930 source files by explicit command.
4931
4932 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4933 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4934 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4935
4936 @menu
4937 * List:: Printing source lines
4938 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
4939 * Edit:: Editing source files
4940 * Search:: Searching source files
4941 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4942 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4943 @end menu
4944
4945 @node List
4946 @section Printing Source Lines
4947
4948 @kindex list
4949 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4950 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4951 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4952 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
4953 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
4954
4955 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4956
4957 @table @code
4958 @item list @var{linenum}
4959 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4960 current source file.
4961
4962 @item list @var{function}
4963 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4964 @var{function}.
4965
4966 @item list
4967 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4968 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4969 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4970 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4971 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4972
4973 @item list -
4974 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4975 @end table
4976
4977 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4978 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4979 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4980
4981 @table @code
4982 @kindex set listsize
4983 @item set listsize @var{count}
4984 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4985 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4986
4987 @kindex show listsize
4988 @item show listsize
4989 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4990 @end table
4991
4992 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4993 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4994 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4995 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4996 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4997
4998 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4999 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5000 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5001 to specify some source line.
5002
5003 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5004
5005 @table @code
5006 @item list @var{linespec}
5007 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5008
5009 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5010 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5011 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5012 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5013 the same source file as the first linespec.
5014
5015 @item list ,@var{last}
5016 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5017
5018 @item list @var{first},
5019 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5020
5021 @item list +
5022 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5023
5024 @item list -
5025 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5026
5027 @item list
5028 As described in the preceding table.
5029 @end table
5030
5031 @node Specify Location
5032 @section Specifying a Location
5033 @cindex specifying location
5034 @cindex linespec
5035
5036 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5037 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5038 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5039 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5040
5041 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5042 @value{GDBN} understands:
5043
5044 @table @code
5045 @item @var{linenum}
5046 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5047
5048 @item -@var{offset}
5049 @itemx +@var{offset}
5050 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5051 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5052 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5053 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5054 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5055 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5056 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5057 linespec.
5058
5059 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5060 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5061
5062 @item @var{function}
5063 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5064 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5065
5066 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5067 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5068 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5069 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5070 functions in different source files.
5071
5072 @item *@var{address}
5073 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5074 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5075 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5076 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5077 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5078 source files.
5079
5080 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5081 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5082 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5083 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5084 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5085 of @var{address}:
5086
5087 @table @code
5088 @item @var{expression}
5089 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5090
5091 @item @var{funcaddr}
5092 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5093 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5094 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5095 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5096 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5097 (although the Pascal form also works).
5098
5099 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5100 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5101
5102 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5103 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5104 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5105 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5106 functions with identical names in different source files.
5107 @end table
5108
5109 @end table
5110
5111
5112 @node Edit
5113 @section Editing Source Files
5114 @cindex editing source files
5115
5116 @kindex edit
5117 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5118 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5119 The editing program of your choice
5120 is invoked with the current line set to
5121 the active line in the program.
5122 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5123 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5124
5125 @table @code
5126 @item edit @var{location}
5127 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5128 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5129 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5130 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5131 command most commonly used:
5132
5133 @table @code
5134 @item edit @var{number}
5135 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5136
5137 @item edit @var{function}
5138 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5139 @end table
5140
5141 @end table
5142
5143 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5144 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5145 @footnote{
5146 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5147 following command-line syntax:
5148 @smallexample
5149 ex +@var{number} file
5150 @end smallexample
5151 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5152 the file where to start editing.}.
5153 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5154 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5155 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5156 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5157 @smallexample
5158 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5159 export EDITOR
5160 gdb @dots{}
5161 @end smallexample
5162 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5163 @smallexample
5164 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5165 gdb @dots{}
5166 @end smallexample
5167
5168 @node Search
5169 @section Searching Source Files
5170 @cindex searching source files
5171
5172 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5173 regular expression.
5174
5175 @table @code
5176 @kindex search
5177 @kindex forward-search
5178 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5179 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5180 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5181 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5182 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5183 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5184 @code{fo}.
5185
5186 @kindex reverse-search
5187 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5188 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5189 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5190 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5191 this command as @code{rev}.
5192 @end table
5193
5194 @node Source Path
5195 @section Specifying Source Directories
5196
5197 @cindex source path
5198 @cindex directories for source files
5199 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5200 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5201 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5202 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5203 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5204 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5205 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5206
5207 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5208 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5209 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5210 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5211 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5212 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5213 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5214 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5215 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5216 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5217 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5218
5219 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5220 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5221 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5222 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5223 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5224 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5225
5226 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5227 source files.
5228
5229 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5230 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5231 each line is in the file.
5232
5233 @kindex directory
5234 @kindex dir
5235 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5236 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5237 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5238
5239 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5240 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5241
5242 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5243 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5244 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5245 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5246 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5247 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5248 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5249 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5250 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5251 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5252 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5253 name to look up the sources.
5254
5255 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5256 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5257 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5258 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5259 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5260 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5261 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5262 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5263
5264 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5265 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5266 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5267 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5268 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5269 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5270 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5271
5272 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5273 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5274 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5275 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5276 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5277 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5278 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5279 command.
5280
5281 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5282 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5283 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5284 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5285 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5286 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5287 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5288
5289 @table @code
5290 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5291 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5292 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5293 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5294 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5295 part of absolute file names) or
5296 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5297 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5298
5299 @kindex cdir
5300 @kindex cwd
5301 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5302 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5303 @cindex compilation directory
5304 @cindex current directory
5305 @cindex working directory
5306 @cindex directory, current
5307 @cindex directory, compilation
5308 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5309 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5310 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5311 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5312 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5313 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5314
5315 @item directory
5316 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5317
5318 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5319 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5320
5321 @item show directories
5322 @kindex show directories
5323 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5324
5325 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5326 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5327 @kindex set substitute-path
5328 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5329 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5330 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5331
5332 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5333 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5334
5335 @smallexample
5336 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5337 @end smallexample
5338
5339 @noindent
5340 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5341 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5342 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5343
5344 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5345 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5346 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5347 the substitution.
5348
5349 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5350
5351 @smallexample
5352 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5353 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5354 @end smallexample
5355
5356 @noindent
5357 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5358 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5359 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5360 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5361
5362
5363 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5364 @kindex unset substitute-path
5365 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5366 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5367 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5368
5369 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5370
5371 @item show substitute-path [path]
5372 @kindex show substitute-path
5373 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5374 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5375
5376 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5377 rules.
5378
5379 @end table
5380
5381 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5382 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5383 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5384
5385 @enumerate
5386 @item
5387 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5388
5389 @item
5390 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5391 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5392 directories in one command.
5393 @end enumerate
5394
5395 @node Machine Code
5396 @section Source and Machine Code
5397 @cindex source line and its code address
5398
5399 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5400 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5401 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5402 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5403 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5404 well as hex.
5405
5406 @table @code
5407 @kindex info line
5408 @item info line @var{linespec}
5409 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5410 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5411 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5412 @end table
5413
5414 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5415 the object code for the first line of function
5416 @code{m4_changequote}:
5417
5418 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5419 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5420 @smallexample
5421 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5422 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5423 @end smallexample
5424
5425 @noindent
5426 @cindex code address and its source line
5427 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5428 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5429 @smallexample
5430 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5431 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5432 @end smallexample
5433
5434 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5435 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5436 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5437 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5438 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5439 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5440 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5441 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5442 Variables}).
5443
5444 @table @code
5445 @kindex disassemble
5446 @cindex assembly instructions
5447 @cindex instructions, assembly
5448 @cindex machine instructions
5449 @cindex listing machine instructions
5450 @item disassemble
5451 @itemx disassemble /m
5452 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5453 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
5454 the @code{/m} modifier.
5455 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5456 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5457 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5458 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5459 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5460 @end table
5461
5462 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5463 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5464
5465 @smallexample
5466 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5467 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5468 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5469 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5470 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5471 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5472 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5473 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5474 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5475 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5476 End of assembler dump.
5477 @end smallexample
5478
5479 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
5480
5481 @smallexample
5482 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
5483 Dump of assembler code for function main:
5484 5 @{
5485 0x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
5486 0x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
5487 0x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
5488 0x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
5489 0x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
5490
5491 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
5492 0x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
5493 0x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
5494
5495 7 return 0;
5496 8 @}
5497 0x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
5498 0x0804834d <main+29>: leave
5499 0x0804834e <main+30>: ret
5500
5501 End of assembler dump.
5502 @end smallexample
5503
5504 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5505 mnemonics or other syntax.
5506
5507 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5508 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5509 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5510 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5511 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5512
5513 @table @code
5514 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5515 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5516 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5517 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5518 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5519 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5520
5521 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5522 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5523 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5524 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5525
5526 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5527 @item show disassembly-flavor
5528 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5529 @end table
5530
5531
5532 @node Data
5533 @chapter Examining Data
5534
5535 @cindex printing data
5536 @cindex examining data
5537 @kindex print
5538 @kindex inspect
5539 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5540 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5541 @c different window or something like that.
5542 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5543 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5544 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5545 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5546 Different Languages}).
5547
5548 @table @code
5549 @item print @var{expr}
5550 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5551 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5552 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5553 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5554 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5555 Formats}.
5556
5557 @item print
5558 @itemx print /@var{f}
5559 @cindex reprint the last value
5560 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5561 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5562 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5563 @end table
5564
5565 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5566 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5567 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5568
5569 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5570 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5571 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5572 Table}.
5573
5574 @menu
5575 * Expressions:: Expressions
5576 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
5577 * Variables:: Program variables
5578 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5579 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5580 * Memory:: Examining memory
5581 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5582 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5583 * Value History:: Value history
5584 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5585 * Registers:: Registers
5586 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5587 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5588 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5589 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5590 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5591 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5592 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5593 character set than GDB does
5594 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5595 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
5596 @end menu
5597
5598 @node Expressions
5599 @section Expressions
5600
5601 @cindex expressions
5602 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5603 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5604 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5605 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5606 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5607 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5608 @ref{Compilation}.
5609
5610 @cindex arrays in expressions
5611 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5612 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5613 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
5614 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
5615 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
5616 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5617
5618 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5619 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5620 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5621 languages.
5622
5623 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5624 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5625
5626 @cindex casts, in expressions
5627 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5628 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5629 at that address in memory.
5630 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5631
5632 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5633 to programming languages:
5634
5635 @table @code
5636 @item @@
5637 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5638 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5639
5640 @item ::
5641 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5642 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5643
5644 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5645 @cindex type casting memory
5646 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5647 @cindex casts, to view memory
5648 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5649 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5650 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5651 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5652 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5653 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5654 @end table
5655
5656 @node Ambiguous Expressions
5657 @section Ambiguous Expressions
5658 @cindex ambiguous expressions
5659
5660 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
5661 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
5662 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
5663 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
5664 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
5665 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
5666 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
5667
5668 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
5669 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
5670 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
5671 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
5672 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
5673 as well.
5674
5675 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
5676 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
5677 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
5678 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
5679 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
5680 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
5681 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
5682 choices.
5683
5684 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
5685 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
5686 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
5687
5688 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
5689 @smallexample
5690 @group
5691 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
5692 [0] cancel
5693 [1] all
5694 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
5695 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
5696 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
5697 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
5698 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
5699 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
5700 > 2 4 6
5701 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
5702 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
5703 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
5704 Multiple breakpoints were set.
5705 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
5706 breakpoints.
5707 (@value{GDBP})
5708 @end group
5709 @end smallexample
5710
5711 @table @code
5712 @kindex set multiple-symbols
5713 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
5714 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
5715
5716 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
5717 is ambiguous.
5718
5719 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
5720 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
5721 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
5722 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
5723 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
5724 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
5725 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
5726 in the use of the menu.
5727
5728 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
5729 when an ambiguity is detected.
5730
5731 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
5732 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
5733
5734 @kindex show multiple-symbols
5735 @item show multiple-symbols
5736 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
5737 @end table
5738
5739 @node Variables
5740 @section Program Variables
5741
5742 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5743 in your program.
5744
5745 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5746 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5747
5748 @itemize @bullet
5749 @item
5750 global (or file-static)
5751 @end itemize
5752
5753 @noindent or
5754
5755 @itemize @bullet
5756 @item
5757 visible according to the scope rules of the
5758 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5759 @end itemize
5760
5761 @noindent This means that in the function
5762
5763 @smallexample
5764 foo (a)
5765 int a;
5766 @{
5767 bar (a);
5768 @{
5769 int b = test ();
5770 bar (b);
5771 @}
5772 @}
5773 @end smallexample
5774
5775 @noindent
5776 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5777 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5778 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5779 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5780
5781 @cindex variable name conflict
5782 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5783 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5784 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5785 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5786 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5787 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5788 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5789
5790 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5791 @ifnotinfo
5792 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5793 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5794 @end ifnotinfo
5795 @smallexample
5796 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5797 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5798 @end smallexample
5799
5800 @noindent
5801 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5802 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5803 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5804 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5805
5806 @smallexample
5807 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5808 @end smallexample
5809
5810 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5811 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5812 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5813 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5814 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5815 @c conflict?? --mew
5816
5817 @cindex wrong values
5818 @cindex variable values, wrong
5819 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5820 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5821 @quotation
5822 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5823 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5824 scope, and just before exit.
5825 @end quotation
5826 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5827 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5828 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5829 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5830 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5831 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5832 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5833 variable definitions may be gone.
5834
5835 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5836 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5837 when compiling.
5838
5839 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5840 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5841 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5842 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5843 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5844 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5845 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5846
5847 @smallexample
5848 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5849 @end smallexample
5850
5851 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5852 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5853 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5854 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5855 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5856 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5857 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5858 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5859 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5860 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5861 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5862
5863 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5864 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5865 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5866 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5867
5868 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5869 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5870 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5871 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5872 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5873 For program code
5874
5875 @smallexample
5876 char var0[] = "A";
5877 signed char var1[] = "A";
5878 @end smallexample
5879
5880 You get during debugging
5881 @smallexample
5882 (gdb) print var0
5883 $1 = "A"
5884 (gdb) print var1
5885 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5886 @end smallexample
5887
5888 @node Arrays
5889 @section Artificial Arrays
5890
5891 @cindex artificial array
5892 @cindex arrays
5893 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5894 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5895 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5896 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5897 program.
5898
5899 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5900 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5901 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5902 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5903 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5904 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5905 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5906 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5907 example. If a program says
5908
5909 @smallexample
5910 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5911 @end smallexample
5912
5913 @noindent
5914 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5915
5916 @smallexample
5917 p *array@@len
5918 @end smallexample
5919
5920 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5921 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5922 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5923 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5924 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5925
5926 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5927 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5928 The value need not be in memory:
5929 @smallexample
5930 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5931 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5932 @end smallexample
5933
5934 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5935 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5936 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5937 @smallexample
5938 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5939 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5940 @end smallexample
5941
5942 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5943 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5944 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5945 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5946 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5947 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5948 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5949 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5950 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5951 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5952
5953 @smallexample
5954 set $i = 0
5955 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5956 @key{RET}
5957 @key{RET}
5958 @dots{}
5959 @end smallexample
5960
5961 @node Output Formats
5962 @section Output Formats
5963
5964 @cindex formatted output
5965 @cindex output formats
5966 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5967 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5968 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5969 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5970 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5971
5972 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5973 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5974 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5975 letters supported are:
5976
5977 @table @code
5978 @item x
5979 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5980 hexadecimal.
5981
5982 @item d
5983 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5984
5985 @item u
5986 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5987
5988 @item o
5989 Print as integer in octal.
5990
5991 @item t
5992 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5993 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5994 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5995 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5996
5997 @item a
5998 @cindex unknown address, locating
5999 @cindex locate address
6000 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6001 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6002 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6003
6004 @smallexample
6005 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6006 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6007 @end smallexample
6008
6009 @noindent
6010 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6011 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6012
6013 @item c
6014 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6015 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6016 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6017 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6018
6019 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6020 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6021 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6022 data.
6023
6024 @item f
6025 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6026 using typical floating point syntax.
6027
6028 @item s
6029 @cindex printing strings
6030 @cindex printing byte arrays
6031 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6032 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6033 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6034 natural types.
6035
6036 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6037 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6038 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6039 array.
6040 @end table
6041
6042 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6043
6044 @smallexample
6045 p/x $pc
6046 @end smallexample
6047
6048 @noindent
6049 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6050 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6051
6052 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6053 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6054 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6055
6056 @node Memory
6057 @section Examining Memory
6058
6059 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6060 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6061
6062 @cindex examining memory
6063 @table @code
6064 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6065 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6066 @itemx x @var{addr}
6067 @itemx x
6068 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6069 @end table
6070
6071 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6072 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6073 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6074 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6075 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6076
6077 @table @r
6078 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6079 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6080 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6081 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6082 @c 4.1.2.
6083
6084 @item @var{f}, the display format
6085 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6086 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6087 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6088 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6089 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6090
6091 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6092 The unit size is any of
6093
6094 @table @code
6095 @item b
6096 Bytes.
6097 @item h
6098 Halfwords (two bytes).
6099 @item w
6100 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6101 @item g
6102 Giant words (eight bytes).
6103 @end table
6104
6105 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6106 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6107 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6108
6109 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6110 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6111 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6112 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6113 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6114 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6115 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6116 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6117 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6118 a value from memory).
6119 @end table
6120
6121 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6122 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6123 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6124 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6125 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6126
6127 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6128 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6129 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6130 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6131 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6132
6133 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6134 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6135 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6136 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6137 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6138 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6139 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6140 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6141 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6142
6143 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6144 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6145 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6146 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6147 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6148 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6149 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6150
6151 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6152 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6153 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6154 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6155 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6156 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6157 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6158 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6159 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6160
6161 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6162 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6163 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6164
6165 @cindex remote memory comparison
6166 @cindex verify remote memory image
6167 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6168 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6169 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6170 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6171 situations.
6172
6173 @table @code
6174 @kindex compare-sections
6175 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6176 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6177 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6178 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6179 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6180 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6181 remote request.
6182 @end table
6183
6184 @node Auto Display
6185 @section Automatic Display
6186 @cindex automatic display
6187 @cindex display of expressions
6188
6189 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6190 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6191 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6192 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6193 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6194 The automatic display looks like this:
6195
6196 @smallexample
6197 2: foo = 38
6198 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6199 @end smallexample
6200
6201 @noindent
6202 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6203 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6204 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6205 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6206 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6207 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6208
6209 @table @code
6210 @kindex display
6211 @item display @var{expr}
6212 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6213 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6214
6215 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6216
6217 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6218 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6219 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6220 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6221 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6222
6223 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6224 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6225 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6226 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6227 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6228 @end table
6229
6230 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6231 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6232 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6233
6234 @table @code
6235 @kindex delete display
6236 @kindex undisplay
6237 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6238 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6239 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6240
6241 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6242 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6243
6244 @kindex disable display
6245 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6246 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6247 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6248 enabled again later.
6249
6250 @kindex enable display
6251 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6252 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6253 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6254
6255 @item display
6256 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6257 done when your program stops.
6258
6259 @kindex info display
6260 @item info display
6261 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6262 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6263 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6264 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6265 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6266 @end table
6267
6268 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6269 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6270 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6271 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6272 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6273 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6274 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6275 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6276 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6277 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6278 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6279
6280 @node Print Settings
6281 @section Print Settings
6282
6283 @cindex format options
6284 @cindex print settings
6285 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6286 and symbols are printed.
6287
6288 @noindent
6289 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6290
6291 @table @code
6292 @kindex set print
6293 @item set print address
6294 @itemx set print address on
6295 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6296 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6297 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6298 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6299 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6300 @code{set print address on}:
6301
6302 @smallexample
6303 @group
6304 (@value{GDBP}) f
6305 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6306 at input.c:530
6307 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6308 @end group
6309 @end smallexample
6310
6311 @item set print address off
6312 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6313 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6314
6315 @smallexample
6316 @group
6317 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6318 (@value{GDBP}) f
6319 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6320 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6321 @end group
6322 @end smallexample
6323
6324 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6325 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6326 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6327 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6328
6329 @kindex show print
6330 @item show print address
6331 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6332 @end table
6333
6334 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6335 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6336 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6337 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6338 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6339 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6340 it prints a symbolic address:
6341
6342 @table @code
6343 @item set print symbol-filename on
6344 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6345 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6346 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6347 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6348
6349 @item set print symbol-filename off
6350 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6351 default.
6352
6353 @item show print symbol-filename
6354 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6355 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6356 @end table
6357
6358 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6359 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6360 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6361
6362 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6363 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6364
6365 @table @code
6366 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6367 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6368 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6369 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6370 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6371 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6372
6373 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6374 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6375 symbolic address.
6376 @end table
6377
6378 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6379 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6380 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6381 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6382 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6383 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6384 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6385 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6386
6387 @smallexample
6388 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6389 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6390 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6391 @end smallexample
6392
6393 @quotation
6394 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6395 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6396 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6397 @end quotation
6398
6399 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6400
6401 @table @code
6402 @item set print array
6403 @itemx set print array on
6404 @cindex pretty print arrays
6405 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6406 but uses more space. The default is off.
6407
6408 @item set print array off
6409 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6410
6411 @item show print array
6412 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6413 arrays.
6414
6415 @cindex print array indexes
6416 @item set print array-indexes
6417 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6418 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6419 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6420 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6421
6422 @item set print array-indexes off
6423 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6424
6425 @item show print array-indexes
6426 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6427 arrays.
6428
6429 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6430 @cindex number of array elements to print
6431 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6432 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6433 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6434 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6435 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6436 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6437 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6438
6439 @item show print elements
6440 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6441 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6442
6443 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6444 @cindex printing frame argument values
6445 @cindex print all frame argument values
6446 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6447 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6448 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6449 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6450 values are:
6451
6452 @table @code
6453 @item all
6454 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6455
6456 @item scalars
6457 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6458 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6459 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6460
6461 @smallexample
6462 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6463 at frame-args.c:23
6464 @end smallexample
6465
6466 @item none
6467 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6468 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6469
6470 @smallexample
6471 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6472 at frame-args.c:23
6473 @end smallexample
6474 @end table
6475
6476 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6477 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6478 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6479 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6480 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6481 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6482 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6483 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6484
6485 @item show print frame-arguments
6486 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6487
6488 @item set print repeats
6489 @cindex repeated array elements
6490 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6491 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6492 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6493 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6494 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6495 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6496 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6497
6498 @item show print repeats
6499 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6500 elements.
6501
6502 @item set print null-stop
6503 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6504 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6505 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6506 contain only short strings.
6507 The default is off.
6508
6509 @item show print null-stop
6510 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6511 @sc{null} character.
6512
6513 @item set print pretty on
6514 @cindex print structures in indented form
6515 @cindex indentation in structure display
6516 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6517 per line, like this:
6518
6519 @smallexample
6520 @group
6521 $1 = @{
6522 next = 0x0,
6523 flags = @{
6524 sweet = 1,
6525 sour = 1
6526 @},
6527 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6528 @}
6529 @end group
6530 @end smallexample
6531
6532 @item set print pretty off
6533 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6534
6535 @smallexample
6536 @group
6537 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6538 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6539 @end group
6540 @end smallexample
6541
6542 @noindent
6543 This is the default format.
6544
6545 @item show print pretty
6546 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6547
6548 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6549 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6550 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6551 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6552 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6553 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6554 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6555 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6556
6557 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6558 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6559 international character sets, and is the default.
6560
6561 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6562 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6563
6564 @item set print union on
6565 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6566 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6567 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6568
6569 @item set print union off
6570 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6571 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6572 instead.
6573
6574 @item show print union
6575 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6576 structures and other unions.
6577
6578 For example, given the declarations
6579
6580 @smallexample
6581 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6582 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6583 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6584 Bug_forms;
6585
6586 struct thing @{
6587 Species it;
6588 union @{
6589 Tree_forms tree;
6590 Bug_forms bug;
6591 @} form;
6592 @};
6593
6594 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6595 @end smallexample
6596
6597 @noindent
6598 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6599
6600 @smallexample
6601 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6602 @end smallexample
6603
6604 @noindent
6605 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6606
6607 @smallexample
6608 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6609 @end smallexample
6610
6611 @noindent
6612 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6613 and in Pascal.
6614 @end table
6615
6616 @need 1000
6617 @noindent
6618 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6619
6620 @table @code
6621 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6622 @item set print demangle
6623 @itemx set print demangle on
6624 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6625 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6626 linkage. The default is on.
6627
6628 @item show print demangle
6629 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6630
6631 @item set print asm-demangle
6632 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6633 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6634 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6635 The default is off.
6636
6637 @item show print asm-demangle
6638 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6639 or demangled form.
6640
6641 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6642 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6643 @kindex set demangle-style
6644 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6645 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6646 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6647
6648 @table @code
6649 @item auto
6650 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6651
6652 @item gnu
6653 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6654 This is the default.
6655
6656 @item hp
6657 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6658
6659 @item lucid
6660 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6661
6662 @item arm
6663 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6664 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6665 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6666 require further enhancement to permit that.
6667
6668 @end table
6669 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6670
6671 @item show demangle-style
6672 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6673
6674 @item set print object
6675 @itemx set print object on
6676 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6677 @cindex display derived types
6678 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6679 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6680 the virtual function table.
6681
6682 @item set print object off
6683 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6684 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6685
6686 @item show print object
6687 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6688
6689 @item set print static-members
6690 @itemx set print static-members on
6691 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6692 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6693
6694 @item set print static-members off
6695 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6696
6697 @item show print static-members
6698 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6699
6700 @item set print pascal_static-members
6701 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6702 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6703 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6704 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6705
6706 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6707 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6708
6709 @item show print pascal_static-members
6710 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6711
6712 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6713 @item set print vtbl
6714 @itemx set print vtbl on
6715 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6716 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6717 @cindex VTBL display
6718 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6719 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6720 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6721
6722 @item set print vtbl off
6723 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6724
6725 @item show print vtbl
6726 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6727 @end table
6728
6729 @node Value History
6730 @section Value History
6731
6732 @cindex value history
6733 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6734 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6735 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6736 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6737 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6738 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6739 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6740 symbol table.
6741
6742 @cindex @code{$}
6743 @cindex @code{$$}
6744 @cindex history number
6745 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6746 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6747 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6748 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6749 history number.
6750
6751 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6752 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6753 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6754 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6755 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6756 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6757 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6758
6759 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6760 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6761
6762 @smallexample
6763 p *$
6764 @end smallexample
6765
6766 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6767 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6768
6769 @smallexample
6770 p *$.next
6771 @end smallexample
6772
6773 @noindent
6774 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6775 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6776
6777 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6778 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6779
6780 @smallexample
6781 print x
6782 set x=5
6783 @end smallexample
6784
6785 @noindent
6786 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6787 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6788
6789 @table @code
6790 @kindex show values
6791 @item show values
6792 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6793 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6794 values} does not change the history.
6795
6796 @item show values @var{n}
6797 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6798
6799 @item show values +
6800 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6801 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6802 @end table
6803
6804 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6805 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6806
6807 @node Convenience Vars
6808 @section Convenience Variables
6809
6810 @cindex convenience variables
6811 @cindex user-defined variables
6812 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6813 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6814 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6815 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6816 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6817
6818 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6819 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6820 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6821 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6822 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6823
6824 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6825 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6826 For example:
6827
6828 @smallexample
6829 set $foo = *object_ptr
6830 @end smallexample
6831
6832 @noindent
6833 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6834 @code{object_ptr}.
6835
6836 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6837 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6838 value with another assignment at any time.
6839
6840 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6841 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6842 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6843 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6844
6845 @table @code
6846 @kindex show convenience
6847 @cindex show all user variables
6848 @item show convenience
6849 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6850 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6851
6852 @kindex init-if-undefined
6853 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6854 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6855 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6856 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6857 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6858 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6859 override default values used in a command script.
6860
6861 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6862 any side-effects do not occur.
6863 @end table
6864
6865 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6866 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6867 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6868
6869 @smallexample
6870 set $i = 0
6871 print bar[$i++]->contents
6872 @end smallexample
6873
6874 @noindent
6875 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6876
6877 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6878 values likely to be useful.
6879
6880 @table @code
6881 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6882 @item $_
6883 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6884 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6885 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6886 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6887 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6888 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6889 to the type of @code{$__}.
6890
6891 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6892 @item $__
6893 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6894 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6895 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6896
6897 @item $_exitcode
6898 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6899 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6900 the program being debugged terminates.
6901 @end table
6902
6903 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6904 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6905 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6906
6907 @node Registers
6908 @section Registers
6909
6910 @cindex registers
6911 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6912 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6913 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6914 your machine.
6915
6916 @table @code
6917 @kindex info registers
6918 @item info registers
6919 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6920 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6921
6922 @kindex info all-registers
6923 @cindex floating point registers
6924 @item info all-registers
6925 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6926 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6927
6928 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6929 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6930 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6931 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6932 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6933 @end table
6934
6935 @cindex stack pointer register
6936 @cindex program counter register
6937 @cindex process status register
6938 @cindex frame pointer register
6939 @cindex standard registers
6940 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6941 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6942 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6943 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6944 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6945 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6946 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6947 you could print the program counter in hex with
6948
6949 @smallexample
6950 p/x $pc
6951 @end smallexample
6952
6953 @noindent
6954 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6955
6956 @smallexample
6957 x/i $pc
6958 @end smallexample
6959
6960 @noindent
6961 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6962 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6963 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6964 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6965 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6966 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6967 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6968
6969 @smallexample
6970 set $sp += 4
6971 @end smallexample
6972
6973 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6974 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6975 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6976 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6977 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6978 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6979 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6980
6981 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6982 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6983 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6984 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6985 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6986 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6987 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6988
6989 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6990 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6991 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6992 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6993 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6994 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6995 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6996 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6997 prints the data in both formats.
6998
6999 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
7000 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
7001 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7002 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7003 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7004 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7005 registers in @code{struct} notation:
7006
7007 @smallexample
7008 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7009 $1 = @{
7010 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7011 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7012 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7013 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7014 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7015 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7016 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7017 @}
7018 @end smallexample
7019
7020 @noindent
7021 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7022 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7023 value to a @code{struct} member:
7024
7025 @smallexample
7026 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7027 @end smallexample
7028
7029 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7030 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7031 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7032 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7033 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7034 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7035
7036 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7037 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7038 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7039 frame makes no difference.
7040
7041 @node Floating Point Hardware
7042 @section Floating Point Hardware
7043 @cindex floating point
7044
7045 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7046 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7047
7048 @table @code
7049 @kindex info float
7050 @item info float
7051 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7052 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7053 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7054 the ARM and x86 machines.
7055 @end table
7056
7057 @node Vector Unit
7058 @section Vector Unit
7059 @cindex vector unit
7060
7061 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7062 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7063
7064 @table @code
7065 @kindex info vector
7066 @item info vector
7067 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7068 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7069 @end table
7070
7071 @node OS Information
7072 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7073 @cindex OS information
7074
7075 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7076 you debug your program.
7077
7078 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7079 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7080 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7081 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7082 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7083 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7084 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7085 structure.
7086
7087 @table @code
7088 @item info udot
7089 @kindex info udot
7090 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7091 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7092 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7093 the @code{examine} command.
7094 @end table
7095
7096 @cindex auxiliary vector
7097 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7098 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7099 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7100 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7101 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7102 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7103 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7104 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7105 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7106 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7107 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7108 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7109
7110 @table @code
7111 @kindex info auxv
7112 @item info auxv
7113 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7114 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7115 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7116 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7117 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7118 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7119 an unrecognized tag.
7120 @end table
7121
7122
7123 @node Memory Region Attributes
7124 @section Memory Region Attributes
7125 @cindex memory region attributes
7126
7127 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7128 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7129 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7130 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7131 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7132 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7133 user can override the fetched regions.
7134
7135 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7136 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7137 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7138 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7139 all memory.
7140
7141 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7142 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7143
7144 @table @code
7145 @kindex mem
7146 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7147 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7148 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7149 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7150 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7151 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7152
7153 @item mem auto
7154 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7155 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7156
7157 @kindex delete mem
7158 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7159 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7160 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7161
7162 @kindex disable mem
7163 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7164 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7165 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7166 It may be enabled again later.
7167
7168 @kindex enable mem
7169 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7170 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7171
7172 @kindex info mem
7173 @item info mem
7174 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7175 for each region:
7176
7177 @table @emph
7178 @item Memory Region Number
7179 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7180 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7181 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7182
7183 @item Lo Address
7184 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7185
7186 @item Hi Address
7187 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7188
7189 @item Attributes
7190 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7191 @end table
7192 @end table
7193
7194
7195 @subsection Attributes
7196
7197 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7198 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7199 write accesses to a memory region.
7200
7201 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7202 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7203 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7204
7205 @table @code
7206 @item ro
7207 Memory is read only.
7208 @item wo
7209 Memory is write only.
7210 @item rw
7211 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7212 @end table
7213
7214 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7215 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7216 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7217 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7218 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7219
7220 @table @code
7221 @item 8
7222 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7223 @item 16
7224 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7225 @item 32
7226 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7227 @item 64
7228 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7229 @end table
7230
7231 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7232 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7233 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7234 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7235 @c
7236 @c @table @code
7237 @c @item hwbreak
7238 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7239 @c @item swbreak (default)
7240 @c @end table
7241
7242 @subsubsection Data Cache
7243 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7244 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7245 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7246 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7247 registers.
7248
7249 @table @code
7250 @item cache
7251 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7252 @item nocache
7253 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7254 @end table
7255
7256 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7257 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7258 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7259 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7260 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7261
7262 @table @code
7263 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7264 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7265 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7266 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7267 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7268 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7269 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7270 The default value is @code{on}.
7271 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7272 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7273 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7274 @end table
7275
7276
7277 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7278 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7279 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7280 @c
7281 @c @table @code
7282 @c @item verify
7283 @c @item noverify (default)
7284 @c @end table
7285
7286 @node Dump/Restore Files
7287 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7288 @cindex dump/restore files
7289 @cindex append data to a file
7290 @cindex dump data to a file
7291 @cindex restore data from a file
7292
7293 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7294 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7295 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7296 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7297 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7298 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7299 files.
7300
7301 @table @code
7302
7303 @kindex dump
7304 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7305 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7306 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7307 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7308
7309 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7310 @table @code
7311 @item binary
7312 Raw binary form.
7313 @item ihex
7314 Intel hex format.
7315 @item srec
7316 Motorola S-record format.
7317 @item tekhex
7318 Tektronix Hex format.
7319 @end table
7320
7321 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7322 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7323 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7324 form.
7325
7326 @kindex append
7327 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7328 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7329 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7330 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7331 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7332
7333 @kindex restore
7334 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7335 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7336 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7337 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7338 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7339
7340 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7341 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7342 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7343 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7344 from that location.
7345
7346 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7347 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7348 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7349 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7350
7351 @end table
7352
7353 @node Core File Generation
7354 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7355 @cindex dump core from inferior
7356
7357 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7358 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7359 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7360 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7361 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7362 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7363 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7364
7365 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7366 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7367 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7368
7369 @table @code
7370 @kindex gcore
7371 @kindex generate-core-file
7372 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7373 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7374 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7375 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7376 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7377 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7378
7379 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7380 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7381 @end table
7382
7383 @node Character Sets
7384 @section Character Sets
7385 @cindex character sets
7386 @cindex charset
7387 @cindex translating between character sets
7388 @cindex host character set
7389 @cindex target character set
7390
7391 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7392 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7393 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7394 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7395 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7396 @dfn{target character set}.
7397
7398 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7399 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7400 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7401 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7402 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7403 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7404 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7405 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7406 character and string literals in expressions.
7407
7408 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7409 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7410 target-charset} command, described below.
7411
7412 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7413 support:
7414
7415 @table @code
7416 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7417 @kindex set target-charset
7418 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7419 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7420 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7421 list the target character sets it supports.
7422 @end table
7423
7424 @table @code
7425 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7426 @kindex set host-charset
7427 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7428
7429 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7430 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7431 @code{set host-charset} command.
7432
7433 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7434 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7435 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7436 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7437 list the host character sets it supports.
7438
7439 @item set charset @var{charset}
7440 @kindex set charset
7441 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7442 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7443 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7444 for both host and target.
7445
7446
7447 @item show charset
7448 @kindex show charset
7449 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7450
7451 @itemx show host-charset
7452 @kindex show host-charset
7453 Show the name of the current host charset.
7454
7455 @itemx show target-charset
7456 @kindex show target-charset
7457 Show the name of the current target charset.
7458
7459 @end table
7460
7461 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7462 sets:
7463
7464 @table @code
7465
7466 @item ASCII
7467 @cindex ASCII character set
7468 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7469 character set.
7470
7471 @item ISO-8859-1
7472 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7473 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7474 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7475 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7476 this as its host character set.
7477
7478 @item EBCDIC-US
7479 @itemx IBM1047
7480 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7481 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7482 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7483 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7484 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7485
7486 @end table
7487
7488 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7489 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7490 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7491
7492 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7493 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7494 @file{charset-test.c}:
7495
7496 @smallexample
7497 #include <stdio.h>
7498
7499 char ascii_hello[]
7500 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7501 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7502 char ibm1047_hello[]
7503 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7504 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7505
7506 main ()
7507 @{
7508 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7509 @}
7510 @end smallexample
7511
7512 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7513 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7514 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7515
7516 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7517
7518 @smallexample
7519 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7520 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7521 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7522 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7523 @dots{}
7524 (@value{GDBP})
7525 @end smallexample
7526
7527 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7528 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7529 strings:
7530
7531 @smallexample
7532 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7533 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7534 (@value{GDBP})
7535 @end smallexample
7536
7537 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7538 initial character set:
7539 @smallexample
7540 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7541 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7542 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7543 (@value{GDBP})
7544 @end smallexample
7545
7546 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7547 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7548 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7549 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7550 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7551
7552 @smallexample
7553 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7554 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7555 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7556 $2 = 72 'H'
7557 (@value{GDBP})
7558 @end smallexample
7559
7560 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7561 literals you use in expressions:
7562
7563 @smallexample
7564 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7565 $3 = 43 '+'
7566 (@value{GDBP})
7567 @end smallexample
7568
7569 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7570 character.
7571
7572 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7573 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7574 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7575
7576 @smallexample
7577 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7578 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7579 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7580 $5 = 200 '\310'
7581 (@value{GDBP})
7582 @end smallexample
7583
7584 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7585 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7586
7587 @smallexample
7588 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7589 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7590 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7591 @end smallexample
7592
7593 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7594 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7595 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7596 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7597 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7598
7599 @smallexample
7600 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7601 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7602 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7603 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7604 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7605 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7606 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7607 $7 = 72 '\110'
7608 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7609 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7610 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7611 $9 = 200 'H'
7612 (@value{GDBP})
7613 @end smallexample
7614
7615 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7616 string literals you use in expressions:
7617
7618 @smallexample
7619 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7620 $10 = 78 '+'
7621 (@value{GDBP})
7622 @end smallexample
7623
7624 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7625 character.
7626
7627 @node Caching Remote Data
7628 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7629 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7630
7631 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7632 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7633 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7634 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7635 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7636 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7637 volatile registers are in use.
7638
7639 @table @code
7640 @kindex set remotecache
7641 @item set remotecache on
7642 @itemx set remotecache off
7643 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7644 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7645
7646 @kindex show remotecache
7647 @item show remotecache
7648 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7649
7650 @kindex info dcache
7651 @item info dcache
7652 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7653 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7654 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7655 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7656 the data cache operation.
7657 @end table
7658
7659 @node Searching Memory
7660 @section Search Memory
7661 @cindex searching memory
7662
7663 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
7664 @code{find} command.
7665
7666 @table @code
7667 @kindex find
7668 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
7669 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
7670 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
7671 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
7672 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
7673 @end table
7674
7675 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
7676 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
7677
7678 @table @r
7679 @item @var{s}, search query size
7680 The size of each search query value.
7681
7682 @table @code
7683 @item b
7684 bytes
7685 @item h
7686 halfwords (two bytes)
7687 @item w
7688 words (four bytes)
7689 @item g
7690 giant words (eight bytes)
7691 @end table
7692
7693 All values are interpreted in the current language.
7694 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
7695 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
7696
7697 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
7698 value's type in the current language.
7699 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
7700 pattern as a mixture of types.
7701 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
7702 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
7703 which is typically four bytes.
7704
7705 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
7706 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
7707 @end table
7708
7709 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
7710 (@code{"}).
7711 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
7712 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
7713
7714 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
7715 number of matches found.
7716
7717 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
7718 @samp{$_}.
7719 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
7720
7721 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
7722
7723 @smallexample
7724 void
7725 hello ()
7726 @{
7727 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
7728 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
7729 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
7730 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
7731 printf ("%s\n", hello);
7732 @}
7733 @end smallexample
7734
7735 @noindent
7736 you get during debugging:
7737
7738 @smallexample
7739 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
7740 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
7741 1 pattern found
7742 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
7743 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
7744 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
7745 2 patterns found
7746 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
7747 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
7748 1 pattern found
7749 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
7750 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
7751 1 pattern found
7752 (gdb) print $numfound
7753 $1 = 1
7754 (gdb) print $_
7755 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
7756 @end smallexample
7757
7758 @node Macros
7759 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7760
7761 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7762 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7763 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7764 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7765 where it was defined.
7766
7767 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7768 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7769 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7770 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7771
7772 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7773 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7774 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7775 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7776 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7777 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7778 see @ref{List}.
7779
7780 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7781 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7782 variable-arity macros.
7783
7784 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7785 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7786 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7787
7788 @table @code
7789
7790 @kindex macro expand
7791 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7792 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7793 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7794 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7795 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7796 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7797 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7798 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7799 it can be any string of tokens.
7800
7801 @kindex macro exp1
7802 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7803 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7804 @cindex expand macro once
7805 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7806 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7807 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7808 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7809 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7810 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7811 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7812 can be any string of tokens.
7813
7814 @kindex info macro
7815 @cindex macro definition, showing
7816 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7817 @item info macro @var{macro}
7818 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7819 source location where that definition was established.
7820
7821 @kindex macro define
7822 @cindex user-defined macros
7823 @cindex defining macros interactively
7824 @cindex macros, user-defined
7825 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7826 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7827 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7828 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7829 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7830 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7831 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7832 given in @var{arglist}.
7833
7834 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7835 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7836 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7837 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7838 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7839
7840 @kindex macro undef
7841 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7842 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7843 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7844 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7845 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7846 debugged.
7847
7848 @kindex macro list
7849 @item macro list
7850 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7851 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7852 @end table
7853
7854 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7855 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7856 show our source files:
7857
7858 @smallexample
7859 $ cat sample.c
7860 #include <stdio.h>
7861 #include "sample.h"
7862
7863 #define M 42
7864 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7865
7866 main ()
7867 @{
7868 #define N 28
7869 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7870 #undef N
7871 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7872 #define N 1729
7873 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7874 @}
7875 $ cat sample.h
7876 #define Q <
7877 $
7878 @end smallexample
7879
7880 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7881 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7882 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7883 information.
7884
7885 @smallexample
7886 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7887 $
7888 @end smallexample
7889
7890 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7891
7892 @smallexample
7893 $ gdb -nw sample
7894 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7895 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7896 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7897 (@value{GDBP})
7898 @end smallexample
7899
7900 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7901 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7902 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7903
7904 @smallexample
7905 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7906 3
7907 4 #define M 42
7908 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7909 6
7910 7 main ()
7911 8 @{
7912 9 #define N 28
7913 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7914 11 #undef N
7915 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7916 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7917 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7918 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7919 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7920 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7921 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7922 #define Q <
7923 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7924 expands to: (42 + 1)
7925 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7926 expands to: once (M + 1)
7927 (@value{GDBP})
7928 @end smallexample
7929
7930 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7931 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7932 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7933 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7934
7935 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7936 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7937
7938 @smallexample
7939 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7940 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7941 (@value{GDBP}) run
7942 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7943
7944 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7945 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7946 (@value{GDBP})
7947 @end smallexample
7948
7949 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7950
7951 @smallexample
7952 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7953 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7954 #define N 28
7955 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7956 expands to: 28 < 42
7957 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7958 $1 = 1
7959 (@value{GDBP})
7960 @end smallexample
7961
7962 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7963 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7964 thereof) in force at each point:
7965
7966 @smallexample
7967 (@value{GDBP}) next
7968 Hello, world!
7969 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7970 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7971 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7972 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7973 (@value{GDBP}) next
7974 We're so creative.
7975 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7976 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7977 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7978 #define N 1729
7979 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7980 expands to: 1729 < 42
7981 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7982 $2 = 0
7983 (@value{GDBP})
7984 @end smallexample
7985
7986
7987 @node Tracepoints
7988 @chapter Tracepoints
7989 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7990 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7991
7992 @cindex tracepoints
7993 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7994 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7995 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7996 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7997 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7998 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7999 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8000
8001 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8002 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8003 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8004 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8005 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8006 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8007 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8008 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8009 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8010 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8011 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8012
8013 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8014 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8015 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8016 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8017 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8018 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8019 Packets}.
8020
8021 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8022
8023 @menu
8024 * Set Tracepoints::
8025 * Analyze Collected Data::
8026 * Tracepoint Variables::
8027 @end menu
8028
8029 @node Set Tracepoints
8030 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8031
8032 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8033 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
8034 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
8035 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
8036 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
8037 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
8038 work on.
8039
8040 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8041 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8042 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8043 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8044 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8045 tracepoint was hit.
8046
8047 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8048 conditions and actions.
8049
8050 @menu
8051 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8052 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8053 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
8054 * Tracepoint Actions::
8055 * Listing Tracepoints::
8056 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8057 @end menu
8058
8059 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8060 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8061
8062 @table @code
8063 @cindex set tracepoint
8064 @kindex trace
8065 @item trace
8066 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8067 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
8068 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
8069 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
8070 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
8071 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
8072 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
8073 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
8074 running.
8075
8076 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8077
8078 @smallexample
8079 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8080
8081 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8082
8083 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8084
8085 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8086
8087 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8088 @end smallexample
8089
8090 @noindent
8091 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8092
8093 @vindex $tpnum
8094 @cindex last tracepoint number
8095 @cindex recent tracepoint number
8096 @cindex tracepoint number
8097 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
8098 of the most recently set tracepoint.
8099
8100 @kindex delete tracepoint
8101 @cindex tracepoint deletion
8102 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8103 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
8104 default is to delete all tracepoints.
8105
8106 Examples:
8107
8108 @smallexample
8109 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
8110
8111 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
8112 @end smallexample
8113
8114 @noindent
8115 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
8116 @end table
8117
8118 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8119 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8120
8121 @table @code
8122 @kindex disable tracepoint
8123 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8124 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
8125 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
8126 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
8127 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
8128
8129 @kindex enable tracepoint
8130 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8131 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8132 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8133 run.
8134 @end table
8135
8136 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
8137 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8138
8139 @table @code
8140 @kindex passcount
8141 @cindex tracepoint pass count
8142 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8143 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8144 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8145 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8146 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8147 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8148 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8149 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8150 user.
8151
8152 Examples:
8153
8154 @smallexample
8155 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8156 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8157
8158 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8159 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8160 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8161 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8162 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8163 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8164 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8165 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8166 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8167 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8168 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8169 @end smallexample
8170 @end table
8171
8172 @node Tracepoint Actions
8173 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8174
8175 @table @code
8176 @kindex actions
8177 @cindex tracepoint actions
8178 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8179 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8180 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8181 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8182 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8183 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8184 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8185 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8186 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8187 @code{while-stepping}.
8188
8189 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8190 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8191 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8192
8193 @smallexample
8194 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8195
8196 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8197
8198 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8199 @end smallexample
8200
8201 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8202 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8203 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8204 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8205 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8206 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8207 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8208 @code{end} command.
8209
8210 @smallexample
8211 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8212 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8213 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8214 > collect bar,baz
8215 > collect $regs
8216 > while-stepping 12
8217 > collect $fp, $sp
8218 > end
8219 end
8220 @end smallexample
8221
8222 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8223 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8224 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8225 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8226 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8227 special arguments are supported:
8228
8229 @table @code
8230 @item $regs
8231 collect all registers
8232
8233 @item $args
8234 collect all function arguments
8235
8236 @item $locals
8237 collect all local variables.
8238 @end table
8239
8240 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8241 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8242 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8243
8244 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8245 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8246
8247 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8248 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8249 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8250 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8251 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8252 its own @code{end} command):
8253
8254 @smallexample
8255 > while-stepping 12
8256 > collect $regs, myglobal
8257 > end
8258 >
8259 @end smallexample
8260
8261 @noindent
8262 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8263 @code{stepping}.
8264 @end table
8265
8266 @node Listing Tracepoints
8267 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8268
8269 @table @code
8270 @kindex info tracepoints
8271 @kindex info tp
8272 @cindex information about tracepoints
8273 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8274 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8275 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8276 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8277 shown:
8278
8279 @itemize @bullet
8280 @item
8281 its number
8282 @item
8283 whether it is enabled or disabled
8284 @item
8285 its address
8286 @item
8287 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8288 @item
8289 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8290 @item
8291 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8292 @item
8293 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8294 @end itemize
8295
8296 @smallexample
8297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8298 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8299 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8300 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8301 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8302 (@value{GDBP})
8303 @end smallexample
8304
8305 @noindent
8306 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8307 @end table
8308
8309 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8310 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8311
8312 @table @code
8313 @kindex tstart
8314 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8315 @cindex collected data discarded
8316 @item tstart
8317 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8318 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8319 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8320 experiment.
8321
8322 @kindex tstop
8323 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8324 @item tstop
8325 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8326 stops collecting data.
8327
8328 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8329 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8330 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8331
8332 @kindex tstatus
8333 @cindex status of trace data collection
8334 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8335 @item tstatus
8336 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8337 collection.
8338 @end table
8339
8340 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8341
8342 @smallexample
8343 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8344 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8345 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8346 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8347 > while-stepping 11
8348 > collect $regs
8349 > end
8350 > end
8351 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8352 [time passes @dots{}]
8353 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8354 @end smallexample
8355
8356
8357 @node Analyze Collected Data
8358 @section Using the Collected Data
8359
8360 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8361 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8362 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8363 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8364 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8365 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8366 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8367 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8368 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8369 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8370 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8371 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8372 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8373 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8374 the buffer will fail.
8375
8376 @menu
8377 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8378 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8379 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8380 @end menu
8381
8382 @node tfind
8383 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8384
8385 @kindex tfind
8386 @cindex select trace snapshot
8387 @cindex find trace snapshot
8388 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8389 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8390 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8391 snapshot is selected.
8392
8393 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8394
8395 @table @code
8396 @item tfind start
8397 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8398 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8399
8400 @item tfind none
8401 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8402
8403 @item tfind end
8404 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8405
8406 @item tfind
8407 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8408
8409 @item tfind -
8410 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8411 retracing earlier steps.
8412
8413 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8414 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8415 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8416 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8417 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8418
8419 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8420 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8421 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8422 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8423 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8424
8425 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8426 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8427 addresses.
8428
8429 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8430 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8431 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8432
8433 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8434 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8435 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8436 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8437 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8438 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8439 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8440 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8441 @end table
8442
8443 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8444 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8445 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8446 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8447 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8448 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8449 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8450 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8451 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8452 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8453 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8454 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8455 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8456 tracepoint as the current one.
8457
8458 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8459 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8460 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8461 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8462 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8463
8464 @smallexample
8465 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8466 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8467 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8468 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8469 > tfind
8470 > end
8471
8472 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8473 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8474 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8475 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8476 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8477 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8478 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8479 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8480 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8481 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8482 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8483 @end smallexample
8484
8485 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8486 the buffer:
8487
8488 @smallexample
8489 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8490 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8491 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8492 > tfind line
8493 > end
8494
8495 Frame 0, X = 1
8496 Frame 7, X = 2
8497 Frame 13, X = 255
8498 @end smallexample
8499
8500 @node tdump
8501 @subsection @code{tdump}
8502 @kindex tdump
8503 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8504 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8505
8506 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8507 the current trace snapshot.
8508
8509 @smallexample
8510 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8511 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8512 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8513 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8514 > end
8515
8516 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8517
8518 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8519 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8520 at gdb_test.c:444
8521 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8522
8523 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8524 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8525 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8526 d1 0x18 24
8527 d2 0x80 128
8528 d3 0x33 51
8529 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8530 d5 0x22 34
8531 d6 0xe0 224
8532 d7 0x380035 3670069
8533 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8534 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8535 a2 0x100 256
8536 a3 0x322000 3284992
8537 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8538 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8539 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8540 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8541 ps 0x0 0
8542 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8543 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8544 fpstatus 0x0 0
8545 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8546 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8547 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8548 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8549 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8550 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8551 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8552 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8553 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8554
8555 (@value{GDBP})
8556 @end smallexample
8557
8558 @node save-tracepoints
8559 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8560 @kindex save-tracepoints
8561 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8562
8563 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8564 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8565 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8566 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8567 Files}).
8568
8569 @node Tracepoint Variables
8570 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8571 @cindex tracepoint variables
8572 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8573
8574 @table @code
8575 @vindex $trace_frame
8576 @item (int) $trace_frame
8577 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8578 snapshot is selected.
8579
8580 @vindex $tracepoint
8581 @item (int) $tracepoint
8582 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8583
8584 @vindex $trace_line
8585 @item (int) $trace_line
8586 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8587
8588 @vindex $trace_file
8589 @item (char []) $trace_file
8590 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8591
8592 @vindex $trace_func
8593 @item (char []) $trace_func
8594 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8595 @end table
8596
8597 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8598 use @code{output} instead.
8599
8600 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8601 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8602 data.
8603
8604 @smallexample
8605 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8606
8607 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8608 > output $trace_file
8609 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8610 > tfind
8611 > end
8612 @end smallexample
8613
8614 @node Overlays
8615 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8616 @cindex overlays
8617
8618 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8619 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8620 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8621 use overlays.
8622
8623 @menu
8624 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8625 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8626 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8627 mapped by asking the inferior.
8628 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8629 @end menu
8630
8631 @node How Overlays Work
8632 @section How Overlays Work
8633 @cindex mapped overlays
8634 @cindex unmapped overlays
8635 @cindex load address, overlay's
8636 @cindex mapped address
8637 @cindex overlay area
8638
8639 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8640 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8641 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8642 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8643 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8644
8645 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8646 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8647 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8648 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8649 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8650 largest overlay as well.
8651
8652 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8653 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8654 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8655 there.
8656
8657 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8658 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8659 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8660
8661 @smallexample
8662 @group
8663 Data Instruction Larger
8664 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8665 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8666 | | | | | |
8667 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8668 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8669 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8670 | and heap | | | | | |
8671 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8672 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8673 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8674 | | | | | |
8675 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8676 address | | | | | |
8677 | overlay | <-' | | |
8678 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8679 | | <---. | | load address
8680 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8681 | | | |
8682 +-----------+ | |
8683 +-----------+
8684 | |
8685 +-----------+
8686
8687 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8688 @end group
8689 @end smallexample
8690
8691 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8692 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8693 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8694 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8695 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8696 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8697 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8698 program and the overlay area.
8699
8700 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8701 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8702 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8703 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8704 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8705 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8706 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8707
8708 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8709 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8710 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8711
8712 @itemize @bullet
8713
8714 @item
8715 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8716 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8717 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8718 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8719
8720 @item
8721 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8722 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8723 your program's performance.
8724
8725 @item
8726 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8727 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8728 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8729 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8730 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8731 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8732 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8733
8734 @item
8735 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8736 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8737 instruction and data spaces.
8738
8739 @end itemize
8740
8741 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8742 improved in many ways:
8743
8744 @itemize @bullet
8745
8746 @item
8747 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8748 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8749 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8750 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8751 area in the usual way.
8752
8753 @item
8754 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8755 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8756
8757 @item
8758 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8759 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8760 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8761 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8762 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8763 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8764 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8765
8766 @end itemize
8767
8768
8769 @node Overlay Commands
8770 @section Overlay Commands
8771
8772 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8773 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8774 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8775 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8776 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8777 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8778
8779 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8780 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8781
8782 @table @code
8783 @item overlay off
8784 @kindex overlay
8785 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8786 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8787 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8788 overlay support is disabled.
8789
8790 @item overlay manual
8791 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8792 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8793 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8794 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8795 commands described below.
8796
8797 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8798 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8799 @cindex map an overlay
8800 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8801 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8802 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8803 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8804 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8805 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8806
8807 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8808 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8809 @cindex unmap an overlay
8810 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8811 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8812 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8813 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8814
8815 @item overlay auto
8816 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8817 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8818 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8819 Overlay Debugging}.
8820
8821 @item overlay load-target
8822 @itemx overlay load
8823 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8824 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8825 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8826 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8827 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8828 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8829
8830 @item overlay list-overlays
8831 @itemx overlay list
8832 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8833 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8834 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8835
8836 @end table
8837
8838 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8839 of the function the address falls in:
8840
8841 @smallexample
8842 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8843 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8844 @end smallexample
8845 @noindent
8846 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8847 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8848 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8849 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8850
8851 @smallexample
8852 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8853 No sections are mapped.
8854 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8855 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8856 @end smallexample
8857 @noindent
8858 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8859 name normally:
8860
8861 @smallexample
8862 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8863 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8864 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8865 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8866 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8867 @end smallexample
8868
8869 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8870 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8871 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8872 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8873 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8874
8875 @itemize @bullet
8876 @item
8877 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8878 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8879 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8880 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8881 @item
8882 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8883 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8884 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8885 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8886 breakpoints properly.
8887 @end itemize
8888
8889
8890 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8891 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8892 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8893
8894 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8895 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8896 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8897 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8898 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8899 current state of the overlays.
8900
8901 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8902 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8903
8904 @table @asis
8905
8906 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8907 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8908
8909 @smallexample
8910 struct
8911 @{
8912 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8913 unsigned long vma;
8914
8915 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8916 unsigned long size;
8917
8918 /* The overlay's load address. */
8919 unsigned long lma;
8920
8921 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8922 zero otherwise. */
8923 unsigned long mapped;
8924 @}
8925 @end smallexample
8926
8927 @item @code{_novlys}:
8928 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8929 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8930
8931 @end table
8932
8933 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8934 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8935 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8936 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8937 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8938 currently mapped.
8939
8940 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8941 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8942 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8943 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8944 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8945 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8946 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8947 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8948 are not being executed.
8949
8950 @node Overlay Sample Program
8951 @section Overlay Sample Program
8952 @cindex overlay example program
8953
8954 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8955 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8956 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8957 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8958 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8959 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8960 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8961
8962 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8963 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8964 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8965 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8966
8967 @table @file
8968 @item overlays.c
8969 The main program file.
8970 @item ovlymgr.c
8971 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8972 @item foo.c
8973 @itemx bar.c
8974 @itemx baz.c
8975 @itemx grbx.c
8976 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8977 @item d10v.ld
8978 @itemx m32r.ld
8979 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8980 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8981 @end table
8982
8983 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8984 cross-compiler like this:
8985
8986 @smallexample
8987 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8988 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8989 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8990 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8991 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8992 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8993 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8994 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8995 @end smallexample
8996
8997 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8998 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8999 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9000
9001
9002 @node Languages
9003 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9004 @cindex languages
9005
9006 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9007 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9008 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9009 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9010 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9011 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9012
9013 @cindex working language
9014 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9015 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9016 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9017 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9018 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9019 language}.
9020
9021 @menu
9022 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
9023 * Show:: Displaying the language
9024 * Checks:: Type and range checks
9025 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9026 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9027 @end menu
9028
9029 @node Setting
9030 @section Switching Between Source Languages
9031
9032 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9033 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9034 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9035 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9036 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9037 are printed, etc.
9038
9039 In addition to the working language, every source file that
9040 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9041 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9042 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9043 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
9044 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
9045 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
9046 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
9047 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
9048 Displaying the Language}.
9049
9050 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
9051 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
9052 another language. In that case, make the
9053 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
9054 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
9055 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
9056
9057 @menu
9058 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
9059 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
9060 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
9061 @end menu
9062
9063 @node Filenames
9064 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
9065
9066 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
9067 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
9068
9069 @table @file
9070 @item .ada
9071 @itemx .ads
9072 @itemx .adb
9073 @itemx .a
9074 Ada source file.
9075
9076 @item .c
9077 C source file
9078
9079 @item .C
9080 @itemx .cc
9081 @itemx .cp
9082 @itemx .cpp
9083 @itemx .cxx
9084 @itemx .c++
9085 C@t{++} source file
9086
9087 @item .m
9088 Objective-C source file
9089
9090 @item .f
9091 @itemx .F
9092 Fortran source file
9093
9094 @item .mod
9095 Modula-2 source file
9096
9097 @item .s
9098 @itemx .S
9099 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
9100 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
9101 @end table
9102
9103 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
9104 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
9105
9106 @node Manually
9107 @subsection Setting the Working Language
9108
9109 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
9110 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
9111 your program.
9112
9113 @kindex set language
9114 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
9115 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
9116 a language, such as
9117 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
9118 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
9119
9120 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
9121 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
9122 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
9123 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
9124 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
9125 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
9126 command such as:
9127
9128 @smallexample
9129 print a = b + c
9130 @end smallexample
9131
9132 @noindent
9133 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9134 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9135 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9136 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9137
9138 @node Automatically
9139 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9140
9141 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9142 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9143 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9144 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9145 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9146 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9147 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9148 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9149 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9150
9151 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9152 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9153 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9154 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9155 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9156
9157 @node Show
9158 @section Displaying the Language
9159
9160 The following commands help you find out which language is the
9161 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9162
9163 @table @code
9164 @item show language
9165 @kindex show language
9166 Display the current working language. This is the
9167 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9168 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9169
9170 @item info frame
9171 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9172 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9173 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9174 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9175 information listed here.
9176
9177 @item info source
9178 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9179 Display the source language of this source file.
9180 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9181 information listed here.
9182 @end table
9183
9184 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9185 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9186 with a language explicitly:
9187
9188 @table @code
9189 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9190 @kindex set extension-language
9191 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9192 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9193
9194 @item info extensions
9195 @kindex info extensions
9196 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9197 @end table
9198
9199 @node Checks
9200 @section Type and Range Checking
9201
9202 @quotation
9203 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9204 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9205 section documents the intended facilities.
9206 @end quotation
9207 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9208
9209 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9210 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9211 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9212 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9213 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9214 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9215 errors when your program is running.
9216
9217 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9218 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9219 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9220 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9221 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9222 automatically based on your program's source language.
9223 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9224 settings of supported languages.
9225
9226 @menu
9227 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9228 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9229 @end menu
9230
9231 @cindex type checking
9232 @cindex checks, type
9233 @node Type Checking
9234 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9235
9236 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9237 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9238 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9239 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9240
9241 @smallexample
9242 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9243 @exdent but
9244 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9245 @end smallexample
9246
9247 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9248 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9249
9250 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9251 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9252 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9253 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9254 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9255 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9256 also issues a warning.
9257
9258 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9259 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9260 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9261 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9262 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9263 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9264
9265 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9266 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9267 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9268 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9269 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9270 details on specific languages.
9271
9272 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9273
9274 @kindex set check type
9275 @kindex show check type
9276 @table @code
9277 @item set check type auto
9278 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9279 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9280 each language.
9281
9282 @item set check type on
9283 @itemx set check type off
9284 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9285 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9286 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9287 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9288 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9289
9290 @item set check type warn
9291 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9292 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9293 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9294 numbers and structures.
9295
9296 @item show type
9297 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9298 is setting it automatically.
9299 @end table
9300
9301 @cindex range checking
9302 @cindex checks, range
9303 @node Range Checking
9304 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9305
9306 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9307 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9308 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9309 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9310 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9311
9312 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9313 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9314 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9315 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9316
9317 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9318 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9319 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9320 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9321 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9322 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9323
9324 @smallexample
9325 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9326 @end smallexample
9327
9328 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9329 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9330 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9331
9332 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9333
9334 @kindex set check range
9335 @kindex show check range
9336 @table @code
9337 @item set check range auto
9338 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9339 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9340 each language.
9341
9342 @item set check range on
9343 @itemx set check range off
9344 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9345 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9346 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9347 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9348
9349 @item set check range warn
9350 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9351 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9352 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9353 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9354 systems).
9355
9356 @item show range
9357 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9358 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9359 @end table
9360
9361 @node Supported Languages
9362 @section Supported Languages
9363
9364 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9365 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9366 @c This is false ...
9367 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9368 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9369 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9370 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9371 language.
9372
9373 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9374 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9375 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9376 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9377 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9378 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9379 language reference or tutorial.
9380
9381 @menu
9382 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9383 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9384 * Fortran:: Fortran
9385 * Pascal:: Pascal
9386 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9387 * Ada:: Ada
9388 @end menu
9389
9390 @node C
9391 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9392
9393 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9394 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9395
9396 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9397 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9398 together.
9399
9400 @cindex C@t{++}
9401 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9402 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9403 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9404 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9405 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9406 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9407 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9408
9409 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9410 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9411 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9412 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9413 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9414 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9415
9416 @menu
9417 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9418 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9419 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9420 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9421 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9422 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9423 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9424 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9425 @end menu
9426
9427 @node C Operators
9428 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9429
9430 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9431
9432 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9433 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9434 often defined on groups of types.
9435
9436 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9437
9438 @itemize @bullet
9439
9440 @item
9441 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9442 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9443
9444 @item
9445 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9446 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9447
9448 @item
9449 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9450
9451 @item
9452 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9453
9454 @end itemize
9455
9456 @noindent
9457 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9458 in order of increasing precedence:
9459
9460 @table @code
9461 @item ,
9462 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9463 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9464 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9465
9466 @item =
9467 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9468 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9469
9470 @item @var{op}=
9471 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9472 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9473 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9474 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9475 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9476
9477 @item ?:
9478 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9479 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9480 integral type.
9481
9482 @item ||
9483 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9484
9485 @item &&
9486 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9487
9488 @item |
9489 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9490
9491 @item ^
9492 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9493
9494 @item &
9495 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9496
9497 @item ==@r{, }!=
9498 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9499 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9500
9501 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9502 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9503 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9504 and non-zero for true.
9505
9506 @item <<@r{, }>>
9507 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9508
9509 @item @@
9510 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9511
9512 @item +@r{, }-
9513 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9514 pointer types.
9515
9516 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9517 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9518 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9519 integral types.
9520
9521 @item ++@r{, }--
9522 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9523 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9524 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9525 operation takes place.
9526
9527 @item *
9528 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9529 @code{++}.
9530
9531 @item &
9532 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9533
9534 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9535 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9536 to examine the address
9537 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9538 stored.
9539
9540 @item -
9541 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9542 precedence as @code{++}.
9543
9544 @item !
9545 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9546 @code{++}.
9547
9548 @item ~
9549 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9550 @code{++}.
9551
9552
9553 @item .@r{, }->
9554 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9555 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9556 pointer based on the stored type information.
9557 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9558
9559 @item .*@r{, }->*
9560 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9561
9562 @item []
9563 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9564 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9565
9566 @item ()
9567 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9568
9569 @item ::
9570 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9571 and @code{class} types.
9572
9573 @item ::
9574 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9575 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9576 above.
9577 @end table
9578
9579 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9580 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9581 predefined meaning.
9582
9583 @node C Constants
9584 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9585
9586 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9587
9588 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9589 following ways:
9590
9591 @itemize @bullet
9592 @item
9593 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9594 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9595 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9596 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9597 @code{long} value.
9598
9599 @item
9600 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9601 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9602 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9603 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9604 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9605 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9606 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9607 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9608 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9609 constant.
9610
9611 @item
9612 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9613 integral equivalents.
9614
9615 @item
9616 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9617 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9618 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9619 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9620 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9621 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9622 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9623 @samp{\n} for newline.
9624
9625 @item
9626 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9627 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9628 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9629 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9630 characters.
9631
9632 @item
9633 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9634 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9635
9636 @item
9637 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9638 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9639 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9640 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9641 @end itemize
9642
9643 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9644 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9645
9646 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9647 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9648
9649 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9650 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9651 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9652 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9653 @quotation
9654 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9655 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9656 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9657 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9658 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9659 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9660 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9661 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9662 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9663 C@t{++} code.
9664 @end quotation
9665
9666 @enumerate
9667
9668 @cindex member functions
9669 @item
9670 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9671
9672 @smallexample
9673 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9674 @end smallexample
9675
9676 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9677 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9678 @item
9679 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9680 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9681 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9682 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9683
9684 @cindex call overloaded functions
9685 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9686 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9687 @item
9688 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9689 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9690 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9691 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9692 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9693 default arguments.
9694
9695 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9696 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9697 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9698 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9699 number of function arguments.
9700
9701 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9702 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9703 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9704
9705 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9706 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9707 @smallexample
9708 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9709 @end smallexample
9710
9711 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9712 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9713
9714 @cindex reference declarations
9715 @item
9716 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9717 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9718 dereferenced.
9719
9720 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9721 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9722 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9723 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9724 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9725
9726 @item
9727 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9728 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9729 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9730 necessary, for example in an expression like
9731 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9732 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9733 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9734 @end enumerate
9735
9736 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9737 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9738 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9739 invoking user-defined operators.
9740
9741 @node C Defaults
9742 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9743
9744 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9745
9746 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9747 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9748 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9749 selects the working language.
9750
9751 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9752 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9753 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9754 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9755 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9756 for further details.
9757
9758 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9759 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9760 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9761
9762 @node C Checks
9763 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9764
9765 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9766
9767 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9768 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9769 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9770
9771 @itemize @bullet
9772 @item
9773 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9774 enumerated tag.
9775
9776 @item
9777 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9778 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9779
9780 @ignore
9781 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9782 @c FIXME--beers?
9783 @item
9784 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9785 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9786 compilers.)
9787 @end ignore
9788 @end itemize
9789
9790 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9791 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9792 that is not itself an array.
9793
9794 @node Debugging C
9795 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9796
9797 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9798 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9799 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9800 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9801
9802 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9803 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9804 ,Expressions}.
9805
9806 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9807 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9808
9809 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9810
9811 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9812 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9813
9814 @table @code
9815 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9816 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9817 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9818 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
9819 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
9820 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
9821
9822 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9823 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9824 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9825 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9826 classes.
9827 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9828
9829 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9830 @item catch throw
9831 @itemx catch catch
9832 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9833 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9834
9835 @cindex inheritance
9836 @item ptype @var{typename}
9837 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9838 @var{typename}.
9839 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9840
9841 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9842 @item set print demangle
9843 @itemx show print demangle
9844 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9845 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9846 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9847 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9848 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9849
9850 @item set print object
9851 @itemx show print object
9852 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9853 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9854
9855 @item set print vtbl
9856 @itemx show print vtbl
9857 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9858 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9859 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9860 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9861
9862 @kindex set overload-resolution
9863 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9864 @item set overload-resolution on
9865 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9866 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9867 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9868 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9869 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9870 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9871
9872 @item set overload-resolution off
9873 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9874 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9875 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9876 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9877 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9878 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9879 argument types.
9880
9881 @kindex show overload-resolution
9882 @item show overload-resolution
9883 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9884
9885 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9886 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9887 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9888 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9889 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9890 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9891 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9892 @end table
9893
9894 @node Decimal Floating Point
9895 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
9896 @cindex decimal floating point format
9897
9898 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
9899 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
9900 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
9901 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
9902
9903 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
9904 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
9905 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
9906 target.
9907
9908 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
9909 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
9910 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
9911
9912 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
9913 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
9914 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
9915
9916 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
9917 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
9918 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
9919
9920 @node Objective-C
9921 @subsection Objective-C
9922
9923 @cindex Objective-C
9924 This section provides information about some commands and command
9925 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9926 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9927 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9928
9929 @menu
9930 * Method Names in Commands::
9931 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9932 @end menu
9933
9934 @node Method Names in Commands
9935 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9936
9937 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9938 names as line specifications:
9939
9940 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9941 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9942 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9943 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9944 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9945 @itemize
9946 @item @code{clear}
9947 @item @code{break}
9948 @item @code{info line}
9949 @item @code{jump}
9950 @item @code{list}
9951 @end itemize
9952
9953 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9954
9955 @smallexample
9956 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9957 @end smallexample
9958
9959 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9960 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9961 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9962 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9963 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9964 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9965 debugged, enter:
9966
9967 @smallexample
9968 break -[Fruit create]
9969 @end smallexample
9970
9971 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9972 enter:
9973
9974 @smallexample
9975 list +[NSText initialize]
9976 @end smallexample
9977
9978 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9979 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9980 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9981 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9982
9983 @smallexample
9984 break create
9985 @end smallexample
9986
9987 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9988 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9989 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9990 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9991 none apply.
9992
9993 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9994 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9995
9996 @smallexample
9997 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9998 @end smallexample
9999
10000 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
10001 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10002 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
10003 @kindex print-object
10004 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10005
10006 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10007
10008 @smallexample
10009 print -[@var{object} hash]
10010 @end smallexample
10011
10012 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
10013 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10014 @noindent
10015 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10016 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10017 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10018 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10019 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10020 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10021
10022 @node Fortran
10023 @subsection Fortran
10024 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10025
10026 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10027 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10028
10029 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10030 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10031 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10032 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10033 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10034 underscore.
10035
10036 @menu
10037 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10038 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10039 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10040 @end menu
10041
10042 @node Fortran Operators
10043 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
10044
10045 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
10046
10047 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10048 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
10049 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
10050
10051 @table @code
10052 @item **
10053 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
10054 of the second one.
10055
10056 @item :
10057 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
10058 represent a section of array.
10059
10060 @item %
10061 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
10062 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
10063 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
10064 union type.
10065 @end table
10066
10067 @node Fortran Defaults
10068 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
10069
10070 @cindex Fortran Defaults
10071
10072 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
10073 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
10074 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
10075 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
10076
10077 @node Special Fortran Commands
10078 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
10079
10080 @cindex Special Fortran commands
10081
10082 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
10083 such as displaying common blocks.
10084
10085 @table @code
10086 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
10087 @kindex info common
10088 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
10089 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
10090 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
10091 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
10092 printed.
10093 @end table
10094
10095 @node Pascal
10096 @subsection Pascal
10097
10098 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
10099 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
10100 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
10101 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
10102 syntax.
10103
10104 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
10105 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
10106 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
10107
10108 @node Modula-2
10109 @subsection Modula-2
10110
10111 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
10112
10113 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
10114 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
10115 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
10116 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10117 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
10118 table.
10119
10120 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
10121 @menu
10122 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
10123 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
10124 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
10125 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
10126 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
10127 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
10128 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10129 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10130 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10131 @end menu
10132
10133 @node M2 Operators
10134 @subsubsection Operators
10135 @cindex Modula-2 operators
10136
10137 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10138 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10139 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10140 following definitions hold:
10141
10142 @itemize @bullet
10143
10144 @item
10145 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10146 their subranges.
10147
10148 @item
10149 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10150
10151 @item
10152 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10153
10154 @item
10155 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10156 @var{type}}.
10157
10158 @item
10159 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10160
10161 @item
10162 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10163
10164 @item
10165 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10166 @end itemize
10167
10168 @noindent
10169 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10170 increasing precedence:
10171
10172 @table @code
10173 @item ,
10174 Function argument or array index separator.
10175
10176 @item :=
10177 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10178 @var{value}.
10179
10180 @item <@r{, }>
10181 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10182 types.
10183
10184 @item <=@r{, }>=
10185 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10186 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10187 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10188
10189 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10190 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10191 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10192 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10193 comment character.
10194
10195 @item IN
10196 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10197 Same precedence as @code{<}.
10198
10199 @item OR
10200 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10201
10202 @item AND@r{, }&
10203 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10204
10205 @item @@
10206 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10207
10208 @item +@r{, }-
10209 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10210 and difference on set types.
10211
10212 @item *
10213 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10214 on set types.
10215
10216 @item /
10217 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10218 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10219
10220 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10221 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10222 precedence as @code{*}.
10223
10224 @item -
10225 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10226
10227 @item ^
10228 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10229
10230 @item NOT
10231 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10232 @code{^}.
10233
10234 @item .
10235 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10236 precedence as @code{^}.
10237
10238 @item []
10239 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10240
10241 @item ()
10242 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10243 as @code{^}.
10244
10245 @item ::@r{, }.
10246 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10247 @end table
10248
10249 @quotation
10250 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10251 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10252 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10253 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10254 @end quotation
10255
10256
10257 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10258 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10259 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10260
10261 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10262 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10263
10264 @table @var
10265
10266 @item a
10267 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10268
10269 @item c
10270 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10271
10272 @item i
10273 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10274
10275 @item m
10276 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10277 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10278 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10279
10280 @item n
10281 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10282
10283 @item r
10284 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10285
10286 @item t
10287 represents a type.
10288
10289 @item v
10290 represents a variable.
10291
10292 @item x
10293 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10294 explanation of the function for details.
10295 @end table
10296
10297 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10298
10299 @table @code
10300 @item ABS(@var{n})
10301 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10302
10303 @item CAP(@var{c})
10304 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10305 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10306
10307 @item CHR(@var{i})
10308 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10309
10310 @item DEC(@var{v})
10311 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10312
10313 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10314 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10315 new value.
10316
10317 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10318 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10319 set.
10320
10321 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10322 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10323
10324 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10325 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10326
10327 @item INC(@var{v})
10328 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10329
10330 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10331 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10332 new value.
10333
10334 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10335 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10336 there. Returns the new set.
10337
10338 @item MAX(@var{t})
10339 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10340
10341 @item MIN(@var{t})
10342 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10343
10344 @item ODD(@var{i})
10345 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10346
10347 @item ORD(@var{x})
10348 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10349 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10350 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10351 integral, character and enumerated types.
10352
10353 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10354 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10355
10356 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10357 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10358
10359 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10360 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10361
10362 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10363 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10364 @end table
10365
10366 @quotation
10367 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10368 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10369 an error.
10370 @end quotation
10371
10372 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10373 @node M2 Constants
10374 @subsubsection Constants
10375
10376 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10377 ways:
10378
10379 @itemize @bullet
10380
10381 @item
10382 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10383 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10384 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10385 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10386
10387 @item
10388 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10389 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10390 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10391 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10392 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10393 digits.
10394
10395 @item
10396 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10397 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10398 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10399 followed by a @samp{C}.
10400
10401 @item
10402 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10403 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10404 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10405 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10406 sequences.
10407
10408 @item
10409 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10410
10411 @item
10412 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10413 @code{FALSE}.
10414
10415 @item
10416 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10417
10418 @item
10419 Set constants are not yet supported.
10420 @end itemize
10421
10422 @node M2 Types
10423 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10424 @cindex Modula-2 types
10425
10426 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10427 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10428 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10429 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10430 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10431 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10432
10433 The first example contains the following section of code:
10434
10435 @smallexample
10436 VAR
10437 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10438 r: [20..40] ;
10439 @end smallexample
10440
10441 @noindent
10442 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10443 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10444
10445 @smallexample
10446 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10447 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10448 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10449 SET OF CHAR
10450 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10451 21
10452 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10453 [20..40]
10454 @end smallexample
10455
10456 @noindent
10457 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10458
10459 @smallexample
10460 VAR
10461 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10462 @end smallexample
10463
10464 @noindent
10465 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10466
10467 @smallexample
10468 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10469 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10470 @end smallexample
10471
10472 @noindent
10473 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10474 expressions using the debugger.
10475
10476 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10477 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10478
10479 @smallexample
10480 VAR
10481 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10482 @end smallexample
10483
10484 @smallexample
10485 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10486 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10487 @end smallexample
10488
10489 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10490 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10491 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10492 above.
10493
10494 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10495
10496 @smallexample
10497 TYPE
10498 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10499 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10500 VAR
10501 s: t ;
10502 BEGIN
10503 s := blue ;
10504 @end smallexample
10505
10506 @noindent
10507 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10508 and value of a variable.
10509
10510 @smallexample
10511 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10512 $1 = blue
10513 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10514 type = [blue..yellow]
10515 @end smallexample
10516
10517 @noindent
10518 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10519 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10520 their @code{C} counterparts.
10521
10522 @smallexample
10523 VAR
10524 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10525 BEGIN
10526 s[1] := 1 ;
10527 @end smallexample
10528
10529 @smallexample
10530 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10531 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10532 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10533 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10534 @end smallexample
10535
10536 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10537 pointer types as shown in this example:
10538
10539 @smallexample
10540 VAR
10541 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10542 BEGIN
10543 NEW(s) ;
10544 s^[1] := 1 ;
10545 @end smallexample
10546
10547 @noindent
10548 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10549
10550 @smallexample
10551 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10552 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10553 @end smallexample
10554
10555 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10556 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10557 types:
10558
10559 @smallexample
10560 TYPE
10561 foo = RECORD
10562 f1: CARDINAL ;
10563 f2: CHAR ;
10564 f3: myarray ;
10565 END ;
10566
10567 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10568 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10569 VAR
10570 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10571 @end smallexample
10572
10573 @noindent
10574 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10575 below.
10576
10577 @smallexample
10578 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10579 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10580 f1 : CARDINAL;
10581 f2 : CHAR;
10582 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10583 END
10584 @end smallexample
10585
10586 @node M2 Defaults
10587 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10588 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10589
10590 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10591 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10592 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10593 selected the working language.
10594
10595 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10596 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10597 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10598 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10599
10600 @node Deviations
10601 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10602 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10603
10604 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10605 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10606
10607 @itemize @bullet
10608 @item
10609 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10610 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10611 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10612 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10613 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10614 returned a pointer.)
10615
10616 @item
10617 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10618 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10619 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10620 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10621
10622 @item
10623 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10624 argument.
10625
10626 @item
10627 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10628 @end itemize
10629
10630 @node M2 Checks
10631 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10632 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10633
10634 @quotation
10635 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10636 range checking.
10637 @end quotation
10638 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10639
10640 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10641
10642 @itemize @bullet
10643 @item
10644 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10645 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10646
10647 @item
10648 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10649 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10650 @end itemize
10651
10652 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10653 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10654
10655 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10656 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10657
10658 @node M2 Scope
10659 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10660 @cindex scope
10661 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10662 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10663 @ifinfo
10664 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10665 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10666 @end ifinfo
10667 @iftex
10668 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10669 @end iftex
10670
10671 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10672 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10673 similar syntax:
10674
10675 @smallexample
10676
10677 @var{module} . @var{id}
10678 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10679 @end smallexample
10680
10681 @noindent
10682 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10683 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10684 identifier within your program, except another module.
10685
10686 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10687 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10688 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10689 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10690
10691 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10692 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10693 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10694 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10695 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10696 @var{module}.
10697
10698 @node GDB/M2
10699 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10700
10701 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10702 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10703 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10704 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10705 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10706 analogue in Modula-2.
10707
10708 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10709 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10710 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10711 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10712 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10713 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10714
10715 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10716 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10717 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10718
10719 @node Ada
10720 @subsection Ada
10721 @cindex Ada
10722
10723 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10724 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10725 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10726 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10727 to be difficult.
10728
10729
10730 @cindex expressions in Ada
10731 @menu
10732 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10733 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10734 in @value{GDBN}.
10735 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10736 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10737 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10738 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10739 @end menu
10740
10741 @node Ada Mode Intro
10742 @subsubsection Introduction
10743 @cindex Ada mode, general
10744
10745 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10746 syntax, with some extensions.
10747 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10748
10749 @itemize @bullet
10750 @item
10751 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10752 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10753 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10754 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10755
10756 @item
10757 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10758 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10759
10760 @item
10761 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10762 @end itemize
10763
10764 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10765 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10766 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10767 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10768 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10769
10770 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10771 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10772 was translated from an Ada source file.
10773
10774 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10775 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10776 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10777 middle (to allow based literals).
10778
10779 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10780 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10781 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10782 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10783 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10784 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10785
10786 @node Omissions from Ada
10787 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10788 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10789
10790 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10791
10792 @itemize @bullet
10793 @item
10794 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10795
10796 @itemize @minus
10797 @item
10798 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10799 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10800
10801 @item
10802 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10803
10804 @item
10805 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10806
10807 @item
10808 @t{'Tag}.
10809
10810 @item
10811 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10812 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10813
10814 @item
10815 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10816 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10817
10818 @item
10819 @t{'Address}.
10820 @end itemize
10821
10822 @item
10823 The names in
10824 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10825 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10826 not currently available.
10827
10828 @item
10829 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10830 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10831 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10832 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10833 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10834 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10835 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10836 indeterminate values.
10837
10838 @item
10839 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10840 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10841 are not implemented.
10842
10843 @item
10844 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10845 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10846 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10847 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10848 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10849
10850 @smallexample
10851 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10852 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10853 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10854 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10855 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10856 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10857 @end smallexample
10858
10859 Changing a
10860 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10861 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10862 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10863 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10864 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10865 declared to have a type such as:
10866
10867 @smallexample
10868 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10869 Id : Integer;
10870 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10871 end record;
10872 @end smallexample
10873
10874 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10875 assignments:
10876
10877 @smallexample
10878 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10879 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10880 @end smallexample
10881
10882 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10883 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10884 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10885 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10886 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10887 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10888 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10889 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10890
10891 @item
10892 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10893
10894 @item
10895 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10896 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10897 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10898 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10899 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10900 the proper resolution.
10901
10902 @item
10903 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10904
10905 @item
10906 Entry calls are not implemented.
10907
10908 @item
10909 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10910 formats are not supported.
10911
10912 @item
10913 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10914 @end itemize
10915
10916 @node Additions to Ada
10917 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10918 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10919
10920 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10921 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10922
10923 @itemize @bullet
10924 @item
10925 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10926 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10927 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10928 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10929 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10930 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10931 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10932 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10933
10934 @item
10935 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10936 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10937 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10938
10939 @item
10940 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10941 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10942
10943 @item
10944 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10945 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10946 @end itemize
10947
10948 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10949 additions specific to Ada:
10950
10951 @itemize @bullet
10952 @item
10953 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10954 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10955
10956 @smallexample
10957 set x := y + 3
10958 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10959 @end smallexample
10960
10961 @item
10962 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10963 the value of its right-hand operand.
10964 This allows, for example,
10965 complex conditional breaks:
10966
10967 @smallexample
10968 break f
10969 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10970 @end smallexample
10971
10972 @item
10973 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10974 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10975 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10976 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10977 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10978 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10979 in strings. For example,
10980 @smallexample
10981 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10982 @end smallexample
10983 @noindent
10984 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10985 after each period.
10986
10987 @item
10988 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10989 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10990 to write
10991
10992 @smallexample
10993 print 'max(x, y)
10994 @end smallexample
10995
10996 @item
10997 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10998 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10999 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11000 of 3 might print as
11001
11002 @smallexample
11003 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
11004 @end smallexample
11005
11006 @noindent
11007 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11008 clause.
11009
11010 @item
11011 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11012 multi-character subsequence of
11013 their names (an exact match gets preference).
11014 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11015 in place of @t{a'length}.
11016
11017 @item
11018 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11019 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11020 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11021 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11022 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11023 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11024 For example,
11025 @smallexample
11026 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11027 @end smallexample
11028
11029 @item
11030 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11031 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11032 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11033 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
11034 object.
11035
11036 @end itemize
11037
11038 @node Stopping Before Main Program
11039 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
11040
11041 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
11042 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
11043 before reaching the main procedure.
11044 As defined in the Ada Reference
11045 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
11046 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
11047 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
11048 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
11049
11050 @node Ada Glitches
11051 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
11052 @cindex Ada, problems
11053
11054 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
11055 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
11056 @value{GDBN},
11057 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
11058 and the GNU Ada compiler.
11059
11060 @itemize @bullet
11061 @item
11062 Currently, the debugger
11063 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
11064 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
11065 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
11066 to get it printed properly.
11067
11068 @item
11069 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
11070 storage are invisible to the debugger.
11071
11072 @item
11073 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
11074 argument lists are treated as positional).
11075
11076 @item
11077 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
11078
11079 @item
11080 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
11081 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
11082 the host machine.
11083
11084 @item
11085 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
11086
11087 @item
11088 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
11089 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
11090 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
11091 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
11092 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
11093 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
11094 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
11095 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
11096 you can usually resolve the confusion
11097 by qualifying the problematic names with package
11098 @code{Standard} explicitly.
11099 @end itemize
11100
11101 @node Unsupported Languages
11102 @section Unsupported Languages
11103
11104 @cindex unsupported languages
11105 @cindex minimal language
11106 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
11107 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
11108 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
11109 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
11110 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
11111 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
11112
11113 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
11114 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
11115 language.
11116
11117 @node Symbols
11118 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
11119
11120 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
11121 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
11122 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
11123 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
11124 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
11125 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
11126 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
11127
11128 @cindex symbol names
11129 @cindex names of symbols
11130 @cindex quoting names
11131 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
11132 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
11133 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
11134 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
11135 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
11136 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
11137 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
11138 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
11139
11140 @smallexample
11141 p 'foo.c'::x
11142 @end smallexample
11143
11144 @noindent
11145 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
11146
11147 @table @code
11148 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
11149 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
11150 @kindex set case-sensitive
11151 @item set case-sensitive on
11152 @itemx set case-sensitive off
11153 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
11154 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
11155 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
11156 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
11157 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
11158 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
11159 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
11160 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
11161 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
11162 case-insensitive matches.
11163
11164 @kindex show case-sensitive
11165 @item show case-sensitive
11166 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
11167 lookups.
11168
11169 @kindex info address
11170 @cindex address of a symbol
11171 @item info address @var{symbol}
11172 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
11173 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
11174 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
11175 is always stored.
11176
11177 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
11178 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
11179 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
11180
11181 @kindex info symbol
11182 @cindex symbol from address
11183 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
11184 @item info symbol @var{addr}
11185 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
11186 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
11187 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
11188
11189 @smallexample
11190 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
11191 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
11192 @end smallexample
11193
11194 @noindent
11195 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
11196 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
11197
11198 @kindex whatis
11199 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
11200 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
11201 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
11202 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
11203 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
11204 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
11205 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
11206 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
11207 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
11208 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
11209 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11210
11211 @kindex ptype
11212 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
11213 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
11214 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
11215 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11216
11217 For example, for this variable declaration:
11218
11219 @smallexample
11220 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
11221 @end smallexample
11222
11223 @noindent
11224 the two commands give this output:
11225
11226 @smallexample
11227 @group
11228 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
11229 type = struct complex
11230 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
11231 type = struct complex @{
11232 double real;
11233 double imag;
11234 @}
11235 @end group
11236 @end smallexample
11237
11238 @noindent
11239 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11240 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11241
11242 @cindex incomplete type
11243 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11244 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11245 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11246 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11247 given these declarations:
11248
11249 @smallexample
11250 struct foo;
11251 struct foo *fooptr;
11252 @end smallexample
11253
11254 @noindent
11255 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11256
11257 @smallexample
11258 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11259 $1 = <incomplete type>
11260 @end smallexample
11261
11262 @noindent
11263 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11264 completely specified.
11265
11266 @kindex info types
11267 @item info types @var{regexp}
11268 @itemx info types
11269 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11270 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11271 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11272 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11273 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11274 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11275 name is @code{value}.
11276
11277 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11278 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11279 lists all source files where a type is defined.
11280
11281 @kindex info scope
11282 @cindex local variables
11283 @item info scope @var{location}
11284 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11285 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11286 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11287 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11288 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11289
11290 @smallexample
11291 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11292 Scope for command_line_handler:
11293 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11294 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11295 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11296 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11297 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11298 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11299 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11300 @end smallexample
11301
11302 @noindent
11303 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11304 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11305 collect}.
11306
11307 @kindex info source
11308 @item info source
11309 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11310 the function containing the current point of execution:
11311 @itemize @bullet
11312 @item
11313 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11314 @item
11315 the directory it was compiled in,
11316 @item
11317 its length, in lines,
11318 @item
11319 which programming language it is written in,
11320 @item
11321 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11322 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11323 @item
11324 whether the debugging information includes information about
11325 preprocessor macros.
11326 @end itemize
11327
11328
11329 @kindex info sources
11330 @item info sources
11331 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11332 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11333 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11334
11335 @kindex info functions
11336 @item info functions
11337 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11338
11339 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11340 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11341 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11342 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11343 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11344 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11345 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11346 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11347
11348 @kindex info variables
11349 @item info variables
11350 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11351 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11352
11353 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11354 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11355 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11356 @var{regexp}.
11357
11358 @kindex info classes
11359 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11360 @item info classes
11361 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11362 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11363 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11364 expression.
11365
11366 @kindex info selectors
11367 @item info selectors
11368 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11369 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11370 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11371 expression.
11372
11373 @ignore
11374 This was never implemented.
11375 @kindex info methods
11376 @item info methods
11377 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11378 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11379 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11380 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11381 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11382 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11383 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11384 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11385 @end ignore
11386
11387 @cindex reloading symbols
11388 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11389 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11390 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11391 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11392 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11393
11394 @table @code
11395 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11396 @item set symbol-reloading on
11397 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11398 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11399
11400 @item set symbol-reloading off
11401 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11402 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11403 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11404 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11405 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11406 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11407 name.
11408
11409 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11410 @item show symbol-reloading
11411 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11412 @end table
11413
11414 @cindex opaque data types
11415 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11416 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11417 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11418 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11419 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11420 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11421 another source file. The default is on.
11422
11423 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11424 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11425
11426 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11427 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11428 is printed as follows:
11429 @smallexample
11430 @{<no data fields>@}
11431 @end smallexample
11432
11433 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11434 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11435 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11436
11437 @kindex maint print symbols
11438 @cindex symbol dump
11439 @kindex maint print psymbols
11440 @cindex partial symbol dump
11441 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11442 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11443 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11444 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11445 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11446 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11447 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11448 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11449 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11450 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11451 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11452 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11453 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11454 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11455 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11456 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11457 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11458
11459 @kindex maint info symtabs
11460 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11461 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11462 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11463 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11464 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11465 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11466 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11467
11468 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11469 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11470 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11471 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11472 structure in more detail. For example:
11473
11474 @smallexample
11475 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11476 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11477 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11478 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11479 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11480 readin no
11481 fullname (null)
11482 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11483 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11484 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11485 dependencies (none)
11486 @}
11487 @}
11488 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11489 (@value{GDBP})
11490 @end smallexample
11491 @noindent
11492 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11493 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11494 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11495 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11496 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11497
11498 @smallexample
11499 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11500 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11501 line 1574.
11502 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11503 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11504 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11505 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11506 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11507 dirname (null)
11508 fullname (null)
11509 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11510 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11511 debugformat DWARF 2
11512 @}
11513 @}
11514 (@value{GDBP})
11515 @end smallexample
11516 @end table
11517
11518
11519 @node Altering
11520 @chapter Altering Execution
11521
11522 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11523 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11524 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11525 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11526 program.
11527
11528 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11529 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11530 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11531
11532 @menu
11533 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11534 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11535 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11536 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11537 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11538 * Patching:: Patching your program
11539 @end menu
11540
11541 @node Assignment
11542 @section Assignment to Variables
11543
11544 @cindex assignment
11545 @cindex setting variables
11546 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11547 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11548
11549 @smallexample
11550 print x=4
11551 @end smallexample
11552
11553 @noindent
11554 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11555 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11556 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11557 information on operators in supported languages.
11558
11559 @kindex set variable
11560 @cindex variables, setting
11561 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11562 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11563 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11564 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11565 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11566
11567 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11568 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11569 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11570 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11571 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11572 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11573 command @code{set width}:
11574
11575 @smallexample
11576 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11577 type = double
11578 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11579 $4 = 13
11580 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11581 Invalid syntax in expression.
11582 @end smallexample
11583
11584 @noindent
11585 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11586 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11587
11588 @smallexample
11589 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11590 @end smallexample
11591
11592 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11593 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11594 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11595 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11596 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11597 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11598
11599 @smallexample
11600 @group
11601 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11602 type = double
11603 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11604 $1 = 1
11605 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11606 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11607 $2 = 1
11608 (@value{GDBP}) r
11609 The program being debugged has been started already.
11610 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11611 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11612 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11613 Invalid bfd target.
11614 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11615 The current BFD target is "=4".
11616 @end group
11617 @end smallexample
11618
11619 @noindent
11620 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11621 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11622 @code{g}, use
11623
11624 @smallexample
11625 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11626 @end smallexample
11627
11628 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11629 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11630 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11631 same length or shorter.
11632 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11633 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11634
11635 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11636 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11637 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11638 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11639 and representation in memory), and
11640
11641 @smallexample
11642 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11643 @end smallexample
11644
11645 @noindent
11646 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11647
11648 @node Jumping
11649 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11650
11651 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11652 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11653 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11654
11655 @table @code
11656 @kindex jump
11657 @item jump @var{linespec}
11658 @itemx jump @var{location}
11659 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
11660 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
11661 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
11662 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
11663 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
11664 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11665
11666 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11667 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11668 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11669 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11670 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11671 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11672 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11673 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11674 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11675 @end table
11676
11677 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11678 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11679 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11680 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11681 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11682 example,
11683
11684 @smallexample
11685 set $pc = 0x485
11686 @end smallexample
11687
11688 @noindent
11689 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11690 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11691 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11692
11693 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11694 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11695 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11696 detail.
11697
11698 @c @group
11699 @node Signaling
11700 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11701 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11702
11703 @table @code
11704 @kindex signal
11705 @item signal @var{signal}
11706 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11707 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11708 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11709 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11710
11711 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11712 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11713 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11714 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11715 signal.
11716
11717 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11718 after executing the command.
11719 @end table
11720 @c @end group
11721
11722 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11723 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11724 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11725 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11726 passes the signal directly to your program.
11727
11728
11729 @node Returning
11730 @section Returning from a Function
11731
11732 @table @code
11733 @cindex returning from a function
11734 @kindex return
11735 @item return
11736 @itemx return @var{expression}
11737 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11738 command. If you give an
11739 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11740 value.
11741 @end table
11742
11743 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11744 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11745 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11746 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11747
11748 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11749 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11750 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11751 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11752 of functions.
11753
11754 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11755 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11756 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11757 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11758 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11759
11760 @node Calling
11761 @section Calling Program Functions
11762
11763 @table @code
11764 @cindex calling functions
11765 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11766 @item print @var{expr}
11767 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11768 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11769 debugged.
11770
11771 @kindex call
11772 @item call @var{expr}
11773 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11774 returned values.
11775
11776 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11777 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11778 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11779 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11780 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11781 value history.
11782 @end table
11783
11784 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11785 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11786 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11787 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11788
11789 @table @code
11790 @item set unwindonsignal
11791 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11792 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11793 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11794 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11795 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11796 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11797 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11798 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11799 received.
11800
11801 @item show unwindonsignal
11802 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11803 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11804 @value{GDBN}.
11805 @end table
11806
11807 @cindex weak alias functions
11808 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11809 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11810 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11811 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11812 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11813 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11814 function instead.
11815
11816 @node Patching
11817 @section Patching Programs
11818
11819 @cindex patching binaries
11820 @cindex writing into executables
11821 @cindex writing into corefiles
11822
11823 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11824 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11825 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11826 patching your program's binary.
11827
11828 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11829 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11830 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11831 repairs.
11832
11833 @table @code
11834 @kindex set write
11835 @item set write on
11836 @itemx set write off
11837 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11838 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11839 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11840
11841 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11842 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11843 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11844
11845 @item show write
11846 @kindex show write
11847 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11848 as well as reading.
11849 @end table
11850
11851 @node GDB Files
11852 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11853
11854 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11855 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11856 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11857 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11858
11859 @menu
11860 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11861 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11862 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11863 @end menu
11864
11865 @node Files
11866 @section Commands to Specify Files
11867
11868 @cindex symbol table
11869 @cindex core dump file
11870
11871 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11872 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11873 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11874 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11875
11876 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11877 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11878 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11879 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11880 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11881 new files are useful.
11882
11883 @table @code
11884 @cindex executable file
11885 @kindex file
11886 @item file @var{filename}
11887 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11888 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11889 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11890 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11891 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11892 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11893 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11894 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11895
11896 @cindex unlinked object files
11897 @cindex patching object files
11898 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11899 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11900 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11901 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11902 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11903 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11904 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11905 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11906
11907 @item file
11908 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11909 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11910
11911 @kindex exec-file
11912 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11913 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11914 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11915 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11916 discard information on the executable file.
11917
11918 @kindex symbol-file
11919 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11920 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11921 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11922 table and program to run from the same file.
11923
11924 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11925 program's symbol table.
11926
11927 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11928 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11929 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11930 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11931 @value{GDBN}.
11932
11933 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11934 executing it once.
11935
11936 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11937 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11938 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11939 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11940 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11941 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11942 optimized code.
11943
11944 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11945 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11946 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11947 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11948 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11949
11950 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11951 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11952 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11953 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11954 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11955 Warnings and Messages}.)
11956
11957 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11958 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11959 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11960 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11961 in stabs format.
11962
11963 @kindex readnow
11964 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11965 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11966 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11967 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11968 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11969 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11970 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11971 entire symbol table available.
11972
11973 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11974 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11975 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11976 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11977 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11978 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11979 @c files.
11980
11981 @kindex core-file
11982 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11983 @itemx core
11984 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11985 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11986 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11987 executable file itself for other parts.
11988
11989 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11990 to be used.
11991
11992 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11993 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11994 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11995 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11996 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11997
11998 @kindex add-symbol-file
11999 @cindex dynamic linking
12000 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
12001 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12002 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
12003 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
12004 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
12005 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
12006 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
12007 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
12008 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
12009 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
12010 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
12011 @var{address} as an expression.
12012
12013 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
12014 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
12015 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
12016 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
12017 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
12018
12019 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
12020 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
12021 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
12022 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
12023 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
12024 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
12025 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
12026 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
12027 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
12028
12029 @itemize @bullet
12030 @item
12031 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
12032 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
12033 @item
12034 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
12035 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
12036 @item
12037 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
12038 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12039 @end itemize
12040
12041 @noindent
12042 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
12043 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
12044 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
12045 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
12046 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
12047 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
12048 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
12049 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
12050 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
12051 way.
12052
12053 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
12054
12055 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
12056 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
12057 @cindex load symbols from memory
12058 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
12059 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
12060 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
12061 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
12062 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
12063 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
12064 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
12065 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
12066 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
12067
12068 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
12069 @kindex assf
12070 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
12071 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
12072 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
12073 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
12074 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
12075 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
12076 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
12077 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
12078 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
12079 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
12080
12081 @kindex section
12082 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
12083 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
12084 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
12085 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
12086 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
12087 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
12088 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
12089 their addresses.
12090
12091 @kindex info files
12092 @kindex info target
12093 @item info files
12094 @itemx info target
12095 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
12096 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
12097 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
12098 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
12099 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
12100 current ones.
12101
12102 @kindex maint info sections
12103 @item maint info sections
12104 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
12105 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
12106 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
12107 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
12108 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
12109 may be arbitrarily combined):
12110
12111 @table @code
12112 @item ALLOBJ
12113 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
12114 @item @var{sections}
12115 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
12116 @item @var{section-flags}
12117 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
12118 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
12119 @table @code
12120 @item ALLOC
12121 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
12122 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
12123 @item LOAD
12124 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
12125 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
12126 @item RELOC
12127 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
12128 @item READONLY
12129 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
12130 @item CODE
12131 Section contains executable code only.
12132 @item DATA
12133 Section contains data only (no executable code).
12134 @item ROM
12135 Section will reside in ROM.
12136 @item CONSTRUCTOR
12137 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
12138 @item HAS_CONTENTS
12139 Section is not empty.
12140 @item NEVER_LOAD
12141 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
12142 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
12143 A notification to the linker that the section contains
12144 COFF shared library information.
12145 @item IS_COMMON
12146 Section contains common symbols.
12147 @end table
12148 @end table
12149 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
12150 @cindex read-only sections
12151 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
12152 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
12153 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
12154 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
12155 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
12156 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
12157 enhancement to debugging performance.
12158
12159 The default is off.
12160
12161 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
12162 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
12163 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
12164 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
12165
12166 @item show trust-readonly-sections
12167 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
12168 @end table
12169
12170 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
12171 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
12172 name and remembers it that way.
12173
12174 @cindex shared libraries
12175 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
12176 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
12177 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
12178
12179 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
12180 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
12181
12182 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
12183 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
12184 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
12185 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
12186 debugging a core file).
12187
12188 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
12189 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
12190
12191 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
12192 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
12193 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
12194
12195 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
12196 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
12197 particularly large or there are many of them.
12198
12199 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
12200 commands:
12201
12202 @table @code
12203 @kindex set auto-solib-add
12204 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
12205 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
12206 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
12207 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
12208 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
12209 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
12210 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
12211
12212 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
12213 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
12214 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
12215 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
12216 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
12217 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
12218 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
12219 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
12220 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
12221
12222 @kindex show auto-solib-add
12223 @item show auto-solib-add
12224 Display the current autoloading mode.
12225 @end table
12226
12227 @cindex load shared library
12228 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
12229 command:
12230
12231 @table @code
12232 @kindex info sharedlibrary
12233 @kindex info share
12234 @item info share
12235 @itemx info sharedlibrary
12236 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
12237
12238 @kindex sharedlibrary
12239 @kindex share
12240 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
12241 @itemx share @var{regex}
12242 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
12243 Unix regular expression.
12244 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
12245 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
12246 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12247 loaded.
12248
12249 @item nosharedlibrary
12250 @kindex nosharedlibrary
12251 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12252 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12253 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12254 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12255 discarded.
12256 @end table
12257
12258 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12259 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12260 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12261
12262 @table @code
12263 @item set stop-on-solib-events
12264 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12265 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12266 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12267 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12268 shared library.
12269
12270 @item show stop-on-solib-events
12271 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12272 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12273 library events happen.
12274 @end table
12275
12276 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12277 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
12278 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12279 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12280 not.
12281
12282 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
12283 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12284 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12285 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12286 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12287
12288 @table @code
12289 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
12290 @cindex system root, alternate
12291 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12292 @kindex set sysroot
12293 @item set sysroot @var{path}
12294 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12295 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12296 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12297 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12298 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12299 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12300 under @var{path}.
12301
12302 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12303 sysroot}.
12304
12305 @cindex default system root
12306 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12307 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12308 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12309 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12310 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12311 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12312 location.
12313
12314 @kindex show sysroot
12315 @item show sysroot
12316 Display the current shared library prefix.
12317
12318 @kindex set solib-search-path
12319 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12320 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12321 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12322 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12323 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12324 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12325 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12326 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12327 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12328 of shared library symbols.
12329
12330 @kindex show solib-search-path
12331 @item show solib-search-path
12332 Display the current shared library search path.
12333 @end table
12334
12335
12336 @node Separate Debug Files
12337 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12338 @cindex separate debugging information files
12339 @cindex debugging information in separate files
12340 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12341 @cindex debugging information directory, global
12342 @cindex global debugging information directory
12343 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12344 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12345
12346 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12347 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12348 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12349 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12350 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12351 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12352 install only when they need to debug a problem.
12353
12354 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12355 file:
12356
12357 @itemize @bullet
12358 @item
12359 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12360 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12361 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12362 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12363 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12364 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12365 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12366 came from the same build.
12367
12368 @item
12369 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12370 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12371 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12372 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12373 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12374 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12375 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12376 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12377 below.
12378 @end itemize
12379
12380 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12381 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12382
12383 @itemize @bullet
12384 @item
12385 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12386 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12387 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12388 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12389 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12390
12391 @item
12392 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12393 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12394 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12395 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12396 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12397 hex characters, not 10.)
12398 @end itemize
12399
12400 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12401 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12402 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12403 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12404 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12405 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12406
12407 @itemize @minus
12408 @item
12409 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12410 @item
12411 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12412 @item
12413 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12414 @item
12415 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12416 @end itemize
12417
12418 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12419 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12420
12421 @table @code
12422
12423 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12424 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12425 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12426 information files to @var{directory}.
12427
12428 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12429 @item show debug-file-directory
12430 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12431 information files.
12432
12433 @end table
12434
12435 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12436 @cindex debug link sections
12437 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12438 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12439
12440 @itemize
12441 @item
12442 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12443 a zero byte,
12444 @item
12445 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12446 boundary within the section, and
12447 @item
12448 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12449 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12450 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12451 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12452 @end itemize
12453
12454 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12455 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12456 described above.
12457
12458 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12459 @cindex build ID sections
12460 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12461 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12462 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12463 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12464 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12465 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12466 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12467 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12468 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12469
12470 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12471 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12472 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12473 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12474 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12475 in an ordinary executable.
12476
12477 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12478 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12479 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12480 following commands:
12481
12482 @smallexample
12483 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12484 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12485 @end smallexample
12486
12487 @noindent
12488 These commands remove the debugging
12489 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12490 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12491 two files:
12492
12493 @itemize @bullet
12494 @item
12495 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12496 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12497
12498 @smallexample
12499 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12500 @end smallexample
12501
12502 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12503 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12504 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12505 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12506
12507 @item
12508 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12509 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12510 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12511 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12512 @end itemize
12513
12514 @noindent
12515
12516 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12517 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12518 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12519 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12520
12521 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12522 @smallexample
12523 unsigned long
12524 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12525 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12526 @{
12527 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12528 @{
12529 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12530 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12531 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12532 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12533 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12534 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12535 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12536 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12537 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12538 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12539 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12540 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12541 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12542 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12543 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12544 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12545 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12546 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12547 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12548 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12549 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12550 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12551 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12552 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12553 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12554 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12555 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12556 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12557 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12558 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12559 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12560 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12561 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12562 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12563 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12564 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12565 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12566 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12567 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12568 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12569 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12570 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12571 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12572 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12573 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12574 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12575 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12576 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12577 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12578 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12579 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12580 0x2d02ef8d
12581 @};
12582 unsigned char *end;
12583
12584 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12585 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12586 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12587 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12588 @}
12589 @end smallexample
12590
12591 @noindent
12592 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12593
12594
12595 @node Symbol Errors
12596 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12597
12598 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12599 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12600 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12601 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12602 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12603 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12604 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12605 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12606 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12607 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12608 Messages}).
12609
12610 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12611
12612 @table @code
12613 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12614
12615 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12616 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12617 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12618 in its outer scope blocks.
12619
12620 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12621 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12622 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12623 function.
12624
12625 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12626
12627 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12628 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12629 do so.
12630
12631 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12632 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12633 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12634 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12635 Messages}.)
12636
12637 @item bad block start address patched
12638
12639 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12640 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12641 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12642
12643 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12644 starting on the previous source line.
12645
12646 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12647
12648 @cindex foo
12649 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12650 larger than the size of the string table.
12651
12652 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12653 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12654 with this name.
12655
12656 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12657
12658 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12659 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12660 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12661
12662 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12663 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12664 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12665 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12666 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12667 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12668
12669 @item stub type has NULL name
12670
12671 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12672
12673 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12674 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12675 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12676 it.
12677
12678 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12679
12680 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12681
12682 @end table
12683
12684 @node Targets
12685 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12686
12687 @cindex debugging target
12688 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12689
12690 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12691 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12692 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12693 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12694 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12695 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12696 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12697 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12698
12699 @cindex target architecture
12700 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12701 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12702 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12703 command.
12704
12705 @table @code
12706 @kindex set architecture
12707 @kindex show architecture
12708 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12709 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12710 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12711 supported architectures.
12712
12713 @item show architecture
12714 Show the current target architecture.
12715
12716 @item set processor
12717 @itemx processor
12718 @kindex set processor
12719 @kindex show processor
12720 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12721 and @code{show architecture}.
12722 @end table
12723
12724 @menu
12725 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12726 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12727 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12728 @end menu
12729
12730 @node Active Targets
12731 @section Active Targets
12732
12733 @cindex stacking targets
12734 @cindex active targets
12735 @cindex multiple targets
12736
12737 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12738 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12739 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12740 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12741 a core file.
12742
12743 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12744 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12745 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12746 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12747 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12748 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12749 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12750 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12751 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12752
12753 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12754 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12755 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12756 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12757 process target is active.
12758
12759 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12760 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12761 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12762 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12763 Process}).
12764
12765 @node Target Commands
12766 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12767
12768 @table @code
12769 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12770 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12771 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12772 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12773 protocol of the target machine.
12774
12775 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12776 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12777 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12778
12779 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12780 after executing the command.
12781
12782 @kindex help target
12783 @item help target
12784 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12785 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12786 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12787
12788 @item help target @var{name}
12789 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12790 select it.
12791
12792 @kindex set gnutarget
12793 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12794 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12795 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12796 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12797 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12798 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12799
12800 @quotation
12801 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12802 you must know the actual BFD name.
12803 @end quotation
12804
12805 @noindent
12806 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12807
12808 @kindex show gnutarget
12809 @item show gnutarget
12810 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12811 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12812 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12813 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12814 @end table
12815
12816 @cindex common targets
12817 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12818 configuration):
12819
12820 @table @code
12821 @kindex target
12822 @item target exec @var{program}
12823 @cindex executable file target
12824 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12825 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12826
12827 @item target core @var{filename}
12828 @cindex core dump file target
12829 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12830 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12831
12832 @item target remote @var{medium}
12833 @cindex remote target
12834 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12835 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12836 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12837
12838 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12839 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12840
12841 @smallexample
12842 target remote /dev/ttya
12843 @end smallexample
12844
12845 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12846 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12847 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12848 clobbered by the download.
12849
12850 @item target sim
12851 @cindex built-in simulator target
12852 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12853 In general,
12854 @smallexample
12855 target sim
12856 load
12857 run
12858 @end smallexample
12859 @noindent
12860 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12861 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12862 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12863 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12864 Processors}.
12865
12866 @end table
12867
12868 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12869
12870 @table @code
12871
12872 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12873 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12874 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12875
12876 @end table
12877
12878 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12879 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12880
12881 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12882 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12883 various aspects of this process.
12884
12885 @table @code
12886
12887 @item set hash
12888 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12889 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12890 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12891 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12892 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12893 monitor.
12894
12895 @item show hash
12896 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12897 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12898
12899 @item set debug monitor
12900 @kindex set debug monitor
12901 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12902 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12903 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12904
12905 @item show debug monitor
12906 @kindex show debug monitor
12907 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12908 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12909 @end table
12910
12911 @table @code
12912
12913 @kindex load @var{filename}
12914 @item load @var{filename}
12915 @anchor{load}
12916 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12917 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12918 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12919 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12920 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12921 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12922
12923 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12924 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12925 target is @dots{}}''
12926
12927 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12928 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12929 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12930 specifies a fixed address.
12931 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12932
12933 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12934 load programs into flash memory.
12935
12936 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12937 @end table
12938
12939 @node Byte Order
12940 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12941
12942 @cindex choosing target byte order
12943 @cindex target byte order
12944
12945 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12946 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12947 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12948 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12949 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12950 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12951
12952 @table @code
12953 @kindex set endian
12954 @item set endian big
12955 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12956
12957 @item set endian little
12958 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12959
12960 @item set endian auto
12961 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12962 executable.
12963
12964 @item show endian
12965 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12966
12967 @end table
12968
12969 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12970 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12971 target system.
12972
12973
12974 @node Remote Debugging
12975 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12976 @cindex remote debugging
12977
12978 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12979 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12980 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12981 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12982 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12983
12984 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12985 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12986 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12987 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12988 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12989 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12990
12991 Other remote targets may be available in your
12992 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12993
12994 @menu
12995 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12996 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
12997 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12998 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12999 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
13000 @end menu
13001
13002 @node Connecting
13003 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
13004
13005 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
13006 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
13007 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
13008 program as the first argument.
13009
13010 @cindex @code{target remote}
13011 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
13012 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
13013 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
13014 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
13015 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
13016 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
13017
13018 @table @code
13019
13020 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
13021 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
13022 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
13023 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
13024
13025 @smallexample
13026 target remote /dev/ttyb
13027 @end smallexample
13028
13029 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
13030 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
13031 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
13032 @code{target} command.
13033
13034 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
13035 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13036 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
13037 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
13038 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
13039 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
13040 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
13041 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
13042 target.
13043
13044 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
13045 @code{manyfarms}:
13046
13047 @smallexample
13048 target remote manyfarms:2828
13049 @end smallexample
13050
13051 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
13052 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
13053 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
13054 port 1234 on your local machine:
13055
13056 @smallexample
13057 target remote :1234
13058 @end smallexample
13059 @noindent
13060
13061 Note that the colon is still required here.
13062
13063 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13064 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
13065 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
13066 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
13067
13068 @smallexample
13069 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
13070 @end smallexample
13071
13072 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
13073 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
13074 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
13075 cause havoc with your debugging session.
13076
13077 @item target remote | @var{command}
13078 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
13079 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
13080 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
13081 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
13082 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
13083 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
13084 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
13085 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
13086
13087 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
13088 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
13089 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
13090
13091 @end table
13092
13093 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
13094 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
13095 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
13096 need to use @kbd{run}.
13097
13098 @cindex interrupting remote programs
13099 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
13100 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
13101 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
13102 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
13103 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
13104 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
13105
13106 @smallexample
13107 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
13108 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
13109 @end smallexample
13110
13111 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
13112 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
13113 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
13114 goes back to waiting.
13115
13116 @table @code
13117 @kindex detach (remote)
13118 @item detach
13119 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
13120 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
13121 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
13122 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
13123 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
13124
13125 @kindex disconnect
13126 @item disconnect
13127 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
13128 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
13129 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
13130 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
13131 another target.
13132
13133 @cindex send command to remote monitor
13134 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
13135 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
13136 @kindex monitor
13137 @item monitor @var{cmd}
13138 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
13139 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
13140 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
13141 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
13142 and implement.
13143 @end table
13144
13145 @node File Transfer
13146 @section Sending files to a remote system
13147 @cindex remote target, file transfer
13148 @cindex file transfer
13149 @cindex sending files to remote systems
13150
13151 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
13152 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
13153 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
13154 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
13155 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
13156 the only way to upload or download files.
13157
13158 Not all remote targets support these commands.
13159
13160 @table @code
13161 @kindex remote put
13162 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
13163 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
13164 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
13165
13166 @kindex remote get
13167 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
13168 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
13169 on the host system.
13170
13171 @kindex remote delete
13172 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
13173 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
13174
13175 @end table
13176
13177 @node Server
13178 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
13179
13180 @kindex gdbserver
13181 @cindex remote connection without stubs
13182 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
13183 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
13184 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
13185
13186 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
13187 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
13188 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
13189 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
13190 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
13191 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
13192 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
13193 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
13194 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
13195 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
13196 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
13197 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
13198 choice for debugging.
13199
13200 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
13201 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
13202 protocol.
13203
13204 @quotation
13205 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
13206 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
13207 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
13208 target system with the same privileges as the user running
13209 @code{gdbserver}.
13210 @end quotation
13211
13212 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
13213 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
13214
13215 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
13216 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
13217 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
13218 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
13219 system does all the symbol handling.
13220
13221 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
13222 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
13223 syntax is:
13224
13225 @smallexample
13226 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
13227 @end smallexample
13228
13229 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
13230 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
13231 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
13232 @file{/dev/com1}:
13233
13234 @smallexample
13235 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
13236 @end smallexample
13237
13238 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
13239 with it.
13240
13241 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
13242
13243 @smallexample
13244 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
13245 @end smallexample
13246
13247 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
13248 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13249 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13250 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13251 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13252 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13253 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13254 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13255 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13256 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13257 @code{target remote} command.
13258
13259 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13260
13261 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13262 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13263
13264 @smallexample
13265 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13266 @end smallexample
13267
13268 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13269 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13270
13271 @pindex pidof
13272 @cindex attach to a program by name
13273 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13274 @code{pidof} utility:
13275
13276 @smallexample
13277 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13278 @end smallexample
13279
13280 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13281 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13282 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13283
13284 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13285 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13286 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13287
13288 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13289 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13290 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13291 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13292
13293 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13294 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13295 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13296 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13297 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13298 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13299 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13300 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13301 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13302
13303 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13304 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13305 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
13306 the program you want to debug.
13307
13308 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13309 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13310 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13311
13312 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13313
13314 You can include @option{--debug} on the @code{gdbserver} command line.
13315 @code{gdbserver} will display extra status information about the debugging
13316 process. This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and
13317 for bug reports to the developers.
13318
13319 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
13320 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
13321 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
13322 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
13323
13324 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
13325 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
13326 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
13327 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
13328
13329 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
13330 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
13331 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
13332 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
13333
13334 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
13335 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
13336 environment:
13337
13338 @smallexample
13339 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
13340 @end smallexample
13341
13342 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
13343
13344 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
13345
13346 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13347 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13348 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13349 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
13350
13351 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13352 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13353 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13354 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13355 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13356 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13357 programs.
13358
13359 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13360 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13361 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13362 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13363 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
13364 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13365 already on the target.
13366
13367 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13368 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13369 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
13370
13371 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13372 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13373 Here are the available commands.
13374
13375 @table @code
13376 @item monitor help
13377 List the available monitor commands.
13378
13379 @item monitor set debug 0
13380 @itemx monitor set debug 1
13381 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13382
13383 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
13384 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13385 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13386 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13387
13388 @item monitor exit
13389 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
13390 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
13391 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
13392 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
13393 of a multi-process mode debug session.
13394
13395 @end table
13396
13397 @node Remote Configuration
13398 @section Remote Configuration
13399
13400 @kindex set remote
13401 @kindex show remote
13402 This section documents the configuration options available when
13403 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13404 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13405 system-call-allowed}.
13406
13407 @table @code
13408 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13409 @cindex address size for remote targets
13410 @cindex bits in remote address
13411 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13412 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13413 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13414 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13415
13416 @item show remoteaddresssize
13417 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13418
13419 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
13420 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
13421 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13422 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13423 remote targets.
13424
13425 @item show remotebaud
13426 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13427
13428 @item set remotebreak
13429 @cindex interrupt remote programs
13430 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13431 @anchor{set remotebreak}
13432 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13433 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13434 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13435 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13436 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13437
13438 @item show remotebreak
13439 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13440 interrupt the remote program.
13441
13442 @item set remoteflow on
13443 @itemx set remoteflow off
13444 @kindex set remoteflow
13445 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13446 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13447
13448 @item show remoteflow
13449 @kindex show remoteflow
13450 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13451
13452 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13453 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13454 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13455 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13456 @code{ascii}.
13457
13458 @item show remotelogbase
13459 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13460 protocol.
13461
13462 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13463 @cindex record serial communications on file
13464 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13465 default is not to record at all.
13466
13467 @item show remotelogfile.
13468 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13469 serial communications.
13470
13471 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13472 @cindex timeout for serial communications
13473 @cindex remote timeout
13474 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13475 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13476
13477 @item show remotetimeout
13478 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13479 responses.
13480
13481 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13482 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13483 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13484 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13485 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13486 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13487 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13488 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13489
13490 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
13491 @itemx show remote exec-file
13492 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
13493 @cindex executable file, for remote target
13494 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
13495 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
13496 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
13497 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
13498 @end table
13499
13500 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13501 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13502 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13503 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13504 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13505 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13506 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13507 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13508 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13509
13510 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13511 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13512 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13513 @value{GDBN} developers.
13514
13515 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13516 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13517 are:
13518
13519 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13520 @item Command Name
13521 @tab Remote Packet
13522 @tab Related Features
13523
13524 @item @code{fetch-register}
13525 @tab @code{p}
13526 @tab @code{info registers}
13527
13528 @item @code{set-register}
13529 @tab @code{P}
13530 @tab @code{set}
13531
13532 @item @code{binary-download}
13533 @tab @code{X}
13534 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13535
13536 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13537 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13538 @tab @code{info auxv}
13539
13540 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13541 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13542 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13543
13544 @item @code{attach}
13545 @tab @code{vAttach}
13546 @tab @code{attach}
13547
13548 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13549 @tab @code{vCont}
13550 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13551
13552 @item @code{run}
13553 @tab @code{vRun}
13554 @tab @code{run}
13555
13556 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13557 @tab @code{Z0}
13558 @tab @code{break}
13559
13560 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13561 @tab @code{Z1}
13562 @tab @code{hbreak}
13563
13564 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13565 @tab @code{Z2}
13566 @tab @code{watch}
13567
13568 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13569 @tab @code{Z3}
13570 @tab @code{rwatch}
13571
13572 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13573 @tab @code{Z4}
13574 @tab @code{awatch}
13575
13576 @item @code{target-features}
13577 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13578 @tab @code{set architecture}
13579
13580 @item @code{library-info}
13581 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13582 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13583
13584 @item @code{memory-map}
13585 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13586 @tab @code{info mem}
13587
13588 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13589 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13590 @tab @code{info spu}
13591
13592 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13593 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13594 @tab @code{info spu}
13595
13596 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13597 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13598 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13599
13600 @item @code{search-memory}
13601 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
13602 @tab @code{find}
13603
13604 @item @code{supported-packets}
13605 @tab @code{qSupported}
13606 @tab Remote communications parameters
13607
13608 @item @code{pass-signals}
13609 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
13610 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13611
13612 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13613 @tab @code{vFile:close}
13614 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13615
13616 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13617 @tab @code{vFile:open}
13618 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13619
13620 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13621 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
13622 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13623
13624 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13625 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13626 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13627
13628 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13629 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13630 @tab @code{remote delete}
13631 @end multitable
13632
13633 @node Remote Stub
13634 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
13635
13636 @cindex debugging stub, example
13637 @cindex remote stub, example
13638 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
13639 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13640 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13641 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13642 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13643 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13644 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13645 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13646
13647 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13648 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13649 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13650 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13651 program, you need:
13652
13653 @enumerate
13654 @item
13655 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13656 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13657 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13658
13659 @item
13660 A C subroutine library to support your program's
13661 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13662
13663 @item
13664 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13665 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13666 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13667 documentation.
13668 @end enumerate
13669
13670 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13671 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13672 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13673
13674 @table @emph
13675 @item On the host,
13676 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13677 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13678 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13679
13680 @item On the target,
13681 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13682 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13683 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13684
13685 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13686 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13687 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13688 @end table
13689
13690 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13691 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13692 @sc{sparc} boards.
13693
13694 @cindex remote serial stub list
13695 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13696
13697 @table @code
13698
13699 @item i386-stub.c
13700 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13701 @cindex Intel
13702 @cindex i386
13703 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13704
13705 @item m68k-stub.c
13706 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13707 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13708 @cindex m680x0
13709 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13710
13711 @item sh-stub.c
13712 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13713 @cindex Renesas
13714 @cindex SH
13715 For Renesas SH architectures.
13716
13717 @item sparc-stub.c
13718 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13719 @cindex Sparc
13720 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13721
13722 @item sparcl-stub.c
13723 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13724 @cindex Fujitsu
13725 @cindex SparcLite
13726 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13727
13728 @end table
13729
13730 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13731 recently added stubs.
13732
13733 @menu
13734 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13735 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13736 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13737 @end menu
13738
13739 @node Stub Contents
13740 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13741
13742 @cindex remote serial stub
13743 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13744 subroutines:
13745
13746 @table @code
13747 @item set_debug_traps
13748 @findex set_debug_traps
13749 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13750 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13751 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13752 beginning of your program.
13753
13754 @item handle_exception
13755 @findex handle_exception
13756 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13757 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13758 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13759 run when a trap is triggered.
13760
13761 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13762 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13763 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13764 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13765 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13766 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13767 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13768 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13769 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13770 machine.
13771
13772 @item breakpoint
13773 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13774 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13775 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13776 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13777 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13778 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13779 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13780 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13781 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13782 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13783 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13784
13785 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13786 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13787 start of your debugging session.
13788 @end table
13789
13790 @node Bootstrapping
13791 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13792
13793 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13794 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13795 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13796 debugging target machine.
13797
13798 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13799 serial port.
13800
13801 @table @code
13802 @item int getDebugChar()
13803 @findex getDebugChar
13804 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13805 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13806 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13807
13808 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13809 @findex putDebugChar
13810 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13811 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13812 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13813 @end table
13814
13815 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13816 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13817 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13818 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13819 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13820 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13821 remote system to stop.
13822
13823 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13824 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13825 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13826 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13827
13828 Other routines you need to supply are:
13829
13830 @table @code
13831 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13832 @findex exceptionHandler
13833 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13834 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13835 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13836 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13837 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13838 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13839 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13840 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13841 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13842 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13843 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13844 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13845 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13846
13847 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13848 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13849 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13850 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13851 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13852
13853 @item void flush_i_cache()
13854 @findex flush_i_cache
13855 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13856 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13857 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13858
13859 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13860 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13861 @end table
13862
13863 @noindent
13864 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13865
13866 @table @code
13867 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13868 @findex memset
13869 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13870 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13871 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13872 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13873 @end table
13874
13875 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13876 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13877 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13878 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13879
13880
13881 @node Debug Session
13882 @subsection Putting it All Together
13883
13884 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13885 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13886 steps.
13887
13888 @enumerate
13889 @item
13890 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13891 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13892 @display
13893 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13894 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13895 @end display
13896
13897 @item
13898 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13899
13900 @smallexample
13901 set_debug_traps();
13902 breakpoint();
13903 @end smallexample
13904
13905 @item
13906 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13907 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13908
13909 @smallexample
13910 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13911 @end smallexample
13912
13913 @noindent
13914 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13915 function in your program, that function is called when
13916 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13917 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13918 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13919
13920 @item
13921 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13922 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13923
13924 @item
13925 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13926 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13927
13928 @item
13929 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13930 @c document that. FIXME.
13931 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13932 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13933
13934 @item
13935 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13936 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13937
13938 @end enumerate
13939
13940 @node Configurations
13941 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13942
13943 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13944 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13945 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13946
13947 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13948 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13949 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13950 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13951 are quite different from each other.
13952
13953 @menu
13954 * Native::
13955 * Embedded OS::
13956 * Embedded Processors::
13957 * Architectures::
13958 @end menu
13959
13960 @node Native
13961 @section Native
13962
13963 This section describes details specific to particular native
13964 configurations.
13965
13966 @menu
13967 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13968 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13969 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13970 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13971 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13972 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13973 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13974 @end menu
13975
13976 @node HP-UX
13977 @subsection HP-UX
13978
13979 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13980 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13981 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13982
13983
13984 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13985 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13986
13987 @cindex libkvm
13988 @cindex kernel memory image
13989 @cindex kernel crash dump
13990
13991 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13992 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13993 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13994 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13995 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13996 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13997 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13998 @code{kvm} target:
13999
14000 @smallexample
14001 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
14002 @end smallexample
14003
14004 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
14005 argument:
14006
14007 @smallexample
14008 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
14009 @end smallexample
14010
14011 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
14012 available:
14013
14014 @table @code
14015 @kindex kvm
14016 @item kvm pcb
14017 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
14018
14019 @item kvm proc
14020 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
14021 modern FreeBSD systems.
14022 @end table
14023
14024 @node SVR4 Process Information
14025 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
14026 @cindex /proc
14027 @cindex examine process image
14028 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
14029
14030 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
14031 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
14032 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
14033 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
14034 proc} is available to report information about the process running
14035 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
14036 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
14037 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
14038 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
14039
14040 @table @code
14041 @kindex info proc
14042 @cindex process ID
14043 @item info proc
14044 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
14045 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
14046 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
14047 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
14048 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
14049 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
14050 executable file's absolute file name.
14051
14052 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
14053 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
14054 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
14055 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
14056 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
14057 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
14058
14059 @item info proc mappings
14060 @cindex memory address space mappings
14061 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
14062 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
14063 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
14064 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
14065 memory access rights to that range.
14066
14067 @item info proc stat
14068 @itemx info proc status
14069 @cindex process detailed status information
14070 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
14071 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
14072 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
14073 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
14074 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
14075 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
14076 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
14077
14078 @item info proc all
14079 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
14080 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
14081
14082 @ignore
14083 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
14084 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
14085 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
14086 @kindex info proc times
14087 @item info proc times
14088 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
14089 its children.
14090
14091 @kindex info proc id
14092 @item info proc id
14093 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
14094 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
14095 @end ignore
14096
14097 @item set procfs-trace
14098 @kindex set procfs-trace
14099 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
14100 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
14101
14102 @item show procfs-trace
14103 @kindex show procfs-trace
14104 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
14105
14106 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
14107 @kindex set procfs-file
14108 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
14109 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
14110 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
14111 standard output.
14112
14113 @item show procfs-file
14114 @kindex show procfs-file
14115 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
14116
14117 @item proc-trace-entry
14118 @itemx proc-trace-exit
14119 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
14120 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
14121 @kindex proc-trace-entry
14122 @kindex proc-trace-exit
14123 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
14124 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
14125 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
14126 from the @code{syscall} interface.
14127
14128 @item info pidlist
14129 @kindex info pidlist
14130 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
14131 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
14132 processes and all the threads within each process.
14133
14134 @item info meminfo
14135 @kindex info meminfo
14136 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
14137 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
14138 @end table
14139
14140 @node DJGPP Native
14141 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
14142 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
14143 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
14144 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
14145
14146 @cindex DPMI
14147 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
14148 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
14149 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
14150 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
14151
14152 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
14153 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
14154 subsection describes those commands.
14155
14156 @table @code
14157 @kindex info dos
14158 @item info dos
14159 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
14160 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14161
14162 @kindex sysinfo
14163 @cindex MS-DOS system info
14164 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
14165 @item info dos sysinfo
14166 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
14167 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
14168 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
14169
14170 @cindex GDT
14171 @cindex LDT
14172 @cindex IDT
14173 @cindex segment descriptor tables
14174 @cindex descriptor tables display
14175 @item info dos gdt
14176 @itemx info dos ldt
14177 @itemx info dos idt
14178 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
14179 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
14180 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
14181 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
14182 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
14183 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
14184 rights.
14185
14186 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
14187 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
14188 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
14189 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
14190 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
14191
14192 @cindex garbled pointers
14193 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
14194 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
14195 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
14196 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
14197 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
14198 debugged program's data segment:
14199
14200 @smallexample
14201 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
14202 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
14203 @end smallexample
14204
14205 @noindent
14206 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
14207 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
14208
14209 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
14210 @item info dos pde
14211 @itemx info dos pte
14212 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
14213 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
14214 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
14215 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
14216 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
14217 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
14218 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
14219 that is currently in use.
14220
14221 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
14222 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
14223 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
14224 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
14225 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
14226 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
14227 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
14228
14229 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
14230 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
14231 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
14232 controller.
14233
14234 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
14235
14236 @cindex physical address from linear address
14237 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
14238 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
14239 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
14240 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
14241 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
14242 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
14243 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
14244
14245 @smallexample
14246 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
14247 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
14248 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
14249 @end smallexample
14250
14251 @noindent
14252 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
14253 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
14254 attributes of that page.
14255
14256 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
14257 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
14258 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
14259 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
14260 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
14261 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
14262
14263 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
14264 transfer buffer:
14265
14266 @smallexample
14267 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
14268 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
14269 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
14270 @end smallexample
14271
14272 @noindent
14273 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
14274 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
14275 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14276 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
14277 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
14278
14279 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
14280 @end table
14281
14282 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
14283 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
14284 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
14285 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
14286
14287 @table @code
14288 @kindex set com1base
14289 @kindex set com1irq
14290 @kindex set com2base
14291 @kindex set com2irq
14292 @kindex set com3base
14293 @kindex set com3irq
14294 @kindex set com4base
14295 @kindex set com4irq
14296 @item set com1base @var{addr}
14297 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
14298 port.
14299
14300 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
14301 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
14302 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
14303
14304 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
14305 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
14306 other 3 COM ports.
14307
14308 @kindex show com1base
14309 @kindex show com1irq
14310 @kindex show com2base
14311 @kindex show com2irq
14312 @kindex show com3base
14313 @kindex show com3irq
14314 @kindex show com4base
14315 @kindex show com4irq
14316 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
14317 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
14318 lines used by the COM ports.
14319
14320 @item info serial
14321 @kindex info serial
14322 @cindex DOS serial port status
14323 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
14324 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
14325 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
14326 counts of various errors encountered so far.
14327 @end table
14328
14329
14330 @node Cygwin Native
14331 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
14332 @cindex MS Windows debugging
14333 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
14334 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
14335
14336 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
14337 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
14338 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
14339 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
14340 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
14341
14342 @table @code
14343 @kindex info w32
14344 @item info w32
14345 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
14346 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14347
14348 @item info w32 selector
14349 This command displays information returned by
14350 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
14351 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
14352 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
14353 Without argument, this command displays information
14354 about the six segment registers.
14355
14356 @kindex info dll
14357 @item info dll
14358 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14359
14360 @kindex dll-symbols
14361 @item dll-symbols
14362 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14363 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14364
14365 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14366 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14367 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14368 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14369 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14370 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14371 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14372 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14373 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14374 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14375 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14376
14377 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14378 @item show cygwin-exceptions
14379 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14380 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14381
14382 @kindex set new-console
14383 @item set new-console @var{mode}
14384 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14385 be started in a new console on next start.
14386 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14387 be started in the same console as the debugger.
14388
14389 @kindex show new-console
14390 @item show new-console
14391 Displays whether a new console is used
14392 when the debuggee is started.
14393
14394 @kindex set new-group
14395 @item set new-group @var{mode}
14396 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14397 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14398 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14399 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
14400
14401 @kindex show new-group
14402 @item show new-group
14403 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14404
14405 @kindex set debugevents
14406 @item set debugevents
14407 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14408 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14409 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14410 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14411 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14412
14413 @kindex set debugexec
14414 @item set debugexec
14415 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14416 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14417
14418 @kindex set debugexceptions
14419 @item set debugexceptions
14420 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14421 debuggee seen by the debugger.
14422
14423 @kindex set debugmemory
14424 @item set debugmemory
14425 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14426 and writes by the debugger.
14427
14428 @kindex set shell
14429 @item set shell
14430 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14431 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14432
14433 @kindex show shell
14434 @item show shell
14435 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14436
14437 @end table
14438
14439 @menu
14440 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14441 @end menu
14442
14443 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14444 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14445 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14446 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14447
14448 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14449 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14450 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14451 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14452 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14453 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14454 ``minimal symbols''.
14455
14456 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14457 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14458 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14459 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14460 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14461 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14462 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14463 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14464 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14465 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14466
14467 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14468
14469 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14470 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14471 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14472 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14473 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14474 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14475 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14476 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14477 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14478
14479 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14480 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14481 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14482 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14483 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14484 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14485
14486 @smallexample
14487 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14488 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14489
14490 Non-debugging symbols:
14491 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
14492 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14493 @end smallexample
14494
14495 @smallexample
14496 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
14497 All functions matching regular expression "!":
14498
14499 Non-debugging symbols:
14500 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
14501 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
14502 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14503 [etc...]
14504 @end smallexample
14505
14506 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14507
14508 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14509 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14510 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14511 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14512 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14513 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14514 a function within a DLL without a running program.
14515
14516 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14517 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14518 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14519 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14520 problem:
14521
14522 @smallexample
14523 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14524 $1 = 268572168
14525 @end smallexample
14526
14527 @smallexample
14528 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
14529 0x10021610: "\230y\""
14530 @end smallexample
14531
14532 And two possible solutions:
14533
14534 @smallexample
14535 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14536 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14537 @end smallexample
14538
14539 @smallexample
14540 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14541 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14542 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14543 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14544 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14545 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14546 @end smallexample
14547
14548 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14549 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14550 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14551 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14552 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14553
14554 @smallexample
14555 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14556 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14557 @end smallexample
14558
14559 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14560 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14561 safe.
14562
14563 @node Hurd Native
14564 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14565 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14566
14567 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14568 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14569
14570 @table @code
14571 @item set signals
14572 @itemx set sigs
14573 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14574 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14575 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14576 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14577 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14578 @code{signals}.
14579
14580 @item show signals
14581 @itemx show sigs
14582 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14583 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14584 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14585
14586 @item set signal-thread
14587 @itemx set sigthread
14588 @kindex set signal-thread
14589 @kindex set sigthread
14590 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14591 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14592 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14593 signal-thread}.
14594
14595 @item show signal-thread
14596 @itemx show sigthread
14597 @kindex show signal-thread
14598 @kindex show sigthread
14599 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14600 delivered a signal.
14601
14602 @item set stopped
14603 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14604 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14605 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14606 continued by delivering a signal to it.
14607
14608 @item show stopped
14609 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14610 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14611 stopped.
14612
14613 @item set exceptions
14614 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14615 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14616 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14617 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14618 trapping on.
14619
14620 @item show exceptions
14621 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14622 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14623
14624 @item set task pause
14625 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14626 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14627 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14628 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14629 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14630 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14631 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14632 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14633 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14634
14635 @item show task pause
14636 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14637 Show the current state of task suspension.
14638
14639 @item set task detach-suspend-count
14640 @cindex task suspend count
14641 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14642 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14643 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14644
14645 @item show task detach-suspend-count
14646 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14647
14648 @item set task exception-port
14649 @itemx set task excp
14650 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14651 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14652 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14653 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14654
14655 @item set noninvasive
14656 @cindex noninvasive task options
14657 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14658 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14659 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14660 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14661
14662 @item info send-rights
14663 @itemx info receive-rights
14664 @itemx info port-rights
14665 @itemx info port-sets
14666 @itemx info dead-names
14667 @itemx info ports
14668 @itemx info psets
14669 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14670 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14671 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14672 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14673 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14674 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14675 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14676 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14677 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14678
14679 @item set thread pause
14680 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14681 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14682 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14683 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14684 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14685 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14686 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14687 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14688 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14689 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14690 only the current thread.
14691
14692 @item show thread pause
14693 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14694 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14695
14696 @item set thread run
14697 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14698
14699 @item show thread run
14700 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14701
14702 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14703 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14704 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14705 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14706 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14707 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14708 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14709
14710 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14711 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14712 detaching.
14713
14714 @item set thread exception-port
14715 @itemx set thread excp
14716 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14717 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14718 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14719
14720 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14721 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14722 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14723 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14724
14725 @item set thread default
14726 @itemx show thread default
14727 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14728 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14729 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14730 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14731 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14732 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14733 the non-default commands.
14734 @end table
14735
14736
14737 @node Neutrino
14738 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14739 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14740
14741 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14742 Neutrino target:
14743
14744 @table @code
14745 @item set debug nto-debug
14746 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14747 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14748 Neutrino support.
14749
14750 @item show debug nto-debug
14751 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14752 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14753 @end table
14754
14755
14756 @node Embedded OS
14757 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14758
14759 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14760 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14761 architectures.
14762
14763 @menu
14764 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14765 @end menu
14766
14767 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14768 various real-time operating systems.
14769
14770 @node VxWorks
14771 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14772
14773 @cindex VxWorks
14774
14775 @table @code
14776
14777 @kindex target vxworks
14778 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14779 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14780 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14781
14782 @end table
14783
14784 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14785 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14786
14787 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14788 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14789 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14790 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14791 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14792 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14793 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14794
14795 @table @code
14796 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14797 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14798 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14799 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14800 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14801 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14802 of a thin network line.
14803 @end table
14804
14805 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14806 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14807 procedures.
14808
14809 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14810 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14811 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14812 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14813 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14814 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14815 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14816 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14817 manual.
14818 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14819
14820 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14821 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14822 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14823 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14824
14825 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14826
14827 @smallexample
14828 (vxgdb)
14829 @end smallexample
14830
14831 @menu
14832 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14833 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14834 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14835 @end menu
14836
14837 @node VxWorks Connection
14838 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14839
14840 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14841 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14842
14843 @smallexample
14844 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14845 @end smallexample
14846
14847 @need 750
14848 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14849
14850 @smallexample
14851 Attaching remote machine across net...
14852 Connected to tt.
14853 @end smallexample
14854
14855 @need 1000
14856 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14857 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14858 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14859 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14860 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14861
14862 @smallexample
14863 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14864 @end smallexample
14865
14866 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14867 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14868 command again.
14869
14870 @node VxWorks Download
14871 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14872
14873 @cindex download to VxWorks
14874 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14875 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14876 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14877 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14878 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14879 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14880 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14881 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14882 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14883 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14884 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14885 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14886 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14887 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14888 program, type this on VxWorks:
14889
14890 @smallexample
14891 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14892 @end smallexample
14893
14894 @noindent
14895 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14896
14897 @smallexample
14898 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14899 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14900 @end smallexample
14901
14902 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14903
14904 @smallexample
14905 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14906 @end smallexample
14907
14908 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14909 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14910 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14911 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14912 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14913 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14914 table.)
14915
14916 @node VxWorks Attach
14917 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14918
14919 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14920 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14921 follows:
14922
14923 @smallexample
14924 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14925 @end smallexample
14926
14927 @noindent
14928 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14929 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14930 the time of attachment.
14931
14932 @node Embedded Processors
14933 @section Embedded Processors
14934
14935 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14936 configurations.
14937
14938 @cindex send command to simulator
14939 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14940 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14941
14942 @table @code
14943 @item sim @var{command}
14944 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14945 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14946 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14947 acceptable commands.
14948 @end table
14949
14950
14951 @menu
14952 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14953 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14954 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14955 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14956 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14957 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14958 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
14959 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14960 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14961 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14962 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14963 * CRIS:: CRIS
14964 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14965 @end menu
14966
14967 @node ARM
14968 @subsection ARM
14969 @cindex ARM RDI
14970
14971 @table @code
14972 @kindex target rdi
14973 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14974 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14975 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14976 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14977
14978 @kindex target rdp
14979 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14980 ARM Demon monitor.
14981
14982 @end table
14983
14984 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14985
14986 @table @code
14987 @item set arm disassembler
14988 @kindex set arm
14989 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14990 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14991
14992 @item show arm disassembler
14993 @kindex show arm
14994 Show the current disassembly style.
14995
14996 @item set arm apcs32
14997 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14998 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14999
15000 @item show arm apcs32
15001 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
15002
15003 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
15004 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
15005 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
15006
15007 @table @code
15008 @item auto
15009 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
15010 @item softfpa
15011 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
15012 processors.
15013 @item fpa
15014 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
15015 @item softvfp
15016 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
15017 @item vfp
15018 VFP co-processor.
15019 @end table
15020
15021 @item show arm fpu
15022 Show the current type of the FPU.
15023
15024 @item set arm abi
15025 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
15026
15027 @item show arm abi
15028 Show the currently used ABI.
15029
15030 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15031 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
15032 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
15033 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
15034 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
15035 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
15036 register).
15037
15038 @item show arm fallback-mode
15039 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
15040
15041 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15042 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
15043 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
15044 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
15045 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
15046
15047 @item show arm force-mode
15048 Show the current forced instruction mode.
15049
15050 @item set debug arm
15051 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
15052 target support subsystem.
15053
15054 @item show debug arm
15055 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
15056 @end table
15057
15058 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
15059 using the RDI interface:
15060
15061 @table @code
15062 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15063 @kindex rdilogfile
15064 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
15065 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
15066 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
15067 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
15068 @file{rdi.log}.
15069
15070 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
15071 @kindex rdilogenable
15072 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
15073 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
15074 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
15075 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
15076 are logged to a file.
15077
15078 @item set rdiromatzero
15079 @kindex set rdiromatzero
15080 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
15081 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
15082 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
15083 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
15084 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
15085
15086 @item show rdiromatzero
15087 @kindex show rdiromatzero
15088 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
15089
15090 @item set rdiheartbeat
15091 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
15092 @cindex RDI heartbeat
15093 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
15094 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
15095 well as the Angel monitor.
15096
15097 @item show rdiheartbeat
15098 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
15099 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
15100 @end table
15101
15102
15103 @node M32R/D
15104 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
15105
15106 @table @code
15107 @kindex target m32r
15108 @item target m32r @var{dev}
15109 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
15110
15111 @kindex target m32rsdi
15112 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
15113 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
15114 @end table
15115
15116 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
15117
15118 @table @code
15119 @item set download-path @var{path}
15120 @kindex set download-path
15121 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
15122 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15123
15124 @item show download-path
15125 @kindex show download-path
15126 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15127
15128 @item set board-address @var{addr}
15129 @kindex set board-address
15130 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
15131 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
15132
15133 @item show board-address
15134 @kindex show board-address
15135 Show the current IP address of the target board.
15136
15137 @item set server-address @var{addr}
15138 @kindex set server-address
15139 @cindex download server address (M32R)
15140 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
15141 host machine.
15142
15143 @item show server-address
15144 @kindex show server-address
15145 Display the IP address of the download server.
15146
15147 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15148 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
15149 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
15150 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
15151 executable file is uploaded.
15152
15153 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15154 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
15155 Test the @code{upload} command.
15156 @end table
15157
15158 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
15159
15160 @table @code
15161 @item sdireset
15162 @kindex sdireset
15163 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
15164 This command resets the SDI connection.
15165
15166 @item sdistatus
15167 @kindex sdistatus
15168 This command shows the SDI connection status.
15169
15170 @item debug_chaos
15171 @kindex debug_chaos
15172 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
15173 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
15174
15175 @item use_debug_dma
15176 @kindex use_debug_dma
15177 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
15178
15179 @item use_mon_code
15180 @kindex use_mon_code
15181 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
15182
15183 @item use_ib_break
15184 @kindex use_ib_break
15185 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
15186
15187 @item use_dbt_break
15188 @kindex use_dbt_break
15189 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
15190 @end table
15191
15192 @node M68K
15193 @subsection M68k
15194
15195 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
15196 target command for the following ROM monitor.
15197
15198 @table @code
15199
15200 @kindex target dbug
15201 @item target dbug @var{dev}
15202 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
15203
15204 @end table
15205
15206 @node MIPS Embedded
15207 @subsection MIPS Embedded
15208
15209 @cindex MIPS boards
15210 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
15211 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
15212 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
15213
15214 @need 1000
15215 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
15216
15217 @table @code
15218 @item target mips @var{port}
15219 @kindex target mips @var{port}
15220 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
15221 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
15222 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
15223 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
15224 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
15225 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
15226
15227 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
15228 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
15229 debugger:
15230
15231 @smallexample
15232 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
15233 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
15234 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
15235 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
15236 (@value{GDBP}) run
15237 @end smallexample
15238
15239 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
15240 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
15241 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
15242 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
15243 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15244
15245 @item target pmon @var{port}
15246 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
15247 PMON ROM monitor.
15248
15249 @item target ddb @var{port}
15250 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
15251 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
15252
15253 @item target lsi @var{port}
15254 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
15255 LSI variant of PMON.
15256
15257 @kindex target r3900
15258 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
15259 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
15260
15261 @kindex target array
15262 @item target array @var{dev}
15263 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
15264
15265 @end table
15266
15267
15268 @noindent
15269 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
15270
15271 @table @code
15272 @item set mipsfpu double
15273 @itemx set mipsfpu single
15274 @itemx set mipsfpu none
15275 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
15276 @itemx show mipsfpu
15277 @kindex set mipsfpu
15278 @kindex show mipsfpu
15279 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
15280 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
15281 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
15282 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
15283 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
15284 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
15285 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
15286 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
15287 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
15288 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
15289 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
15290 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
15291 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
15292
15293 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
15294 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
15295 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
15296
15297 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
15298 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
15299
15300 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
15301 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
15302 @itemx show timeout
15303 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
15304 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
15305 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
15306 @kindex set timeout
15307 @kindex show timeout
15308 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
15309 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
15310 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
15311 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
15312 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
15313 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
15314 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
15315 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
15316 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
15317 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
15318
15319 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
15320 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
15321 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
15322 to run before stopping.
15323
15324 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
15325 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15326 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
15327 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
15328 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
15329 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
15330
15331 @item show syn-garbage-limit
15332 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15333 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
15334 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
15335
15336 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
15337 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15338 @cindex remote monitor prompt
15339 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
15340 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
15341 @table @asis
15342 @item pmon target
15343 @samp{PMON}
15344 @item ddb target
15345 @samp{NEC010}
15346 @item lsi target
15347 @samp{PMON>}
15348 @end table
15349
15350 @item show monitor-prompt
15351 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15352 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
15353 remote monitor.
15354
15355 @item set monitor-warnings
15356 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15357 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
15358 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
15359 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
15360 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
15361
15362 @item show monitor-warnings
15363 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15364 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
15365
15366 @item pmon @var{command}
15367 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
15368 @cindex send PMON command
15369 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
15370 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
15371 @end table
15372
15373 @node OpenRISC 1000
15374 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
15375 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
15376
15377 @cindex or1k boards
15378 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15379 about platform and commands.
15380
15381 @table @code
15382
15383 @kindex target jtag
15384 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15385
15386 Connects to remote JTAG server.
15387 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15388 connected via parallel port to the board.
15389
15390 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15391
15392 @kindex or1ksim
15393 @item or1ksim @var{command}
15394 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15395 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15396
15397 @kindex info or1k spr
15398 @item info or1k spr
15399 Displays spr groups.
15400
15401 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
15402 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15403 Displays register names in selected group.
15404
15405 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15406 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15407 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15408 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15409 Shows information about specified spr register.
15410
15411 @kindex spr
15412 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15413 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15414 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15415 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15416 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15417 @end table
15418
15419 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15420 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15421 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15422 triggers can be set using:
15423 @table @code
15424 @item $LEA/$LDATA
15425 Load effective address/data
15426 @item $SEA/$SDATA
15427 Store effective address/data
15428 @item $AEA/$ADATA
15429 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15430 @item $FETCH
15431 Fetch data
15432 @end table
15433
15434 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15435 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15436
15437 @code{htrace} commands:
15438 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15439 @table @code
15440 @kindex hwatch
15441 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15442 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15443 or Data. For example:
15444
15445 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15446
15447 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15448
15449 @kindex htrace
15450 @item htrace info
15451 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15452
15453 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15454 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15455
15456 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15457 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15458
15459 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15460 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15461
15462 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15463 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15464 triggered.
15465
15466 @item htrace enable
15467 @itemx htrace disable
15468 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15469
15470 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15471 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15472
15473 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15474 will be written there.
15475
15476 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15477 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15478
15479 @item htrace mode continuous
15480 Set continuous trace mode.
15481
15482 @item htrace mode suspend
15483 Set suspend trace mode.
15484
15485 @end table
15486
15487 @node PowerPC Embedded
15488 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
15489
15490 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15491
15492 @table @code
15493 @kindex set powerpc
15494 @item set powerpc soft-float
15495 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
15496 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15497 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15498 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15499
15500 @item set powerpc vector-abi
15501 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15502 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15503 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15504 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15505 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15506 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15507 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15508
15509 @kindex target dink32
15510 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15511 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15512
15513 @kindex target ppcbug
15514 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15515 @kindex target ppcbug1
15516 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15517 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15518
15519 @kindex target sds
15520 @item target sds @var{dev}
15521 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15522 @end table
15523
15524 @cindex SDS protocol
15525 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15526 by @value{GDBN}:
15527
15528 @table @code
15529 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15530 @kindex set sdstimeout
15531 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15532 default is 2 seconds.
15533
15534 @item show sdstimeout
15535 @kindex show sdstimeout
15536 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15537
15538 @item sds @var{command}
15539 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15540 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15541 @end table
15542
15543
15544 @node PA
15545 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15546
15547 @table @code
15548
15549 @kindex target op50n
15550 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15551 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15552
15553 @kindex target w89k
15554 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15555 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15556
15557 @end table
15558
15559 @node Sparclet
15560 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15561
15562 @cindex Sparclet
15563
15564 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15565 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15566 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15567 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15568 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15569
15570 @table @code
15571 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15572 @kindex remotetimeout
15573 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15574 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15575 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15576 @end table
15577
15578 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15579 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15580 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15581 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15582 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15583
15584 @smallexample
15585 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15586 @end smallexample
15587
15588 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15589
15590 @smallexample
15591 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15592 @end smallexample
15593
15594 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15595 Once you have set
15596 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15597 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15598 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15599
15600 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15601
15602 @smallexample
15603 (gdbslet)
15604 @end smallexample
15605
15606 @menu
15607 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15608 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15609 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15610 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15611 @end menu
15612
15613 @node Sparclet File
15614 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15615
15616 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15617
15618 @smallexample
15619 (gdbslet) file prog
15620 @end smallexample
15621
15622 @need 1000
15623 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15624 @value{GDBN} locates
15625 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15626 path.
15627 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15628 files will be searched as well.
15629 @value{GDBN} locates
15630 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15631 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15632 If it fails
15633 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15634
15635 @smallexample
15636 prog: No such file or directory.
15637 @end smallexample
15638
15639 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15640 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15641 @code{target} command again.
15642
15643 @node Sparclet Connection
15644 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15645
15646 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15647 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15648
15649 @smallexample
15650 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15651 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15652 main () at ../prog.c:3
15653 @end smallexample
15654
15655 @need 750
15656 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15657
15658 @smallexample
15659 Connected to ttya.
15660 @end smallexample
15661
15662 @node Sparclet Download
15663 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
15664
15665 @cindex download to Sparclet
15666 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15667 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15668 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15669 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15670 command.
15671 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15672 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15673 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15674 of each of the file's sections.
15675 For instance, if the program
15676 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15677 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15678
15679 @smallexample
15680 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15681 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15682 @end smallexample
15683
15684 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15685 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15686 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15687
15688 @node Sparclet Execution
15689 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
15690
15691 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15692 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15693 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15694 manual for the list of commands.
15695
15696 @smallexample
15697 (gdbslet) b main
15698 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15699 (gdbslet) run
15700 Starting program: prog
15701 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15702 3 char *symarg = 0;
15703 (gdbslet) step
15704 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15705 (gdbslet)
15706 @end smallexample
15707
15708 @node Sparclite
15709 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15710
15711 @table @code
15712
15713 @kindex target sparclite
15714 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15715 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15716 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15717 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15718 remote protocol.
15719
15720 @end table
15721
15722 @node Z8000
15723 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15724
15725 @cindex Z8000
15726 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15727 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15728
15729 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15730 a Z8000 simulator.
15731
15732 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15733 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15734 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15735 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15736
15737 @table @code
15738 @item target sim @var{args}
15739 @kindex sim
15740 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15741 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15742 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15743 @end table
15744
15745 @noindent
15746 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15747 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15748 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15749 to run your program, and so on.
15750
15751 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15752 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15753 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15754
15755 @table @code
15756
15757 @item cycles
15758 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15759
15760 @item insts
15761 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15762
15763 @item time
15764 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15765
15766 @end table
15767
15768 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15769 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15770 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15771 simulated clock ticks.
15772
15773 @node AVR
15774 @subsection Atmel AVR
15775 @cindex AVR
15776
15777 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15778 following AVR-specific commands:
15779
15780 @table @code
15781 @item info io_registers
15782 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15783 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15784 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15785 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15786 @end table
15787
15788 @node CRIS
15789 @subsection CRIS
15790 @cindex CRIS
15791
15792 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15793 following CRIS-specific commands:
15794
15795 @table @code
15796 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15797 @cindex CRIS version
15798 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15799 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15800 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15801
15802 @item show cris-version
15803 Show the current CRIS version.
15804
15805 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15806 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15807 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15808 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15809 @code{R59}.
15810
15811 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15812 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15813
15814 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15815 @cindex CRIS mode
15816 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15817 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15818 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15819
15820 @item show cris-mode
15821 Show the current CRIS mode.
15822 @end table
15823
15824 @node Super-H
15825 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15826 @cindex Super-H
15827
15828 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15829 commands:
15830
15831 @table @code
15832 @item regs
15833 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15834 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15835
15836 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
15837 @kindex set sh calling-convention
15838 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
15839 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
15840 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
15841 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
15842 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
15843 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
15844 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
15845 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
15846 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
15847 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
15848
15849 @item show sh calling-convention
15850 @kindex show sh calling-convention
15851 Show the current calling convention setting.
15852
15853 @end table
15854
15855
15856 @node Architectures
15857 @section Architectures
15858
15859 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15860 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15861
15862 @menu
15863 * i386::
15864 * A29K::
15865 * Alpha::
15866 * MIPS::
15867 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15868 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15869 * PowerPC::
15870 @end menu
15871
15872 @node i386
15873 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15874
15875 @table @code
15876 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15877 @kindex set struct-convention
15878 @cindex struct return convention
15879 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15880 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15881 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15882 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15883 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15884 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15885 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15886 be returned in a register.
15887
15888 @item show struct-convention
15889 @kindex show struct-convention
15890 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15891 from functions.
15892 @end table
15893
15894 @node A29K
15895 @subsection A29K
15896
15897 @table @code
15898
15899 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15900 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15901 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15902 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15903 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15904 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15905 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15906 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15907 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15908 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15909 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15910 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15911 hexadecimal.
15912
15913 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15914 @item show rstack_high_address
15915 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15916 processors.
15917
15918 @end table
15919
15920 @node Alpha
15921 @subsection Alpha
15922
15923 See the following section.
15924
15925 @node MIPS
15926 @subsection MIPS
15927
15928 @cindex stack on Alpha
15929 @cindex stack on MIPS
15930 @cindex Alpha stack
15931 @cindex MIPS stack
15932 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15933 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15934 find the beginning of a function.
15935
15936 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15937 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15938 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15939 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15940 commands:
15941
15942 @table @code
15943 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15944 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15945 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15946 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15947 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15948 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15949 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15950 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15951
15952 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15953 Display the current limit.
15954 @end table
15955
15956 @noindent
15957 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15958 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15959
15960 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15961 programs:
15962
15963 @table @code
15964 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15965 @kindex set mips abi
15966 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15967 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15968 values of @var{arg} are:
15969
15970 @table @samp
15971 @item auto
15972 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15973 default).
15974 @item o32
15975 @item o64
15976 @item n32
15977 @item n64
15978 @item eabi32
15979 @item eabi64
15980 @item auto
15981 @end table
15982
15983 @item show mips abi
15984 @kindex show mips abi
15985 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15986
15987 @item set mipsfpu
15988 @itemx show mipsfpu
15989 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15990
15991 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15992 @kindex set mips mask-address
15993 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15994 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15995 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15996 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15997 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15998
15999 @item show mips mask-address
16000 @kindex show mips mask-address
16001 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
16002 not.
16003
16004 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16005 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16006 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
16007 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
16008 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
16009 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
16010
16011 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16012 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16013 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
16014
16015 @item set debug mips
16016 @kindex set debug mips
16017 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
16018 target code in @value{GDBN}.
16019
16020 @item show debug mips
16021 @kindex show debug mips
16022 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
16023 @end table
16024
16025
16026 @node HPPA
16027 @subsection HPPA
16028 @cindex HPPA support
16029
16030 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
16031 following special commands:
16032
16033 @table @code
16034 @item set debug hppa
16035 @kindex set debug hppa
16036 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
16037 messages are to be displayed.
16038
16039 @item show debug hppa
16040 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
16041
16042 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
16043 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
16044 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
16045 given @var{address}.
16046
16047 @end table
16048
16049
16050 @node SPU
16051 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16052 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
16053 @cindex SPU
16054
16055 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
16056 it provides the following special commands:
16057
16058 @table @code
16059 @item info spu event
16060 @kindex info spu
16061 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
16062 and pending event status.
16063
16064 @item info spu signal
16065 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
16066 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
16067 notification channels.
16068
16069 @item info spu mailbox
16070 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
16071 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
16072 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
16073
16074 @item info spu dma
16075 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16076 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16077 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16078
16079 @item info spu proxydma
16080 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16081 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16082 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16083
16084 @end table
16085
16086 @node PowerPC
16087 @subsection PowerPC
16088 @cindex PowerPC architecture
16089
16090 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
16091 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
16092 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
16093 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
16094 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
16095
16096 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
16097 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
16098 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
16099
16100
16101 @node Controlling GDB
16102 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
16103
16104 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
16105 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
16106 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
16107 described here.
16108
16109 @menu
16110 * Prompt:: Prompt
16111 * Editing:: Command editing
16112 * Command History:: Command history
16113 * Screen Size:: Screen size
16114 * Numbers:: Numbers
16115 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
16116 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
16117 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
16118 @end menu
16119
16120 @node Prompt
16121 @section Prompt
16122
16123 @cindex prompt
16124
16125 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
16126 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
16127 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
16128 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
16129 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
16130 which one you are talking to.
16131
16132 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
16133 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
16134 or a prompt that does not.
16135
16136 @table @code
16137 @kindex set prompt
16138 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
16139 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
16140
16141 @kindex show prompt
16142 @item show prompt
16143 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
16144 @end table
16145
16146 @node Editing
16147 @section Command Editing
16148 @cindex readline
16149 @cindex command line editing
16150
16151 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
16152 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
16153 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
16154 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
16155 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
16156 debugging sessions.
16157
16158 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
16159 command @code{set}.
16160
16161 @table @code
16162 @kindex set editing
16163 @cindex editing
16164 @item set editing
16165 @itemx set editing on
16166 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
16167
16168 @item set editing off
16169 Disable command line editing.
16170
16171 @kindex show editing
16172 @item show editing
16173 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
16174 @end table
16175
16176 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
16177 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
16178 encouraged to read that chapter.
16179
16180 @node Command History
16181 @section Command History
16182 @cindex command history
16183
16184 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
16185 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
16186 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
16187 history facility.
16188
16189 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
16190 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
16191 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
16192
16193 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
16194 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
16195 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
16196 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
16197 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
16198 pressed on a line by itself.
16199
16200 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
16201 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
16202 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
16203 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
16204
16205 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
16206 history.
16207
16208 @table @code
16209 @cindex history substitution
16210 @cindex history file
16211 @kindex set history filename
16212 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
16213 @item set history filename @var{fname}
16214 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
16215 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
16216 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
16217 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
16218 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
16219 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
16220 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
16221 is not set.
16222
16223 @cindex save command history
16224 @kindex set history save
16225 @item set history save
16226 @itemx set history save on
16227 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
16228 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
16229
16230 @item set history save off
16231 Stop recording command history in a file.
16232
16233 @cindex history size
16234 @kindex set history size
16235 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
16236 @item set history size @var{size}
16237 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
16238 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
16239 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
16240 @end table
16241
16242 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
16243 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
16244
16245 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
16246 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
16247 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
16248 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
16249 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
16250 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
16251 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
16252 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
16253
16254 The commands to control history expansion are:
16255
16256 @table @code
16257 @item set history expansion on
16258 @itemx set history expansion
16259 @kindex set history expansion
16260 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
16261
16262 @item set history expansion off
16263 Disable history expansion.
16264
16265 @c @group
16266 @kindex show history
16267 @item show history
16268 @itemx show history filename
16269 @itemx show history save
16270 @itemx show history size
16271 @itemx show history expansion
16272 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
16273 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
16274 @c @end group
16275 @end table
16276
16277 @table @code
16278 @kindex show commands
16279 @cindex show last commands
16280 @cindex display command history
16281 @item show commands
16282 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
16283
16284 @item show commands @var{n}
16285 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
16286
16287 @item show commands +
16288 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
16289 @end table
16290
16291 @node Screen Size
16292 @section Screen Size
16293 @cindex size of screen
16294 @cindex pauses in output
16295
16296 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
16297 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
16298 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
16299 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
16300 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
16301 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
16302 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
16303 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
16304
16305 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
16306 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
16307 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
16308 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
16309 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
16310 width} commands:
16311
16312 @table @code
16313 @kindex set height
16314 @kindex set width
16315 @kindex show width
16316 @kindex show height
16317 @item set height @var{lpp}
16318 @itemx show height
16319 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
16320 @itemx show width
16321 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
16322 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
16323 commands display the current settings.
16324
16325 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
16326 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
16327 file or to an editor buffer.
16328
16329 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
16330 from wrapping its output.
16331
16332 @item set pagination on
16333 @itemx set pagination off
16334 @kindex set pagination
16335 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
16336 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
16337
16338 @item show pagination
16339 @kindex show pagination
16340 Show the current pagination mode.
16341 @end table
16342
16343 @node Numbers
16344 @section Numbers
16345 @cindex number representation
16346 @cindex entering numbers
16347
16348 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
16349 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
16350 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
16351 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
16352 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
16353 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
16354 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
16355 both input and output with the commands described below.
16356
16357 @table @code
16358 @kindex set input-radix
16359 @item set input-radix @var{base}
16360 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
16361 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16362 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
16363 example, any of
16364
16365 @smallexample
16366 set input-radix 012
16367 set input-radix 10.
16368 set input-radix 0xa
16369 @end smallexample
16370
16371 @noindent
16372 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
16373 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
16374 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
16375 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
16376 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
16377 change the radix.
16378
16379 @kindex set output-radix
16380 @item set output-radix @var{base}
16381 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
16382 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16383 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16384
16385 @kindex show input-radix
16386 @item show input-radix
16387 Display the current default base for numeric input.
16388
16389 @kindex show output-radix
16390 @item show output-radix
16391 Display the current default base for numeric display.
16392
16393 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16394 @itemx show radix
16395 @kindex set radix
16396 @kindex show radix
16397 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16398 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16399 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16400 default value of 10.
16401
16402 @end table
16403
16404 @node ABI
16405 @section Configuring the Current ABI
16406
16407 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16408 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16409 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16410 current ABI.
16411
16412 @cindex OS ABI
16413 @kindex set osabi
16414 @kindex show osabi
16415
16416 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16417 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16418 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16419 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16420 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16421 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16422 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16423 platform provides.
16424
16425 @table @code
16426 @item show osabi
16427 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16428
16429 @item set osabi
16430 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16431
16432 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16433 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16434 @end table
16435
16436 @cindex float promotion
16437
16438 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16439 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16440 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16441 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16442 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16443 @code{double} and then passed.
16444
16445 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16446 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16447 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16448
16449 @table @code
16450 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16451 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16452 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16453 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16454 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16455
16456 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16457 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16458 functions.
16459
16460 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16461 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16462 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16463 @end table
16464
16465 @kindex set cp-abi
16466 @kindex show cp-abi
16467 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16468 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16469 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16470 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16471 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16472 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16473 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16474 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16475 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16476 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16477 ``auto''.
16478
16479 @table @code
16480 @item show cp-abi
16481 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16482
16483 @item set cp-abi
16484 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16485
16486 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16487 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16488 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16489 @end table
16490
16491 @node Messages/Warnings
16492 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
16493
16494 @cindex verbose operation
16495 @cindex optional warnings
16496 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16497 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16498 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16499 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16500
16501 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16502 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16503 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16504
16505 @table @code
16506 @kindex set verbose
16507 @item set verbose on
16508 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16509
16510 @item set verbose off
16511 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16512
16513 @kindex show verbose
16514 @item show verbose
16515 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16516 @end table
16517
16518 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16519 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16520 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16521 Symbol Files}).
16522
16523 @table @code
16524
16525 @kindex set complaints
16526 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16527 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16528 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16529 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16530 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16531
16532 @kindex show complaints
16533 @item show complaints
16534 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16535
16536 @end table
16537
16538 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16539 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16540 you try to run a program which is already running:
16541
16542 @smallexample
16543 (@value{GDBP}) run
16544 The program being debugged has been started already.
16545 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16546 @end smallexample
16547
16548 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16549 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16550
16551 @table @code
16552
16553 @kindex set confirm
16554 @cindex flinching
16555 @cindex confirmation
16556 @cindex stupid questions
16557 @item set confirm off
16558 Disables confirmation requests.
16559
16560 @item set confirm on
16561 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16562
16563 @kindex show confirm
16564 @item show confirm
16565 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16566
16567 @end table
16568
16569 @cindex command tracing
16570 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16571 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16572 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16573 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16574
16575 @table @code
16576 @kindex set trace-commands
16577 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16578 @item set trace-commands on
16579 Enable command tracing.
16580 @item set trace-commands off
16581 Disable command tracing.
16582 @item show trace-commands
16583 Display the current state of command tracing.
16584 @end table
16585
16586 @node Debugging Output
16587 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16588 @cindex optional debugging messages
16589
16590 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16591 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16592 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16593 section documents those commands.
16594
16595 @table @code
16596 @kindex set exec-done-display
16597 @item set exec-done-display
16598 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16599 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16600 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16601 @kindex show exec-done-display
16602 @item show exec-done-display
16603 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16604 notification.
16605 @kindex set debug
16606 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16607 @cindex architecture debugging info
16608 @item set debug arch
16609 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16610 @kindex show debug
16611 @item show debug arch
16612 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16613 @item set debug aix-thread
16614 @cindex AIX threads
16615 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16616 module.
16617 @item show debug aix-thread
16618 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16619 @item set debug displaced
16620 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
16621 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
16622 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
16623 @item show debug displaced
16624 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
16625 related to displaced stepping.
16626 @item set debug event
16627 @cindex event debugging info
16628 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16629 default is off.
16630 @item show debug event
16631 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16632 info.
16633 @item set debug expression
16634 @cindex expression debugging info
16635 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16636 expression parsing. The default is off.
16637 @item show debug expression
16638 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16639 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16640 @item set debug frame
16641 @cindex frame debugging info
16642 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16643 default is off.
16644 @item show debug frame
16645 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16646 info.
16647 @item set debug infrun
16648 @cindex inferior debugging info
16649 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16650 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16651 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16652 @item show debug infrun
16653 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16654 @item set debug lin-lwp
16655 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16656 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16657 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16658 @item show debug lin-lwp
16659 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16660 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
16661 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
16662 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16663 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
16664 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
16665 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
16666 @item set debug observer
16667 @cindex observer debugging info
16668 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16669 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16670 @item show debug observer
16671 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16672 @item set debug overload
16673 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16674 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16675 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16676 is off.
16677 @item show debug overload
16678 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16679 debugging info.
16680 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16681 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16682 @cindex debug remote protocol
16683 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16684 @cindex display remote packets
16685 @item set debug remote
16686 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16687 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16688 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16689 @item show debug remote
16690 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16691 @item set debug serial
16692 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16693 default is off.
16694 @item show debug serial
16695 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16696 info.
16697 @item set debug solib-frv
16698 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16699 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16700 @item show debug solib-frv
16701 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16702 messages.
16703 @item set debug target
16704 @cindex target debugging info
16705 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16706 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16707 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16708 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16709 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16710 @item show debug target
16711 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16712 info.
16713 @item set debug timestamp
16714 @cindex timestampping debugging info
16715 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
16716 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
16717 message.
16718 @item show debug timestamp
16719 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
16720 debugging info.
16721 @item set debugvarobj
16722 @cindex variable object debugging info
16723 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16724 info. The default is off.
16725 @item show debugvarobj
16726 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16727 debugging info.
16728 @item set debug xml
16729 @cindex XML parser debugging
16730 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16731 @item show debug xml
16732 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16733 @end table
16734
16735 @node Sequences
16736 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16737
16738 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16739 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16740 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16741 files.
16742
16743 @menu
16744 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16745 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16746 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16747 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16748 @end menu
16749
16750 @node Define
16751 @section User-defined Commands
16752
16753 @cindex user-defined command
16754 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16755 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16756 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16757 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16758 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16759 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16760
16761 @smallexample
16762 define adder
16763 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16764 end
16765 @end smallexample
16766
16767 @noindent
16768 To execute the command use:
16769
16770 @smallexample
16771 adder 1 2 3
16772 @end smallexample
16773
16774 @noindent
16775 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16776 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16777 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16778 functions calls.
16779
16780 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16781 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16782 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16783 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16784
16785 @smallexample
16786 define adder
16787 if $argc == 2
16788 print $arg0 + $arg1
16789 end
16790 if $argc == 3
16791 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16792 end
16793 end
16794 @end smallexample
16795
16796 @table @code
16797
16798 @kindex define
16799 @item define @var{commandname}
16800 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16801 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16802
16803 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16804 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16805 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16806
16807 @kindex document
16808 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16809 @item document @var{commandname}
16810 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16811 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16812 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16813 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16814 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16815 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16816
16817 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16818 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16819 does not change the documentation.
16820
16821 @kindex dont-repeat
16822 @cindex don't repeat command
16823 @item dont-repeat
16824 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16825 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16826 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16827
16828 @kindex help user-defined
16829 @item help user-defined
16830 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16831 (if any) for each.
16832
16833 @kindex show user
16834 @item show user
16835 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16836 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16837 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16838 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16839
16840 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16841 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16842 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16843 @item show max-user-call-depth
16844 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16845 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16846 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16847 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16848 @end table
16849
16850 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16851 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16852
16853 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16854 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16855 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16856
16857 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16858 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16859 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16860 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16861
16862 @node Hooks
16863 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16864 @cindex command hooks
16865 @cindex hooks, for commands
16866 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16867
16868 @kindex hook
16869 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16870 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16871 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16872 before that command.
16873
16874 @cindex hooks, post-command
16875 @kindex hookpost
16876 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16877 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16878 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16879 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16880 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16881
16882 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16883 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16884
16885 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16886 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16887
16888 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16889 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16890 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16891 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16892 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16893
16894 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16895 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16896 you could define:
16897
16898 @smallexample
16899 define hook-stop
16900 handle SIGALRM nopass
16901 end
16902
16903 define hook-run
16904 handle SIGALRM pass
16905 end
16906
16907 define hook-continue
16908 handle SIGALRM pass
16909 end
16910 @end smallexample
16911
16912 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16913 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16914 you could define:
16915
16916 @smallexample
16917 define hook-echo
16918 echo <<<---
16919 end
16920
16921 define hookpost-echo
16922 echo --->>>\n
16923 end
16924
16925 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16926 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16927 (@value{GDBP})
16928
16929 @end smallexample
16930
16931 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16932 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16933 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16934 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16935 @c or not?
16936 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16937 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16938 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16939
16940 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16941 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16942
16943 @node Command Files
16944 @section Command Files
16945
16946 @cindex command files
16947 @cindex scripting commands
16948 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16949 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16950 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16951 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16952 terminal.
16953
16954 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16955 command:
16956
16957 @table @code
16958 @kindex source
16959 @cindex execute commands from a file
16960 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16961 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16962 @end table
16963
16964 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16965 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16966 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16967 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16968 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16969
16970 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16971 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16972
16973 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16974 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16975 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16976
16977 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16978 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16979 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16980 when called from command files.
16981
16982 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16983 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16984 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16985 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16986 the next command.
16987
16988 @smallexample
16989 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16990 @end smallexample
16991
16992 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16993 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16994 would be directed to @file{log}.
16995
16996 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16997 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16998 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16999 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
17000 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
17001 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
17002 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
17003 conditionally, etc.
17004
17005 @table @code
17006 @kindex if
17007 @kindex else
17008 @item if
17009 @itemx else
17010 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
17011 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
17012 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
17013 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
17014 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
17015 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
17016 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17017
17018 @kindex while
17019 @item while
17020 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
17021 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
17022 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
17023 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
17024 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
17025 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
17026
17027 @kindex loop_break
17028 @item loop_break
17029 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
17030 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
17031 line.
17032
17033 @kindex loop_continue
17034 @item loop_continue
17035 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
17036 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
17037 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
17038 the controlling expression.
17039
17040 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
17041 @item end
17042 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
17043 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
17044 @end table
17045
17046
17047 @node Output
17048 @section Commands for Controlled Output
17049
17050 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
17051 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
17052 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
17053 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
17054 want.
17055
17056 @table @code
17057 @kindex echo
17058 @item echo @var{text}
17059 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
17060 @c because it is not in ANSI.
17061 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
17062 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
17063 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
17064 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
17065 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
17066 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
17067 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
17068 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
17069 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
17070
17071 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
17072 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
17073
17074 @smallexample
17075 echo This is some text\n\
17076 which is continued\n\
17077 onto several lines.\n
17078 @end smallexample
17079
17080 produces the same output as
17081
17082 @smallexample
17083 echo This is some text\n
17084 echo which is continued\n
17085 echo onto several lines.\n
17086 @end smallexample
17087
17088 @kindex output
17089 @item output @var{expression}
17090 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
17091 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
17092 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
17093 on expressions.
17094
17095 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
17096 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
17097 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
17098 Formats}, for more information.
17099
17100 @kindex printf
17101 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
17102 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
17103 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
17104 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
17105 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
17106 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
17107 executing the code below:
17108
17109 @smallexample
17110 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
17111 @end smallexample
17112
17113 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
17114 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
17115 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
17116 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
17117 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
17118 printed.
17119
17120 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
17121
17122 @smallexample
17123 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
17124 @end smallexample
17125
17126 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
17127 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
17128 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
17129
17130 @itemize @bullet
17131 @item
17132 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
17133
17134 @item
17135 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
17136 width.
17137
17138 @item
17139 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
17140 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
17141
17142 @item
17143 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
17144 supported.
17145
17146 @item
17147 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
17148
17149 @item
17150 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
17151 @end itemize
17152
17153 @noindent
17154 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
17155 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
17156 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
17157 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
17158
17159 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
17160 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
17161 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
17162 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
17163 supported.
17164
17165 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
17166 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
17167 together with a floating point specifier.
17168 letters:
17169
17170 @itemize @bullet
17171 @item
17172 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
17173
17174 @item
17175 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
17176
17177 @item
17178 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
17179 @end itemize
17180
17181 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
17182 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
17183 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
17184
17185 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
17186 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
17187
17188 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
17189 @smallexample
17190 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
17191 @end smallexample
17192
17193 @end table
17194
17195 @node Interpreters
17196 @chapter Command Interpreters
17197 @cindex command interpreters
17198
17199 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
17200 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
17201 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
17202
17203 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
17204 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
17205 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
17206 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
17207
17208 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
17209 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
17210 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
17211 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
17212
17213 @table @code
17214 @item console
17215 @cindex console interpreter
17216 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
17217 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
17218 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
17219
17220 @item mi
17221 @cindex mi interpreter
17222 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
17223 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
17224 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
17225 Interface}.
17226
17227 @item mi2
17228 @cindex mi2 interpreter
17229 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
17230
17231 @item mi1
17232 @cindex mi1 interpreter
17233 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
17234
17235 @end table
17236
17237 @cindex invoke another interpreter
17238 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
17239 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
17240 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
17241 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
17242 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
17243 the IDE inoperable!
17244
17245 @kindex interpreter-exec
17246 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
17247 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
17248 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
17249 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
17250
17251 @smallexample
17252 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
17253 @end smallexample
17254
17255 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
17256 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
17257
17258 @node TUI
17259 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
17260 @cindex TUI
17261 @cindex Text User Interface
17262
17263 @menu
17264 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
17265 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
17266 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
17267 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
17268 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
17269 @end menu
17270
17271 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
17272 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
17273 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
17274 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
17275 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
17276 is available.
17277
17278 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
17279 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
17280 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
17281 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
17282 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
17283 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
17284
17285 @node TUI Overview
17286 @section TUI Overview
17287
17288 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
17289
17290 @table @emph
17291 @item command
17292 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
17293 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
17294 managed using readline.
17295
17296 @item source
17297 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
17298 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
17299
17300 @item assembly
17301 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
17302
17303 @item register
17304 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
17305 when their values change.
17306 @end table
17307
17308 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
17309 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
17310 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
17311 indicates the breakpoint type:
17312
17313 @table @code
17314 @item B
17315 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17316
17317 @item b
17318 Breakpoint which was never hit.
17319
17320 @item H
17321 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17322
17323 @item h
17324 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
17325 @end table
17326
17327 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
17328
17329 @table @code
17330 @item +
17331 Breakpoint is enabled.
17332
17333 @item -
17334 Breakpoint is disabled.
17335 @end table
17336
17337 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
17338 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
17339 changes.
17340
17341 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
17342 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
17343 layouts:
17344
17345 @itemize @bullet
17346 @item
17347 source only,
17348
17349 @item
17350 assembly only,
17351
17352 @item
17353 source and assembly,
17354
17355 @item
17356 source and registers, or
17357
17358 @item
17359 assembly and registers.
17360 @end itemize
17361
17362 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
17363
17364 @table @emph
17365 @item target
17366 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
17367 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
17368
17369 @item process
17370 Gives the current process or thread number.
17371 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
17372
17373 @item function
17374 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
17375 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
17376 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
17377 the string @code{??} is displayed.
17378
17379 @item line
17380 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
17381 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
17382
17383 @item pc
17384 Indicates the current program counter address.
17385 @end table
17386
17387 @node TUI Keys
17388 @section TUI Key Bindings
17389 @cindex TUI key bindings
17390
17391 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
17392 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
17393 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
17394
17395 @table @kbd
17396 @kindex C-x C-a
17397 @item C-x C-a
17398 @kindex C-x a
17399 @itemx C-x a
17400 @kindex C-x A
17401 @itemx C-x A
17402 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
17403 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
17404 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
17405 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
17406 The screen is then refreshed.
17407
17408 @kindex C-x 1
17409 @item C-x 1
17410 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
17411 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
17412 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
17413
17414 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
17415
17416 @kindex C-x 2
17417 @item C-x 2
17418 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
17419 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
17420 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
17421 previous layout and the new one.
17422
17423 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
17424
17425 @kindex C-x o
17426 @item C-x o
17427 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17428 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
17429 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17430
17431 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17432
17433 @kindex C-x s
17434 @item C-x s
17435 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
17436 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17437 @end table
17438
17439 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
17440
17441 @table @asis
17442 @kindex PgUp
17443 @item @key{PgUp}
17444 Scroll the active window one page up.
17445
17446 @kindex PgDn
17447 @item @key{PgDn}
17448 Scroll the active window one page down.
17449
17450 @kindex Up
17451 @item @key{Up}
17452 Scroll the active window one line up.
17453
17454 @kindex Down
17455 @item @key{Down}
17456 Scroll the active window one line down.
17457
17458 @kindex Left
17459 @item @key{Left}
17460 Scroll the active window one column left.
17461
17462 @kindex Right
17463 @item @key{Right}
17464 Scroll the active window one column right.
17465
17466 @kindex C-L
17467 @item @kbd{C-L}
17468 Refresh the screen.
17469 @end table
17470
17471 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17472 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17473 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17474 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17475 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17476
17477 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17478 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17479 @cindex TUI single key mode
17480
17481 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17482 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17483 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17484
17485 @table @kbd
17486 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17487 @item c
17488 continue
17489
17490 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17491 @item d
17492 down
17493
17494 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17495 @item f
17496 finish
17497
17498 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17499 @item n
17500 next
17501
17502 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17503 @item q
17504 exit the SingleKey mode.
17505
17506 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17507 @item r
17508 run
17509
17510 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17511 @item s
17512 step
17513
17514 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17515 @item u
17516 up
17517
17518 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17519 @item v
17520 info locals
17521
17522 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17523 @item w
17524 where
17525 @end table
17526
17527 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17528 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17529 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17530 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17531 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17532 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17533
17534
17535 @node TUI Commands
17536 @section TUI-specific Commands
17537 @cindex TUI commands
17538
17539 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17540 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
17541 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
17542 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
17543
17544 @table @code
17545 @item info win
17546 @kindex info win
17547 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17548
17549 @item layout next
17550 @kindex layout
17551 Display the next layout.
17552
17553 @item layout prev
17554 Display the previous layout.
17555
17556 @item layout src
17557 Display the source window only.
17558
17559 @item layout asm
17560 Display the assembly window only.
17561
17562 @item layout split
17563 Display the source and assembly window.
17564
17565 @item layout regs
17566 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17567
17568 @item focus next
17569 @kindex focus
17570 Make the next window active for scrolling.
17571
17572 @item focus prev
17573 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
17574
17575 @item focus src
17576 Make the source window active for scrolling.
17577
17578 @item focus asm
17579 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
17580
17581 @item focus regs
17582 Make the register window active for scrolling.
17583
17584 @item focus cmd
17585 Make the command window active for scrolling.
17586
17587 @item refresh
17588 @kindex refresh
17589 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17590
17591 @item tui reg float
17592 @kindex tui reg
17593 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17594
17595 @item tui reg general
17596 Show the general registers in the register window.
17597
17598 @item tui reg next
17599 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17600 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17601 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17602 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17603
17604 @item tui reg system
17605 Show the system registers in the register window.
17606
17607 @item update
17608 @kindex update
17609 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17610
17611 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17612 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17613 @kindex winheight
17614 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17615 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17616 decrease it.
17617
17618 @item tabset @var{nchars}
17619 @kindex tabset
17620 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17621 @end table
17622
17623 @node TUI Configuration
17624 @section TUI Configuration Variables
17625 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17626
17627 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
17628
17629 @table @code
17630 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17631 @kindex set tui border-kind
17632 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17633 The possible values are the following:
17634 @table @code
17635 @item space
17636 Use a space character to draw the border.
17637
17638 @item ascii
17639 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
17640
17641 @item acs
17642 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17643 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17644 @end table
17645
17646 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17647 @kindex set tui border-mode
17648 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17649 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17650 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
17651 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17652 @table @code
17653 @item normal
17654 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17655
17656 @item standout
17657 Use standout mode.
17658
17659 @item reverse
17660 Use reverse video mode.
17661
17662 @item half
17663 Use half bright mode.
17664
17665 @item half-standout
17666 Use half bright and standout mode.
17667
17668 @item bold
17669 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17670
17671 @item bold-standout
17672 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17673 @end table
17674 @end table
17675
17676 @node Emacs
17677 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17678
17679 @cindex Emacs
17680 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17681 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17682 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17683 @value{GDBN}.
17684
17685 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17686 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17687 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17688 created Emacs buffer.
17689 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17690
17691 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17692 things:
17693
17694 @itemize @bullet
17695 @item
17696 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17697 the GUD buffer.
17698
17699 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17700 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17701
17702 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17703 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17704 in this way.
17705
17706 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17707 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17708 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17709 stop.
17710
17711 @item
17712 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17713
17714 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17715 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17716 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17717 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17718 and the source.
17719
17720 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17721 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17722 @end itemize
17723
17724 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17725 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17726 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17727 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17728
17729 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17730 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17731 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17732 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17733 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17734 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17735 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17736 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17737 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17738
17739 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17740 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17741 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17742 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17743
17744 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17745 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17746 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17747 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17748 one you want.
17749
17750 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17751 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17752
17753 @table @kbd
17754 @item C-h m
17755 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17756
17757 @item C-c C-s
17758 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17759 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17760
17761 @item C-c C-n
17762 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17763 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17764 to show the current file and location.
17765
17766 @item C-c C-i
17767 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17768 display window accordingly.
17769
17770 @item C-c C-f
17771 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17772 @code{finish} command.
17773
17774 @item C-c C-r
17775 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17776 command.
17777
17778 @item C-c <
17779 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17780 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17781 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17782
17783 @item C-c >
17784 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17785 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17786 @end table
17787
17788 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17789 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17790
17791 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17792 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17793 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17794 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17795 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17796 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17797 speedbar displays watch expressions.
17798
17799 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17800 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17801 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17802 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17803 frame.
17804
17805 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17806 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17807 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17808 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17809 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17810 to correspond properly with the code.
17811
17812 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17813 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17814 Emacs Manual}).
17815
17816 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17817 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17818 @ignore
17819 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17820 @kindex Epoch
17821 @kindex inspect
17822
17823 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17824 called the @code{epoch}
17825 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17826 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17827 each value is printed in its own window.
17828 @end ignore
17829
17830
17831 @node GDB/MI
17832 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17833
17834 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17835
17836 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17837 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17838 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17839 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17840 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17841 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17842
17843 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17844 in the form of a reference manual.
17845
17846 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17847 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17848 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17849
17850 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17851
17852 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17853 This chapter uses the following notation:
17854
17855 @itemize @bullet
17856 @item
17857 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17858
17859 @item
17860 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17861 it may or may not be given.
17862
17863 @item
17864 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17865 may repeat zero or more times.
17866
17867 @item
17868 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17869 may repeat one or more times.
17870
17871 @item
17872 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17873 @end itemize
17874
17875 @ignore
17876 @heading Dependencies
17877 @end ignore
17878
17879 @menu
17880 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17881 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17882 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17883 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17884 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17885 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17886 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17887 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17888 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17889 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17890 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17891 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17892 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17893 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17894 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17895 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17896 @ignore
17897 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17898 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17899 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17900 @end ignore
17901 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17902 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
17903 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17904 @end menu
17905
17906 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17907 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17908 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17909
17910 @menu
17911 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17912 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17913 @end menu
17914
17915 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17916 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17917
17918 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17919 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17920 @table @code
17921 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17922 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17923
17924 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17925 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17926 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17927
17928 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17929 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17930 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17931
17932 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17933 "any sequence of digits"
17934
17935 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17936 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17937
17938 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17939 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17940
17941 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17942 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17943
17944 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17945 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17946 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17947
17948 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17949 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17950
17951 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17952 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17953 @end table
17954
17955 @noindent
17956 Notes:
17957
17958 @itemize @bullet
17959 @item
17960 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17961 output is described below.
17962
17963 @item
17964 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17965 finishes.
17966
17967 @item
17968 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17969 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17970 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17971 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17972 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17973 @end itemize
17974
17975 Pragmatics:
17976
17977 @itemize @bullet
17978 @item
17979 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17980
17981 @item
17982 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17983 @end itemize
17984
17985 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17986 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17987
17988 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17989 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17990 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17991 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17992 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17993 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17994
17995 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17996 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17997 @var{token}.
17998
17999 @table @code
18000 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
18001 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
18002
18003 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
18004 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
18005
18006 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
18007 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
18008
18009 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
18010 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
18011
18012 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
18013 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
18014
18015 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
18016 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
18017
18018 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
18019 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
18020
18021 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
18022 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
18023
18024 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
18025 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
18026
18027 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
18028 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
18029 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
18030
18031 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
18032 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
18033
18034 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
18035 @code{ @var{string} }
18036
18037 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
18038 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
18039
18040 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
18041 @code{@var{c-string}}
18042
18043 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
18044 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
18045
18046 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
18047 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
18048 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
18049
18050 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
18051 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
18052
18053 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
18054 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
18055
18056 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
18057 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
18058
18059 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
18060 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
18061
18062 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
18063 @code{CR | CR-LF}
18064
18065 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
18066 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
18067 @end table
18068
18069 @noindent
18070 Notes:
18071
18072 @itemize @bullet
18073 @item
18074 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
18075
18076 @item
18077 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
18078 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
18079 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
18080 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
18081 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
18082 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
18083 prior command.
18084
18085 @item
18086 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18087 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
18088 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
18089 prefixed by @samp{+}.
18090
18091 @item
18092 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18093 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
18094 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
18095 @samp{*}.
18096
18097 @item
18098 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18099 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
18100 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
18101 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
18102
18103 @item
18104 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18105 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
18106 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
18107 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
18108
18109 @item
18110 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18111 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
18112 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
18113
18114 @item
18115 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18116 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
18117 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
18118 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
18119
18120 @item
18121 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18122 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
18123 @var{values}.
18124
18125
18126 @end itemize
18127
18128 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
18129 details about the various output records.
18130
18131 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18132 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
18133 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
18134
18135 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
18136 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
18137
18138 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
18139 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
18140 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
18141 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
18142 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
18143 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
18144
18145 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
18146 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
18147 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
18148
18149 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18150 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
18151 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
18152 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
18153
18154 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
18155 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
18156
18157 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
18158 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
18159 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
18160 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
18161 might change.
18162
18163 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
18164 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
18165 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
18166 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
18167
18168 @itemize @bullet
18169 @item
18170 New MI commands may be added.
18171
18172 @item
18173 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
18174
18175 @item
18176 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
18177 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
18178
18179 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
18180 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
18181
18182 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
18183 @c resolve inconsistencies.
18184 @end itemize
18185
18186 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
18187 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
18188 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
18189 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
18190 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
18191
18192 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
18193 @c version?
18194
18195 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
18196 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
18197 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
18198 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
18199 @cindex mailing lists
18200
18201 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18202 @node GDB/MI Output Records
18203 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
18204
18205 @menu
18206 * GDB/MI Result Records::
18207 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
18208 * GDB/MI Async Records::
18209 @end menu
18210
18211 @node GDB/MI Result Records
18212 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
18213
18214 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18215 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
18216 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
18217 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
18218
18219 @table @code
18220 @findex ^done
18221 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
18222 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
18223 values.
18224
18225 @item "^running"
18226 @findex ^running
18227 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
18228 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
18229 running.
18230
18231 @item "^connected"
18232 @findex ^connected
18233 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
18234
18235 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
18236 @findex ^error
18237 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
18238 error message.
18239
18240 @item "^exit"
18241 @findex ^exit
18242 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
18243
18244 @end table
18245
18246 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
18247 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
18248
18249 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
18250 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18251 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
18252 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
18253 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
18254
18255 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
18256 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
18257 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
18258 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
18259 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
18260
18261 @table @code
18262 @item "~" @var{string-output}
18263 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
18264 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
18265
18266 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
18267 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
18268 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
18269 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
18270
18271 @item "&" @var{string-output}
18272 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
18273 internals.
18274 @end table
18275
18276 @node GDB/MI Async Records
18277 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
18278
18279 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18280 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
18281 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
18282 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
18283 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
18284 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
18285
18286 The following is the list of possible async records:
18287
18288 @table @code
18289
18290 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
18291 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
18292 following values:
18293
18294 @table @code
18295 @item breakpoint-hit
18296 A breakpoint was reached.
18297 @item watchpoint-trigger
18298 A watchpoint was triggered.
18299 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
18300 A read watchpoint was triggered.
18301 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
18302 An access watchpoint was triggered.
18303 @item function-finished
18304 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18305 @item location-reached
18306 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18307 @item watchpoint-scope
18308 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
18309 @item end-stepping-range
18310 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
18311 similar CLI command was accomplished.
18312 @item exited-signalled
18313 The inferior exited because of a signal.
18314 @item exited
18315 The inferior exited.
18316 @item exited-normally
18317 The inferior exited normally.
18318 @item signal-received
18319 A signal was received by the inferior.
18320 @end table
18321
18322 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}"
18323 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}"
18324 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
18325 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread.
18326 @end table
18327
18328
18329
18330 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18331 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
18332 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
18333 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
18334
18335 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
18336 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
18337 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
18338 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
18339
18340 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
18341 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
18342
18343 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
18344
18345 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
18346 information of the breakpoint.
18347
18348 @smallexample
18349 -> -break-insert main
18350 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18351 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
18352 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
18353 <- (gdb)
18354 @end smallexample
18355
18356 @subheading Program Execution
18357
18358 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
18359 reason that execution stopped.
18360
18361 @smallexample
18362 -> -exec-run
18363 <- ^running
18364 <- (gdb)
18365 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
18366 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
18367 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
18368 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
18369 <- (gdb)
18370 -> -exec-continue
18371 <- ^running
18372 <- (gdb)
18373 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18374 <- (gdb)
18375 @end smallexample
18376
18377 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
18378
18379 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
18380
18381 @smallexample
18382 -> (gdb)
18383 <- -gdb-exit
18384 <- ^exit
18385 @end smallexample
18386
18387 @subheading A Bad Command
18388
18389 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
18390
18391 @smallexample
18392 -> -rubbish
18393 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
18394 <- (gdb)
18395 @end smallexample
18396
18397
18398 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18399 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
18400 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
18401
18402 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
18403 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
18404
18405 @subheading Motivation
18406
18407 The motivation for this collection of commands.
18408
18409 @subheading Introduction
18410
18411 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
18412
18413 @subheading Commands
18414
18415 For each command in the block, the following is described:
18416
18417 @subsubheading Synopsis
18418
18419 @smallexample
18420 -command @var{args}@dots{}
18421 @end smallexample
18422
18423 @subsubheading Result
18424
18425 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18426
18427 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
18428
18429 @subsubheading Example
18430
18431 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
18432 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18433
18434
18435 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18436 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18437 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18438
18439 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18440 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18441 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18442 breakpoints.
18443
18444 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18445 @findex -break-after
18446
18447 @subsubheading Synopsis
18448
18449 @smallexample
18450 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18451 @end smallexample
18452
18453 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18454 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18455 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18456 @samp{-break-list} command below.
18457
18458 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18459
18460 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18461
18462 @subsubheading Example
18463
18464 @smallexample
18465 (gdb)
18466 -break-insert main
18467 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18468 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
18469 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18470 (gdb)
18471 -break-after 1 3
18472 ~
18473 ^done
18474 (gdb)
18475 -break-list
18476 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18477 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18478 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18479 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18480 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18481 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18482 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18483 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18484 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18485 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18486 (gdb)
18487 @end smallexample
18488
18489 @ignore
18490 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18491 @findex -break-catch
18492
18493 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18494 @findex -break-commands
18495 @end ignore
18496
18497
18498 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18499 @findex -break-condition
18500
18501 @subsubheading Synopsis
18502
18503 @smallexample
18504 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18505 @end smallexample
18506
18507 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18508 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18509 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18510 command below).
18511
18512 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18513
18514 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18515
18516 @subsubheading Example
18517
18518 @smallexample
18519 (gdb)
18520 -break-condition 1 1
18521 ^done
18522 (gdb)
18523 -break-list
18524 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18525 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18526 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18527 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18528 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18529 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18530 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18531 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18532 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18533 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18534 (gdb)
18535 @end smallexample
18536
18537 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18538 @findex -break-delete
18539
18540 @subsubheading Synopsis
18541
18542 @smallexample
18543 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18544 @end smallexample
18545
18546 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18547 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18548
18549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18550
18551 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18552
18553 @subsubheading Example
18554
18555 @smallexample
18556 (gdb)
18557 -break-delete 1
18558 ^done
18559 (gdb)
18560 -break-list
18561 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18562 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18563 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18564 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18565 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18566 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18567 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18568 body=[]@}
18569 (gdb)
18570 @end smallexample
18571
18572 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18573 @findex -break-disable
18574
18575 @subsubheading Synopsis
18576
18577 @smallexample
18578 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18579 @end smallexample
18580
18581 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18582 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18583
18584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18585
18586 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18587
18588 @subsubheading Example
18589
18590 @smallexample
18591 (gdb)
18592 -break-disable 2
18593 ^done
18594 (gdb)
18595 -break-list
18596 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18597 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18598 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18599 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18600 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18601 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18602 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18603 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18604 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18605 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18606 (gdb)
18607 @end smallexample
18608
18609 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18610 @findex -break-enable
18611
18612 @subsubheading Synopsis
18613
18614 @smallexample
18615 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18616 @end smallexample
18617
18618 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18619
18620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18621
18622 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18623
18624 @subsubheading Example
18625
18626 @smallexample
18627 (gdb)
18628 -break-enable 2
18629 ^done
18630 (gdb)
18631 -break-list
18632 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18633 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18634 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18635 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18636 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18637 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18638 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18639 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18640 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18641 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18642 (gdb)
18643 @end smallexample
18644
18645 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18646 @findex -break-info
18647
18648 @subsubheading Synopsis
18649
18650 @smallexample
18651 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18652 @end smallexample
18653
18654 @c REDUNDANT???
18655 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18656
18657 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18658
18659 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18660
18661 @subsubheading Example
18662 N.A.
18663
18664 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18665 @findex -break-insert
18666
18667 @subsubheading Synopsis
18668
18669 @smallexample
18670 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
18671 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18672 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
18673 @end smallexample
18674
18675 @noindent
18676 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
18677
18678 @itemize @bullet
18679 @item function
18680 @c @item +offset
18681 @c @item -offset
18682 @c @item linenum
18683 @item filename:linenum
18684 @item filename:function
18685 @item *address
18686 @end itemize
18687
18688 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18689
18690 @table @samp
18691 @item -t
18692 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18693 @item -h
18694 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18695 @item -c @var{condition}
18696 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18697 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18698 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18699 @item -f
18700 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
18701 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
18702 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
18703 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
18704 cannot be parsed.
18705 @end table
18706
18707 @subsubheading Result
18708
18709 The result is in the form:
18710
18711 @smallexample
18712 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18713 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18714 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18715 times="@var{times}"@}
18716 @end smallexample
18717
18718 @noindent
18719 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18720 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18721 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18722 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18723 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18724 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18725 which use the same output).
18726
18727 Note: this format is open to change.
18728 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18729
18730 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18731
18732 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18733 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18734
18735 @subsubheading Example
18736
18737 @smallexample
18738 (gdb)
18739 -break-insert main
18740 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18741 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18742 (gdb)
18743 -break-insert -t foo
18744 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18745 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18746 (gdb)
18747 -break-list
18748 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18749 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18750 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18751 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18752 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18753 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18754 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18755 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18756 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18757 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18758 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18759 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18760 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18761 (gdb)
18762 -break-insert -r foo.*
18763 ~int foo(int, int);
18764 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18765 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18766 (gdb)
18767 @end smallexample
18768
18769 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18770 @findex -break-list
18771
18772 @subsubheading Synopsis
18773
18774 @smallexample
18775 -break-list
18776 @end smallexample
18777
18778 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18779
18780 @table @samp
18781 @item Number
18782 number of the breakpoint
18783 @item Type
18784 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18785 @item Disposition
18786 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18787 or @samp{nokeep}
18788 @item Enabled
18789 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18790 @item Address
18791 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18792 @item What
18793 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18794 name, line number
18795 @item Times
18796 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18797 @end table
18798
18799 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18800 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18801
18802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18803
18804 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18805
18806 @subsubheading Example
18807
18808 @smallexample
18809 (gdb)
18810 -break-list
18811 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18812 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18813 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18814 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18815 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18816 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18817 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18818 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18819 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18820 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18821 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18822 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18823 (gdb)
18824 @end smallexample
18825
18826 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18827
18828 @smallexample
18829 (gdb)
18830 -break-list
18831 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18832 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18833 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18834 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18835 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18836 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18837 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18838 body=[]@}
18839 (gdb)
18840 @end smallexample
18841
18842 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18843 @findex -break-watch
18844
18845 @subsubheading Synopsis
18846
18847 @smallexample
18848 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18849 @end smallexample
18850
18851 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18852 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18853 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18854 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18855 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18856 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18857 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18858 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18859
18860 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18861 breakpoints inserted.
18862
18863 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18864
18865 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18866 @samp{rwatch}.
18867
18868 @subsubheading Example
18869
18870 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18871
18872 @smallexample
18873 (gdb)
18874 -break-watch x
18875 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18876 (gdb)
18877 -exec-continue
18878 ^running
18879 (gdb)
18880 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18881 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18882 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18883 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18884 (gdb)
18885 @end smallexample
18886
18887 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18888 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18889 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18890
18891 @smallexample
18892 (gdb)
18893 -break-watch C
18894 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18895 (gdb)
18896 -exec-continue
18897 ^running
18898 (gdb)
18899 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18900 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18901 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18902 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18903 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18904 (gdb)
18905 -exec-continue
18906 ^running
18907 (gdb)
18908 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18909 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18910 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18911 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18912 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18913 (gdb)
18914 @end smallexample
18915
18916 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18917 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18918 deleted.
18919
18920 @smallexample
18921 (gdb)
18922 -break-watch C
18923 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18924 (gdb)
18925 -break-list
18926 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18927 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18928 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18929 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18930 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18931 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18932 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18933 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18934 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18935 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18936 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18937 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18938 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18939 (gdb)
18940 -exec-continue
18941 ^running
18942 (gdb)
18943 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18944 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18945 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18946 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18947 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18948 (gdb)
18949 -break-list
18950 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18951 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18952 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18953 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18954 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18955 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18956 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18957 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18958 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18959 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18960 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18961 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18962 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18963 (gdb)
18964 -exec-continue
18965 ^running
18966 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18967 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18968 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18969 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18970 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18971 (gdb)
18972 -break-list
18973 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18974 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18975 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18976 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18977 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18978 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18979 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18980 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18981 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18982 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18983 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18984 times="1"@}]@}
18985 (gdb)
18986 @end smallexample
18987
18988 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18989 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18990 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18991
18992 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18993 @findex -exec-arguments
18994
18995
18996 @subsubheading Synopsis
18997
18998 @smallexample
18999 -exec-arguments @var{args}
19000 @end smallexample
19001
19002 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
19003 @samp{-exec-run}.
19004
19005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19006
19007 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
19008
19009 @subsubheading Example
19010
19011 @c FIXME!
19012 Don't have one around.
19013
19014
19015 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
19016 @findex -exec-show-arguments
19017
19018 @subsubheading Synopsis
19019
19020 @smallexample
19021 -exec-show-arguments
19022 @end smallexample
19023
19024 Print the arguments of the program.
19025
19026 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19027
19028 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
19029
19030 @subsubheading Example
19031 N.A.
19032
19033
19034 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
19035 @findex -environment-cd
19036
19037 @subsubheading Synopsis
19038
19039 @smallexample
19040 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
19041 @end smallexample
19042
19043 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
19044
19045 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19046
19047 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
19048
19049 @subsubheading Example
19050
19051 @smallexample
19052 (gdb)
19053 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
19054 ^done
19055 (gdb)
19056 @end smallexample
19057
19058
19059 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
19060 @findex -environment-directory
19061
19062 @subsubheading Synopsis
19063
19064 @smallexample
19065 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
19066 @end smallexample
19067
19068 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
19069 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
19070 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
19071 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
19072 occurs as normal.
19073 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
19074 multiple directories in a single command
19075 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
19076 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
19077 If blanks are needed as
19078 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
19079 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
19080 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
19081 character must not be used
19082 in any directory name.
19083 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
19084
19085 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19086
19087 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
19088
19089 @subsubheading Example
19090
19091 @smallexample
19092 (gdb)
19093 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
19094 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
19095 (gdb)
19096 -environment-directory ""
19097 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
19098 (gdb)
19099 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
19100 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
19101 (gdb)
19102 -environment-directory -r
19103 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
19104 (gdb)
19105 @end smallexample
19106
19107
19108 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
19109 @findex -environment-path
19110
19111 @subsubheading Synopsis
19112
19113 @smallexample
19114 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
19115 @end smallexample
19116
19117 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
19118 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
19119 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
19120 supplied in addition to the
19121 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
19122 occurs as normal.
19123 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
19124 multiple directories in a single command
19125 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
19126 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
19127 If blanks are needed as
19128 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
19129 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
19130 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
19131 character must not be used
19132 in any directory name.
19133 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
19134
19135
19136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19137
19138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
19139
19140 @subsubheading Example
19141
19142 @smallexample
19143 (gdb)
19144 -environment-path
19145 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
19146 (gdb)
19147 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
19148 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
19149 (gdb)
19150 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
19151 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
19152 (gdb)
19153 @end smallexample
19154
19155
19156 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
19157 @findex -environment-pwd
19158
19159 @subsubheading Synopsis
19160
19161 @smallexample
19162 -environment-pwd
19163 @end smallexample
19164
19165 Show the current working directory.
19166
19167 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19168
19169 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
19170
19171 @subsubheading Example
19172
19173 @smallexample
19174 (gdb)
19175 -environment-pwd
19176 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
19177 (gdb)
19178 @end smallexample
19179
19180 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19181 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
19182 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
19183
19184
19185 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
19186 @findex -thread-info
19187
19188 @subsubheading Synopsis
19189
19190 @smallexample
19191 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
19192 @end smallexample
19193
19194 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
19195 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
19196 threads. When printing information about all threads,
19197 also reports the current thread.
19198
19199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19200
19201 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
19202 about all threads.
19203
19204 @subsubheading Example
19205
19206 @smallexample
19207 -thread-info
19208 ^done,threads=[
19209 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
19210 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},
19211 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
19212 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
19213 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@}@}],
19214 current-thread-id="1"
19215 (gdb)
19216 @end smallexample
19217
19218 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
19219 @findex -thread-list-ids
19220
19221 @subsubheading Synopsis
19222
19223 @smallexample
19224 -thread-list-ids
19225 @end smallexample
19226
19227 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
19228 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
19229
19230 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19231
19232 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
19233
19234 @subsubheading Example
19235
19236 No threads present, besides the main process:
19237
19238 @smallexample
19239 (gdb)
19240 -thread-list-ids
19241 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
19242 (gdb)
19243 @end smallexample
19244
19245
19246 Several threads:
19247
19248 @smallexample
19249 (gdb)
19250 -thread-list-ids
19251 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19252 number-of-threads="3"
19253 (gdb)
19254 @end smallexample
19255
19256
19257 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
19258 @findex -thread-select
19259
19260 @subsubheading Synopsis
19261
19262 @smallexample
19263 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
19264 @end smallexample
19265
19266 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
19267 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
19268
19269 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19270
19271 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
19272
19273 @subsubheading Example
19274
19275 @smallexample
19276 (gdb)
19277 -exec-next
19278 ^running
19279 (gdb)
19280 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
19281 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
19282 (gdb)
19283 -thread-list-ids
19284 ^done,
19285 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19286 number-of-threads="3"
19287 (gdb)
19288 -thread-select 3
19289 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
19290 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
19291 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
19292 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
19293 (gdb)
19294 @end smallexample
19295
19296 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19297 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
19298 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
19299
19300 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
19301 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
19302 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
19303 other cases.
19304
19305 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
19306 @findex -exec-continue
19307
19308 @subsubheading Synopsis
19309
19310 @smallexample
19311 -exec-continue
19312 @end smallexample
19313
19314 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
19315 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
19316
19317 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19318
19319 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
19320
19321 @subsubheading Example
19322
19323 @smallexample
19324 -exec-continue
19325 ^running
19326 (gdb)
19327 @@Hello world
19328 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
19329 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
19330 line="13"@}
19331 (gdb)
19332 @end smallexample
19333
19334
19335 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
19336 @findex -exec-finish
19337
19338 @subsubheading Synopsis
19339
19340 @smallexample
19341 -exec-finish
19342 @end smallexample
19343
19344 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
19345 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
19346
19347 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19348
19349 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
19350
19351 @subsubheading Example
19352
19353 Function returning @code{void}.
19354
19355 @smallexample
19356 -exec-finish
19357 ^running
19358 (gdb)
19359 @@hello from foo
19360 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19361 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
19362 (gdb)
19363 @end smallexample
19364
19365 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
19366 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
19367 value itself.
19368
19369 @smallexample
19370 -exec-finish
19371 ^running
19372 (gdb)
19373 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
19374 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
19375 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19376 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
19377 (gdb)
19378 @end smallexample
19379
19380
19381 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
19382 @findex -exec-interrupt
19383
19384 @subsubheading Synopsis
19385
19386 @smallexample
19387 -exec-interrupt
19388 @end smallexample
19389
19390 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
19391 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
19392 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
19393 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
19394 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
19395
19396 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19397
19398 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
19399
19400 @subsubheading Example
19401
19402 @smallexample
19403 (gdb)
19404 111-exec-continue
19405 111^running
19406
19407 (gdb)
19408 222-exec-interrupt
19409 222^done
19410 (gdb)
19411 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
19412 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19413 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
19414 (gdb)
19415
19416 (gdb)
19417 -exec-interrupt
19418 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
19419 (gdb)
19420 @end smallexample
19421
19422
19423 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
19424 @findex -exec-next
19425
19426 @subsubheading Synopsis
19427
19428 @smallexample
19429 -exec-next
19430 @end smallexample
19431
19432 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19433 of the next source line is reached.
19434
19435 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19436
19437 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19438
19439 @subsubheading Example
19440
19441 @smallexample
19442 -exec-next
19443 ^running
19444 (gdb)
19445 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19446 (gdb)
19447 @end smallexample
19448
19449
19450 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19451 @findex -exec-next-instruction
19452
19453 @subsubheading Synopsis
19454
19455 @smallexample
19456 -exec-next-instruction
19457 @end smallexample
19458
19459 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19460 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19461 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19462 printed as well.
19463
19464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19465
19466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19467
19468 @subsubheading Example
19469
19470 @smallexample
19471 (gdb)
19472 -exec-next-instruction
19473 ^running
19474
19475 (gdb)
19476 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19477 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19478 (gdb)
19479 @end smallexample
19480
19481
19482 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19483 @findex -exec-return
19484
19485 @subsubheading Synopsis
19486
19487 @smallexample
19488 -exec-return
19489 @end smallexample
19490
19491 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19492 Displays the new current frame.
19493
19494 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19495
19496 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19497
19498 @subsubheading Example
19499
19500 @smallexample
19501 (gdb)
19502 200-break-insert callee4
19503 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19504 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19505 (gdb)
19506 000-exec-run
19507 000^running
19508 (gdb)
19509 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
19510 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19511 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19512 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19513 (gdb)
19514 205-break-delete
19515 205^done
19516 (gdb)
19517 111-exec-return
19518 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19519 args=[@{name="strarg",
19520 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19521 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19522 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19523 (gdb)
19524 @end smallexample
19525
19526
19527 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19528 @findex -exec-run
19529
19530 @subsubheading Synopsis
19531
19532 @smallexample
19533 -exec-run
19534 @end smallexample
19535
19536 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19537 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19538 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19539 the program has exited exceptionally.
19540
19541 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19542
19543 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19544
19545 @subsubheading Examples
19546
19547 @smallexample
19548 (gdb)
19549 -break-insert main
19550 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19551 (gdb)
19552 -exec-run
19553 ^running
19554 (gdb)
19555 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
19556 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19557 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19558 (gdb)
19559 @end smallexample
19560
19561 @noindent
19562 Program exited normally:
19563
19564 @smallexample
19565 (gdb)
19566 -exec-run
19567 ^running
19568 (gdb)
19569 x = 55
19570 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19571 (gdb)
19572 @end smallexample
19573
19574 @noindent
19575 Program exited exceptionally:
19576
19577 @smallexample
19578 (gdb)
19579 -exec-run
19580 ^running
19581 (gdb)
19582 x = 55
19583 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19584 (gdb)
19585 @end smallexample
19586
19587 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19588 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19589
19590 @smallexample
19591 (gdb)
19592 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19593 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19594 @end smallexample
19595
19596
19597 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19598
19599
19600 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19601 @findex -exec-step
19602
19603 @subsubheading Synopsis
19604
19605 @smallexample
19606 -exec-step
19607 @end smallexample
19608
19609 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19610 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19611 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19612 function.
19613
19614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19615
19616 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19617
19618 @subsubheading Example
19619
19620 Stepping into a function:
19621
19622 @smallexample
19623 -exec-step
19624 ^running
19625 (gdb)
19626 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19627 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19628 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19629 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19630 (gdb)
19631 @end smallexample
19632
19633 Regular stepping:
19634
19635 @smallexample
19636 -exec-step
19637 ^running
19638 (gdb)
19639 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19640 (gdb)
19641 @end smallexample
19642
19643
19644 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19645 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19646
19647 @subsubheading Synopsis
19648
19649 @smallexample
19650 -exec-step-instruction
19651 @end smallexample
19652
19653 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19654 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19655 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19656 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19657 well.
19658
19659 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19660
19661 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19662
19663 @subsubheading Example
19664
19665 @smallexample
19666 (gdb)
19667 -exec-step-instruction
19668 ^running
19669
19670 (gdb)
19671 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19672 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19673 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19674 (gdb)
19675 -exec-step-instruction
19676 ^running
19677
19678 (gdb)
19679 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19680 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19681 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19682 (gdb)
19683 @end smallexample
19684
19685
19686 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19687 @findex -exec-until
19688
19689 @subsubheading Synopsis
19690
19691 @smallexample
19692 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19693 @end smallexample
19694
19695 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19696 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19697 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19698 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19699
19700 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19701
19702 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19703
19704 @subsubheading Example
19705
19706 @smallexample
19707 (gdb)
19708 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19709 ^running
19710 (gdb)
19711 x = 55
19712 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19713 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19714 (gdb)
19715 @end smallexample
19716
19717 @ignore
19718 @subheading -file-clear
19719 Is this going away????
19720 @end ignore
19721
19722 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19723 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19724 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19725
19726
19727 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19728 @findex -stack-info-frame
19729
19730 @subsubheading Synopsis
19731
19732 @smallexample
19733 -stack-info-frame
19734 @end smallexample
19735
19736 Get info on the selected frame.
19737
19738 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19739
19740 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19741 (without arguments).
19742
19743 @subsubheading Example
19744
19745 @smallexample
19746 (gdb)
19747 -stack-info-frame
19748 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19749 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19750 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19751 (gdb)
19752 @end smallexample
19753
19754 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19755 @findex -stack-info-depth
19756
19757 @subsubheading Synopsis
19758
19759 @smallexample
19760 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19761 @end smallexample
19762
19763 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19764 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19765
19766 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19767
19768 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19769
19770 @subsubheading Example
19771
19772 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19773
19774 @smallexample
19775 (gdb)
19776 -stack-info-depth
19777 ^done,depth="12"
19778 (gdb)
19779 -stack-info-depth 4
19780 ^done,depth="4"
19781 (gdb)
19782 -stack-info-depth 12
19783 ^done,depth="12"
19784 (gdb)
19785 -stack-info-depth 11
19786 ^done,depth="11"
19787 (gdb)
19788 -stack-info-depth 13
19789 ^done,depth="12"
19790 (gdb)
19791 @end smallexample
19792
19793 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19794 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19795
19796 @subsubheading Synopsis
19797
19798 @smallexample
19799 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19800 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19801 @end smallexample
19802
19803 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19804 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19805 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19806 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19807 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19808 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19809 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19810 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19811
19812 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19813 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19814 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19815
19816 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19817
19818 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19819 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19820 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19821
19822 @subsubheading Example
19823
19824 @smallexample
19825 (gdb)
19826 -stack-list-frames
19827 ^done,
19828 stack=[
19829 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19830 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19831 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19832 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19833 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19834 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19835 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19836 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19837 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19838 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19839 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19840 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19841 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19842 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19843 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19844 (gdb)
19845 -stack-list-arguments 0
19846 ^done,
19847 stack-args=[
19848 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19849 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19850 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19851 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19852 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19853 (gdb)
19854 -stack-list-arguments 1
19855 ^done,
19856 stack-args=[
19857 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19858 frame=@{level="1",
19859 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19860 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19861 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19862 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19863 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19864 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19865 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19866 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19867 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19868 (gdb)
19869 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19870 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19871 (gdb)
19872 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19873 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19874 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19875 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19876 (gdb)
19877 @end smallexample
19878
19879 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19880
19881
19882 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19883 @findex -stack-list-frames
19884
19885 @subsubheading Synopsis
19886
19887 @smallexample
19888 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19889 @end smallexample
19890
19891 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19892 following info:
19893
19894 @table @samp
19895 @item @var{level}
19896 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19897 @item @var{addr}
19898 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19899 @item @var{func}
19900 Function name.
19901 @item @var{file}
19902 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19903 @item @var{line}
19904 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19905 @end table
19906
19907 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19908 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19909 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19910 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19911 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19912 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19913 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19914
19915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19916
19917 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19918
19919 @subsubheading Example
19920
19921 Full stack backtrace:
19922
19923 @smallexample
19924 (gdb)
19925 -stack-list-frames
19926 ^done,stack=
19927 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19928 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19929 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19930 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19931 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19932 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19933 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19934 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19935 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19936 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19937 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19938 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19939 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19940 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19941 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19942 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19943 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19944 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19945 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19946 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19947 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19948 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19949 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19950 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19951 (gdb)
19952 @end smallexample
19953
19954 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19955
19956 @smallexample
19957 (gdb)
19958 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19959 ^done,stack=
19960 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19961 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19962 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19963 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19964 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19965 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19966 (gdb)
19967 @end smallexample
19968
19969 Show a single frame:
19970
19971 @smallexample
19972 (gdb)
19973 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19974 ^done,stack=
19975 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19976 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19977 (gdb)
19978 @end smallexample
19979
19980
19981 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19982 @findex -stack-list-locals
19983
19984 @subsubheading Synopsis
19985
19986 @smallexample
19987 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19988 @end smallexample
19989
19990 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19991 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19992 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19993 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19994 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19995 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19996 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19997 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19998 more detail.
19999
20000 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20001
20002 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
20003
20004 @subsubheading Example
20005
20006 @smallexample
20007 (gdb)
20008 -stack-list-locals 0
20009 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
20010 (gdb)
20011 -stack-list-locals --all-values
20012 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
20013 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
20014 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
20015 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
20016 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
20017 (gdb)
20018 @end smallexample
20019
20020
20021 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
20022 @findex -stack-select-frame
20023
20024 @subsubheading Synopsis
20025
20026 @smallexample
20027 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
20028 @end smallexample
20029
20030 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
20031 the stack.
20032
20033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20034
20035 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
20036 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
20037
20038 @subsubheading Example
20039
20040 @smallexample
20041 (gdb)
20042 -stack-select-frame 2
20043 ^done
20044 (gdb)
20045 @end smallexample
20046
20047 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20048 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
20049 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
20050
20051 @ignore
20052
20053 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20054
20055 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
20056 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
20057 used by @code{Insight}.
20058
20059 The two main reasons for that are:
20060
20061 @enumerate 1
20062 @item
20063 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
20064
20065 @item
20066 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
20067 now).
20068 @end enumerate
20069
20070 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
20071 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
20072 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
20073 hints about their use.
20074
20075 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
20076 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
20077 least, the following operations:
20078
20079 @itemize @bullet
20080 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
20081 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
20082 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
20083 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
20084 @end itemize
20085
20086 @end ignore
20087
20088 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
20089
20090 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20091
20092 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
20093 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
20094 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
20095 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
20096 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
20097 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
20098 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
20099 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
20100 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
20101 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
20102 object, or to change display format.
20103
20104 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
20105 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
20106 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
20107 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
20108 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
20109 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
20110 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
20111 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
20112 child will be created.
20113
20114 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
20115 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
20116 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
20117 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
20118 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
20119
20120 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
20121 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
20122 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
20123 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
20124 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
20125 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
20126 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
20127 variables that frontend has created.
20128
20129 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
20130 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
20131 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
20132 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
20133 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
20134 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
20135 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
20136 implicitly updated.
20137
20138 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
20139 access this functionality:
20140
20141 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
20142 @item @strong{Operation}
20143 @tab @strong{Description}
20144
20145 @item @code{-var-create}
20146 @tab create a variable object
20147 @item @code{-var-delete}
20148 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
20149 @item @code{-var-set-format}
20150 @tab set the display format of this variable
20151 @item @code{-var-show-format}
20152 @tab show the display format of this variable
20153 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
20154 @tab tells how many children this object has
20155 @item @code{-var-list-children}
20156 @tab return a list of the object's children
20157 @item @code{-var-info-type}
20158 @tab show the type of this variable object
20159 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
20160 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
20161 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
20162 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
20163 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
20164 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
20165 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
20166 @tab get the value of this variable
20167 @item @code{-var-assign}
20168 @tab set the value of this variable
20169 @item @code{-var-update}
20170 @tab update the variable and its children
20171 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
20172 @tab set frozeness attribute
20173 @end multitable
20174
20175 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
20176 how it can be used.
20177
20178 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
20179
20180 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
20181 @findex -var-create
20182
20183 @subsubheading Synopsis
20184
20185 @smallexample
20186 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
20187 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
20188 @end smallexample
20189
20190 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
20191 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
20192 register.
20193
20194 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
20195 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
20196 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
20197 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
20198 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
20199
20200 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
20201 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
20202 frame should be used.
20203
20204 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
20205 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
20206
20207 @itemize @bullet
20208 @item
20209 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
20210
20211 @item
20212 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
20213
20214 @item
20215 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
20216 @end itemize
20217
20218 @subsubheading Result
20219
20220 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
20221 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
20222 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
20223
20224 @smallexample
20225 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
20226 @end smallexample
20227
20228
20229 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
20230 @findex -var-delete
20231
20232 @subsubheading Synopsis
20233
20234 @smallexample
20235 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
20236 @end smallexample
20237
20238 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
20239 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
20240
20241 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
20242
20243
20244 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
20245 @findex -var-set-format
20246
20247 @subsubheading Synopsis
20248
20249 @smallexample
20250 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
20251 @end smallexample
20252
20253 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
20254 @var{format-spec}.
20255
20256 @anchor{-var-set-format}
20257 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
20258
20259 @smallexample
20260 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
20261 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
20262 @end smallexample
20263
20264 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
20265 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
20266 for pointers, etc.).
20267
20268 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
20269 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
20270
20271 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
20272 @findex -var-show-format
20273
20274 @subsubheading Synopsis
20275
20276 @smallexample
20277 -var-show-format @var{name}
20278 @end smallexample
20279
20280 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
20281
20282 @smallexample
20283 @var{format} @expansion{}
20284 @var{format-spec}
20285 @end smallexample
20286
20287
20288 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
20289 @findex -var-info-num-children
20290
20291 @subsubheading Synopsis
20292
20293 @smallexample
20294 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
20295 @end smallexample
20296
20297 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
20298
20299 @smallexample
20300 numchild=@var{n}
20301 @end smallexample
20302
20303
20304 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
20305 @findex -var-list-children
20306
20307 @subsubheading Synopsis
20308
20309 @smallexample
20310 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
20311 @end smallexample
20312 @anchor{-var-list-children}
20313
20314 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
20315 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
20316 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
20317 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20318 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20319 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20320 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20321 and unions.
20322
20323 @subsubheading Example
20324
20325 @smallexample
20326 (gdb)
20327 -var-list-children n
20328 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20329 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20330 (gdb)
20331 -var-list-children --all-values n
20332 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20333 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20334 @end smallexample
20335
20336
20337 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20338 @findex -var-info-type
20339
20340 @subsubheading Synopsis
20341
20342 @smallexample
20343 -var-info-type @var{name}
20344 @end smallexample
20345
20346 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20347 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20348 @value{GDBN} CLI:
20349
20350 @smallexample
20351 type=@var{typename}
20352 @end smallexample
20353
20354
20355 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
20356 @findex -var-info-expression
20357
20358 @subsubheading Synopsis
20359
20360 @smallexample
20361 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20362 @end smallexample
20363
20364 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
20365 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
20366 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
20367
20368 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
20369 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
20370
20371 @smallexample
20372 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
20373 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
20374 @end smallexample
20375
20376 @noindent
20377 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
20378
20379 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
20380 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
20381 is of limited use.
20382
20383 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
20384 @findex -var-info-path-expression
20385
20386 @subsubheading Synopsis
20387
20388 @smallexample
20389 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
20390 @end smallexample
20391
20392 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
20393 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
20394 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
20395 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
20396 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
20397 watchpoint from a variable object.
20398
20399 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
20400 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
20401 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
20402 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
20403 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
20404 @smallexample
20405 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
20406 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
20407 @end smallexample
20408
20409 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
20410 @findex -var-show-attributes
20411
20412 @subsubheading Synopsis
20413
20414 @smallexample
20415 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
20416 @end smallexample
20417
20418 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
20419
20420 @smallexample
20421 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
20422 @end smallexample
20423
20424 @noindent
20425 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
20426
20427 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
20428 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
20429
20430 @subsubheading Synopsis
20431
20432 @smallexample
20433 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
20434 @end smallexample
20435
20436 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20437 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
20438 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
20439 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
20440 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
20441 the current display format will be used. The current display format
20442 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
20443
20444 @smallexample
20445 value=@var{value}
20446 @end smallexample
20447
20448 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20449 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20450
20451 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20452 @findex -var-assign
20453
20454 @subsubheading Synopsis
20455
20456 @smallexample
20457 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20458 @end smallexample
20459
20460 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20461 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20462 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20463 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20464
20465 @subsubheading Example
20466
20467 @smallexample
20468 (gdb)
20469 -var-assign var1 3
20470 ^done,value="3"
20471 (gdb)
20472 -var-update *
20473 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20474 (gdb)
20475 @end smallexample
20476
20477 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20478 @findex -var-update
20479
20480 @subsubheading Synopsis
20481
20482 @smallexample
20483 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20484 @end smallexample
20485
20486 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20487 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20488 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
20489 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
20490 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
20491 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
20492 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
20493 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
20494 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
20495 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
20496 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
20497 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
20498 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
20499
20500
20501 @subsubheading Example
20502
20503 @smallexample
20504 (gdb)
20505 -var-assign var1 3
20506 ^done,value="3"
20507 (gdb)
20508 -var-update --all-values var1
20509 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20510 type_changed="false"@}]
20511 (gdb)
20512 @end smallexample
20513
20514 @anchor{-var-update}
20515 The field in_scope may take three values:
20516
20517 @table @code
20518 @item "true"
20519 The variable object's current value is valid.
20520
20521 @item "false"
20522 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
20523 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
20524 scope.
20525
20526 @item "invalid"
20527 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
20528 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
20529 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
20530 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
20531 objects.
20532 @end table
20533
20534 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
20535 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
20536
20537 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
20538 @findex -var-set-frozen
20539 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
20540
20541 @subsubheading Synopsis
20542
20543 @smallexample
20544 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
20545 @end smallexample
20546
20547 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
20548 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
20549 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
20550 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
20551 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
20552 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
20553 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
20554 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
20555 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
20556 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
20557 @code{-var-update} does.
20558
20559 @subsubheading Example
20560
20561 @smallexample
20562 (gdb)
20563 -var-set-frozen V 1
20564 ^done
20565 (gdb)
20566 @end smallexample
20567
20568
20569 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20570 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20571 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20572
20573 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20574 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20575 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20576 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20577
20578 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20579 @c @subheading -data-assign
20580 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20581 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
20582 @c set variable
20583 @c @subsubheading Example
20584 @c N.A.
20585
20586 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20587 @findex -data-disassemble
20588
20589 @subsubheading Synopsis
20590
20591 @smallexample
20592 -data-disassemble
20593 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20594 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20595 -- @var{mode}
20596 @end smallexample
20597
20598 @noindent
20599 Where:
20600
20601 @table @samp
20602 @item @var{start-addr}
20603 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20604 @item @var{end-addr}
20605 is the end address
20606 @item @var{filename}
20607 is the name of the file to disassemble
20608 @item @var{linenum}
20609 is the line number to disassemble around
20610 @item @var{lines}
20611 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20612 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20613 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20614 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20615 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20616 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20617 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20618 are displayed.
20619 @item @var{mode}
20620 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20621 disassembly).
20622 @end table
20623
20624 @subsubheading Result
20625
20626 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20627
20628 @itemize @bullet
20629 @item Address
20630 @item Func-name
20631 @item Offset
20632 @item Instruction
20633 @end itemize
20634
20635 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20636 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20637
20638 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20639
20640 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20641
20642 @subsubheading Example
20643
20644 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20645
20646 @smallexample
20647 (gdb)
20648 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20649 ^done,
20650 asm_insns=[
20651 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20652 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20653 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20654 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20655 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20656 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20657 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20658 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20659 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20660 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20661 (gdb)
20662 @end smallexample
20663
20664 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20665 @code{main}.
20666
20667 @smallexample
20668 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20669 ^done,asm_insns=[
20670 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20671 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20672 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20673 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20674 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20675 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20676 [@dots{}]
20677 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20678 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20679 (gdb)
20680 @end smallexample
20681
20682 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20683
20684 @smallexample
20685 (gdb)
20686 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20687 ^done,asm_insns=[
20688 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20689 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20690 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20691 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20692 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20693 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20694 (gdb)
20695 @end smallexample
20696
20697 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20698
20699 @smallexample
20700 (gdb)
20701 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20702 ^done,asm_insns=[
20703 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20704 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20705 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20706 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20707 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20708 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20709 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20710 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20711 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20712 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20713 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20714 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20715 (gdb)
20716 @end smallexample
20717
20718
20719 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20720 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20721
20722 @subsubheading Synopsis
20723
20724 @smallexample
20725 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20726 @end smallexample
20727
20728 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20729 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20730 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20731
20732 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20733
20734 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20735 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20736 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20737
20738 @subsubheading Example
20739
20740 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20741 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20742 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20743 output.
20744
20745 @smallexample
20746 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20747 211^done,value="1"
20748 (gdb)
20749 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20750 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20751 (gdb)
20752 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20753 411^done,value="4"
20754 (gdb)
20755 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20756 511^done,value="4"
20757 (gdb)
20758 @end smallexample
20759
20760
20761 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20762 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20763
20764 @subsubheading Synopsis
20765
20766 @smallexample
20767 -data-list-changed-registers
20768 @end smallexample
20769
20770 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20771
20772 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20773
20774 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20775 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20776
20777 @subsubheading Example
20778
20779 On a PPC MBX board:
20780
20781 @smallexample
20782 (gdb)
20783 -exec-continue
20784 ^running
20785
20786 (gdb)
20787 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
20788 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
20789 line="5"@}
20790 (gdb)
20791 -data-list-changed-registers
20792 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20793 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20794 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20795 (gdb)
20796 @end smallexample
20797
20798
20799 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20800 @findex -data-list-register-names
20801
20802 @subsubheading Synopsis
20803
20804 @smallexample
20805 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20806 @end smallexample
20807
20808 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20809 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20810 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20811 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20812 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20813 include empty register names.
20814
20815 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20816
20817 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20818 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20819 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20820
20821 @subsubheading Example
20822
20823 For the PPC MBX board:
20824 @smallexample
20825 (gdb)
20826 -data-list-register-names
20827 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20828 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20829 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20830 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20831 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20832 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20833 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20834 (gdb)
20835 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20836 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20837 (gdb)
20838 @end smallexample
20839
20840 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20841 @findex -data-list-register-values
20842
20843 @subsubheading Synopsis
20844
20845 @smallexample
20846 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20847 @end smallexample
20848
20849 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20850 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20851 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20852 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20853
20854 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20855
20856 @table @code
20857 @item x
20858 Hexadecimal
20859 @item o
20860 Octal
20861 @item t
20862 Binary
20863 @item d
20864 Decimal
20865 @item r
20866 Raw
20867 @item N
20868 Natural
20869 @end table
20870
20871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20872
20873 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20874 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20875
20876 @subsubheading Example
20877
20878 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20879 don't appear in the actual output):
20880
20881 @smallexample
20882 (gdb)
20883 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20884 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20885 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20886 (gdb)
20887 -data-list-register-values x
20888 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20889 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20890 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20891 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20892 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20893 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20894 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20895 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20896 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20897 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20898 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20899 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20900 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20901 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20902 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20903 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20904 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20905 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20906 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20907 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20908 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20909 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20910 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20911 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20912 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20913 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20914 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20915 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20916 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20917 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20918 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20919 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20920 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20921 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20922 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20923 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20924 (gdb)
20925 @end smallexample
20926
20927
20928 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20929 @findex -data-read-memory
20930
20931 @subsubheading Synopsis
20932
20933 @smallexample
20934 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20935 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20936 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20937 @end smallexample
20938
20939 @noindent
20940 where:
20941
20942 @table @samp
20943 @item @var{address}
20944 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20945 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20946 quoted using the C convention.
20947
20948 @item @var{word-format}
20949 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20950 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20951 ,Output Formats}).
20952
20953 @item @var{word-size}
20954 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20955
20956 @item @var{nr-rows}
20957 The number of rows in the output table.
20958
20959 @item @var{nr-cols}
20960 The number of columns in the output table.
20961
20962 @item @var{aschar}
20963 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20964 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20965 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20966 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20967
20968 @item @var{byte-offset}
20969 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20970 @end table
20971
20972 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20973 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20974 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20975 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20976 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20977 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20978 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20979 @samp{addr}.
20980
20981 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20982 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20983 @samp{prev-page}.
20984
20985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20986
20987 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20988 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20989
20990 @subsubheading Example
20991
20992 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20993 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20994 word. Display each word in hex.
20995
20996 @smallexample
20997 (gdb)
20998 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20999 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
21000 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
21001 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
21002 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
21003 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
21004 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
21005 (gdb)
21006 @end smallexample
21007
21008 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
21009 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
21010
21011 @smallexample
21012 (gdb)
21013 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
21014 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
21015 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
21016 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
21017 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
21018 (gdb)
21019 @end smallexample
21020
21021 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
21022 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
21023 used as the non-printable character.
21024
21025 @smallexample
21026 (gdb)
21027 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
21028 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
21029 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
21030 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
21031 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21032 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21033 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21034 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21035 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
21036 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
21037 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
21038 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
21039 (gdb)
21040 @end smallexample
21041
21042 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21043 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
21044 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
21045
21046 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
21047
21048 @c @subheading -trace-actions
21049
21050 @c @subheading -trace-delete
21051
21052 @c @subheading -trace-disable
21053
21054 @c @subheading -trace-dump
21055
21056 @c @subheading -trace-enable
21057
21058 @c @subheading -trace-exists
21059
21060 @c @subheading -trace-find
21061
21062 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
21063
21064 @c @subheading -trace-info
21065
21066 @c @subheading -trace-insert
21067
21068 @c @subheading -trace-list
21069
21070 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
21071
21072 @c @subheading -trace-save
21073
21074 @c @subheading -trace-start
21075
21076 @c @subheading -trace-stop
21077
21078
21079 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21080 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
21081 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
21082
21083
21084 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
21085 @findex -symbol-info-address
21086
21087 @subsubheading Synopsis
21088
21089 @smallexample
21090 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
21091 @end smallexample
21092
21093 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
21094
21095 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21096
21097 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
21098
21099 @subsubheading Example
21100 N.A.
21101
21102
21103 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
21104 @findex -symbol-info-file
21105
21106 @subsubheading Synopsis
21107
21108 @smallexample
21109 -symbol-info-file
21110 @end smallexample
21111
21112 Show the file for the symbol.
21113
21114 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21115
21116 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
21117 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
21118
21119 @subsubheading Example
21120 N.A.
21121
21122
21123 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
21124 @findex -symbol-info-function
21125
21126 @subsubheading Synopsis
21127
21128 @smallexample
21129 -symbol-info-function
21130 @end smallexample
21131
21132 Show which function the symbol lives in.
21133
21134 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21135
21136 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
21137
21138 @subsubheading Example
21139 N.A.
21140
21141
21142 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
21143 @findex -symbol-info-line
21144
21145 @subsubheading Synopsis
21146
21147 @smallexample
21148 -symbol-info-line
21149 @end smallexample
21150
21151 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
21152
21153 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21154
21155 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
21156 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
21157
21158 @subsubheading Example
21159 N.A.
21160
21161
21162 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
21163 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
21164
21165 @subsubheading Synopsis
21166
21167 @smallexample
21168 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
21169 @end smallexample
21170
21171 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
21172
21173 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21174
21175 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
21176
21177 @subsubheading Example
21178 N.A.
21179
21180
21181 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
21182 @findex -symbol-list-functions
21183
21184 @subsubheading Synopsis
21185
21186 @smallexample
21187 -symbol-list-functions
21188 @end smallexample
21189
21190 List the functions in the executable.
21191
21192 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21193
21194 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
21195 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21196
21197 @subsubheading Example
21198 N.A.
21199
21200
21201 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
21202 @findex -symbol-list-lines
21203
21204 @subsubheading Synopsis
21205
21206 @smallexample
21207 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
21208 @end smallexample
21209
21210 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
21211 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
21212 ascending PC order.
21213
21214 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21215
21216 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
21217
21218 @subsubheading Example
21219 @smallexample
21220 (gdb)
21221 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
21222 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
21223 (gdb)
21224 @end smallexample
21225
21226
21227 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
21228 @findex -symbol-list-types
21229
21230 @subsubheading Synopsis
21231
21232 @smallexample
21233 -symbol-list-types
21234 @end smallexample
21235
21236 List all the type names.
21237
21238 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21239
21240 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
21241 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21242
21243 @subsubheading Example
21244 N.A.
21245
21246
21247 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
21248 @findex -symbol-list-variables
21249
21250 @subsubheading Synopsis
21251
21252 @smallexample
21253 -symbol-list-variables
21254 @end smallexample
21255
21256 List all the global and static variable names.
21257
21258 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21259
21260 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21261
21262 @subsubheading Example
21263 N.A.
21264
21265
21266 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
21267 @findex -symbol-locate
21268
21269 @subsubheading Synopsis
21270
21271 @smallexample
21272 -symbol-locate
21273 @end smallexample
21274
21275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21276
21277 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
21278
21279 @subsubheading Example
21280 N.A.
21281
21282
21283 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
21284 @findex -symbol-type
21285
21286 @subsubheading Synopsis
21287
21288 @smallexample
21289 -symbol-type @var{variable}
21290 @end smallexample
21291
21292 Show type of @var{variable}.
21293
21294 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21295
21296 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
21297 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
21298
21299 @subsubheading Example
21300 N.A.
21301
21302
21303 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21304 @node GDB/MI File Commands
21305 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
21306
21307 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
21308 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
21309
21310 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
21311 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
21312
21313 @subsubheading Synopsis
21314
21315 @smallexample
21316 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
21317 @end smallexample
21318
21319 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
21320 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
21321 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
21322 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
21323 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
21324 notification.
21325
21326 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21327
21328 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
21329
21330 @subsubheading Example
21331
21332 @smallexample
21333 (gdb)
21334 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21335 ^done
21336 (gdb)
21337 @end smallexample
21338
21339
21340 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
21341 @findex -file-exec-file
21342
21343 @subsubheading Synopsis
21344
21345 @smallexample
21346 -file-exec-file @var{file}
21347 @end smallexample
21348
21349 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
21350 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
21351 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
21352 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
21353 notification.
21354
21355 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21356
21357 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
21358
21359 @subsubheading Example
21360
21361 @smallexample
21362 (gdb)
21363 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21364 ^done
21365 (gdb)
21366 @end smallexample
21367
21368
21369 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
21370 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
21371
21372 @subsubheading Synopsis
21373
21374 @smallexample
21375 -file-list-exec-sections
21376 @end smallexample
21377
21378 List the sections of the current executable file.
21379
21380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21381
21382 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
21383 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
21384 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
21385
21386 @subsubheading Example
21387 N.A.
21388
21389
21390 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
21391 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
21392
21393 @subsubheading Synopsis
21394
21395 @smallexample
21396 -file-list-exec-source-file
21397 @end smallexample
21398
21399 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
21400 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
21401 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
21402 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
21403
21404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21405
21406 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
21407
21408 @subsubheading Example
21409
21410 @smallexample
21411 (gdb)
21412 123-file-list-exec-source-file
21413 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
21414 (gdb)
21415 @end smallexample
21416
21417
21418 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
21419 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
21420
21421 @subsubheading Synopsis
21422
21423 @smallexample
21424 -file-list-exec-source-files
21425 @end smallexample
21426
21427 List the source files for the current executable.
21428
21429 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
21430 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
21431
21432 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21433
21434 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
21435 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
21436
21437 @subsubheading Example
21438 @smallexample
21439 (gdb)
21440 -file-list-exec-source-files
21441 ^done,files=[
21442 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
21443 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
21444 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
21445 (gdb)
21446 @end smallexample
21447
21448 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
21449 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
21450
21451 @subsubheading Synopsis
21452
21453 @smallexample
21454 -file-list-shared-libraries
21455 @end smallexample
21456
21457 List the shared libraries in the program.
21458
21459 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21460
21461 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
21462
21463 @subsubheading Example
21464 N.A.
21465
21466
21467 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
21468 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
21469
21470 @subsubheading Synopsis
21471
21472 @smallexample
21473 -file-list-symbol-files
21474 @end smallexample
21475
21476 List symbol files.
21477
21478 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21479
21480 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
21481
21482 @subsubheading Example
21483 N.A.
21484
21485
21486 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21487 @findex -file-symbol-file
21488
21489 @subsubheading Synopsis
21490
21491 @smallexample
21492 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
21493 @end smallexample
21494
21495 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
21496 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
21497 produced, except for a completion notification.
21498
21499 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21500
21501 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
21502
21503 @subsubheading Example
21504
21505 @smallexample
21506 (gdb)
21507 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21508 ^done
21509 (gdb)
21510 @end smallexample
21511
21512 @ignore
21513 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21514 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
21515 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
21516
21517 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
21518
21519 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
21520
21521 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
21522
21523 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
21524
21525 @c @subheading -overlay-map
21526
21527 @c @subheading -overlay-off
21528
21529 @c @subheading -overlay-on
21530
21531 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
21532
21533 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21534 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
21535 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
21536
21537 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
21538
21539 @c @subheading -signal-handle
21540
21541 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
21542
21543 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
21544 @end ignore
21545
21546
21547 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21548 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
21549 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
21550
21551
21552 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
21553 @findex -target-attach
21554
21555 @subsubheading Synopsis
21556
21557 @smallexample
21558 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
21559 @end smallexample
21560
21561 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
21562
21563 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21564
21565 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
21566
21567 @subsubheading Example
21568 N.A.
21569
21570
21571 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21572 @findex -target-compare-sections
21573
21574 @subsubheading Synopsis
21575
21576 @smallexample
21577 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21578 @end smallexample
21579
21580 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21581 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21582
21583 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21584
21585 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21586
21587 @subsubheading Example
21588 N.A.
21589
21590
21591 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21592 @findex -target-detach
21593
21594 @subsubheading Synopsis
21595
21596 @smallexample
21597 -target-detach
21598 @end smallexample
21599
21600 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21601 There's no output.
21602
21603 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21604
21605 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21606
21607 @subsubheading Example
21608
21609 @smallexample
21610 (gdb)
21611 -target-detach
21612 ^done
21613 (gdb)
21614 @end smallexample
21615
21616
21617 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21618 @findex -target-disconnect
21619
21620 @subsubheading Synopsis
21621
21622 @smallexample
21623 -target-disconnect
21624 @end smallexample
21625
21626 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21627 generally not resumed.
21628
21629 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21630
21631 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21632
21633 @subsubheading Example
21634
21635 @smallexample
21636 (gdb)
21637 -target-disconnect
21638 ^done
21639 (gdb)
21640 @end smallexample
21641
21642
21643 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21644 @findex -target-download
21645
21646 @subsubheading Synopsis
21647
21648 @smallexample
21649 -target-download
21650 @end smallexample
21651
21652 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21653 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21654
21655 @table @samp
21656 @item section
21657 The name of the section.
21658 @item section-sent
21659 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21660 @item section-size
21661 The size of the section.
21662 @item total-sent
21663 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21664 @item total-size
21665 The size of the overall executable to download.
21666 @end table
21667
21668 @noindent
21669 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21670 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21671
21672 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21673 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21674
21675 @table @samp
21676 @item section
21677 The name of the section.
21678 @item section-size
21679 The size of the section.
21680 @item total-size
21681 The size of the overall executable to download.
21682 @end table
21683
21684 @noindent
21685 At the end, a summary is printed.
21686
21687 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21688
21689 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21690
21691 @subsubheading Example
21692
21693 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21694 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21695
21696 @smallexample
21697 (gdb)
21698 -target-download
21699 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21700 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21701 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21702 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21703 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21704 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21705 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21706 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21707 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21708 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21709 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21710 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21711 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21712 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21713 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21714 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21715 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21716 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21717 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21718 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21719 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21720 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21721 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21722 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21723 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21724 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21725 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21726 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21727 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21728 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21729 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21730 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21731 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21732 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21733 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21734 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21735 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21736 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21737 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21738 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21739 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21740 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21741 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21742 write-rate="429"
21743 (gdb)
21744 @end smallexample
21745
21746
21747 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21748 @findex -target-exec-status
21749
21750 @subsubheading Synopsis
21751
21752 @smallexample
21753 -target-exec-status
21754 @end smallexample
21755
21756 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21757 not, for instance).
21758
21759 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21760
21761 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21762
21763 @subsubheading Example
21764 N.A.
21765
21766
21767 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21768 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21769
21770 @subsubheading Synopsis
21771
21772 @smallexample
21773 -target-list-available-targets
21774 @end smallexample
21775
21776 List the possible targets to connect to.
21777
21778 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21779
21780 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21781
21782 @subsubheading Example
21783 N.A.
21784
21785
21786 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21787 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21788
21789 @subsubheading Synopsis
21790
21791 @smallexample
21792 -target-list-current-targets
21793 @end smallexample
21794
21795 Describe the current target.
21796
21797 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21798
21799 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21800 other things).
21801
21802 @subsubheading Example
21803 N.A.
21804
21805
21806 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21807 @findex -target-list-parameters
21808
21809 @subsubheading Synopsis
21810
21811 @smallexample
21812 -target-list-parameters
21813 @end smallexample
21814
21815 @c ????
21816
21817 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21818
21819 No equivalent.
21820
21821 @subsubheading Example
21822 N.A.
21823
21824
21825 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21826 @findex -target-select
21827
21828 @subsubheading Synopsis
21829
21830 @smallexample
21831 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21832 @end smallexample
21833
21834 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21835
21836 @table @samp
21837 @item @var{type}
21838 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21839 @item @var{parameters}
21840 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21841 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21842 @end table
21843
21844 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21845 which the target program is, in the following form:
21846
21847 @smallexample
21848 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21849 args=[@var{arg list}]
21850 @end smallexample
21851
21852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21853
21854 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21855
21856 @subsubheading Example
21857
21858 @smallexample
21859 (gdb)
21860 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21861 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21862 (gdb)
21863 @end smallexample
21864
21865 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21866 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
21867 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
21868
21869
21870 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21871 @findex -target-file-put
21872
21873 @subsubheading Synopsis
21874
21875 @smallexample
21876 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21877 @end smallexample
21878
21879 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21880 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21881
21882 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21883
21884 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
21885
21886 @subsubheading Example
21887
21888 @smallexample
21889 (gdb)
21890 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
21891 ^done
21892 (gdb)
21893 @end smallexample
21894
21895
21896 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21897 @findex -target-file-get
21898
21899 @subsubheading Synopsis
21900
21901 @smallexample
21902 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21903 @end smallexample
21904
21905 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21906 on the host system.
21907
21908 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21909
21910 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
21911
21912 @subsubheading Example
21913
21914 @smallexample
21915 (gdb)
21916 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
21917 ^done
21918 (gdb)
21919 @end smallexample
21920
21921
21922 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
21923 @findex -target-file-delete
21924
21925 @subsubheading Synopsis
21926
21927 @smallexample
21928 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
21929 @end smallexample
21930
21931 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21932
21933 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21934
21935 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
21936
21937 @subsubheading Example
21938
21939 @smallexample
21940 (gdb)
21941 -target-file-delete remotefile
21942 ^done
21943 (gdb)
21944 @end smallexample
21945
21946
21947 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21948 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21949 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21950
21951 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21952
21953 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21954 @findex -gdb-exit
21955
21956 @subsubheading Synopsis
21957
21958 @smallexample
21959 -gdb-exit
21960 @end smallexample
21961
21962 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21963
21964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21965
21966 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21967
21968 @subsubheading Example
21969
21970 @smallexample
21971 (gdb)
21972 -gdb-exit
21973 ^exit
21974 @end smallexample
21975
21976
21977 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21978 @findex -exec-abort
21979
21980 @subsubheading Synopsis
21981
21982 @smallexample
21983 -exec-abort
21984 @end smallexample
21985
21986 Kill the inferior running program.
21987
21988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21989
21990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21991
21992 @subsubheading Example
21993 N.A.
21994
21995
21996 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21997 @findex -gdb-set
21998
21999 @subsubheading Synopsis
22000
22001 @smallexample
22002 -gdb-set
22003 @end smallexample
22004
22005 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
22006 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
22007
22008 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22009
22010 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
22011
22012 @subsubheading Example
22013
22014 @smallexample
22015 (gdb)
22016 -gdb-set $foo=3
22017 ^done
22018 (gdb)
22019 @end smallexample
22020
22021
22022 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
22023 @findex -gdb-show
22024
22025 @subsubheading Synopsis
22026
22027 @smallexample
22028 -gdb-show
22029 @end smallexample
22030
22031 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
22032
22033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22034
22035 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
22036
22037 @subsubheading Example
22038
22039 @smallexample
22040 (gdb)
22041 -gdb-show annotate
22042 ^done,value="0"
22043 (gdb)
22044 @end smallexample
22045
22046 @c @subheading -gdb-source
22047
22048
22049 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
22050 @findex -gdb-version
22051
22052 @subsubheading Synopsis
22053
22054 @smallexample
22055 -gdb-version
22056 @end smallexample
22057
22058 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
22059
22060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22061
22062 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
22063 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
22064
22065 @subsubheading Example
22066
22067 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
22068 @c box in TeX.
22069 @smallexample
22070 (gdb)
22071 -gdb-version
22072 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
22073 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22074 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
22075 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
22076 ~ certain conditions.
22077 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22078 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
22079 ~ details.
22080 ~This GDB was configured as
22081 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
22082 ^done
22083 (gdb)
22084 @end smallexample
22085
22086 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
22087 @findex -list-features
22088
22089 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
22090 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
22091 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
22092 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
22093 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
22094 startup.
22095
22096 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
22097 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
22098 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
22099 is given below.
22100
22101 Example output:
22102
22103 @smallexample
22104 (gdb) -list-features
22105 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
22106 @end smallexample
22107
22108 The current list of features is:
22109
22110 @itemize @minus
22111 @item
22112 @samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
22113 @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
22114 @code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
22115 @item
22116 @samp{pending-breakpoints}---indicates presence of the @code{-f}
22117 option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
22118 @item
22119 @samp{thread-info}---indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
22120
22121 @end itemize
22122
22123 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
22124 @findex -interpreter-exec
22125
22126 @subheading Synopsis
22127
22128 @smallexample
22129 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
22130 @end smallexample
22131 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
22132
22133 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
22134
22135 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22136
22137 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
22138
22139 @subheading Example
22140
22141 @smallexample
22142 (gdb)
22143 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
22144 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
22145 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
22146 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
22147 ^done
22148 (gdb)
22149 @end smallexample
22150
22151 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
22152 @findex -inferior-tty-set
22153
22154 @subheading Synopsis
22155
22156 @smallexample
22157 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22158 @end smallexample
22159
22160 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
22161
22162 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22163
22164 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
22165
22166 @subheading Example
22167
22168 @smallexample
22169 (gdb)
22170 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22171 ^done
22172 (gdb)
22173 @end smallexample
22174
22175 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
22176 @findex -inferior-tty-show
22177
22178 @subheading Synopsis
22179
22180 @smallexample
22181 -inferior-tty-show
22182 @end smallexample
22183
22184 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
22185
22186 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22187
22188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
22189
22190 @subheading Example
22191
22192 @smallexample
22193 (gdb)
22194 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22195 ^done
22196 (gdb)
22197 -inferior-tty-show
22198 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
22199 (gdb)
22200 @end smallexample
22201
22202 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
22203 @findex -enable-timings
22204
22205 @subheading Synopsis
22206
22207 @smallexample
22208 -enable-timings [yes | no]
22209 @end smallexample
22210
22211 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
22212 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
22213 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
22214 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
22215
22216 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22217
22218 No equivalent.
22219
22220 @subheading Example
22221
22222 @smallexample
22223 (gdb)
22224 -enable-timings
22225 ^done
22226 (gdb)
22227 -break-insert main
22228 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22229 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
22230 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
22231 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
22232 (gdb)
22233 -enable-timings no
22234 ^done
22235 (gdb)
22236 -exec-run
22237 ^running
22238 (gdb)
22239 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
22240 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
22241 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
22242 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
22243 (gdb)
22244 @end smallexample
22245
22246 @node Annotations
22247 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
22248
22249 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
22250 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
22251 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
22252 relatively high level.
22253
22254 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
22255 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
22256
22257 @ignore
22258 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
22259 @end ignore
22260
22261 @menu
22262 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
22263 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
22264 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
22265 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
22266 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
22267 * Annotations for Running::
22268 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
22269 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
22270 @end menu
22271
22272 @node Annotations Overview
22273 @section What is an Annotation?
22274 @cindex annotations
22275
22276 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
22277 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
22278 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
22279 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
22280 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
22281 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
22282 cannot contain newline characters.
22283
22284 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
22285 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
22286 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
22287 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
22288 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
22289 means those three characters as output.
22290
22291 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
22292 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
22293 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
22294 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
22295 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
22296 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
22297 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
22298 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
22299 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
22300
22301 @table @code
22302 @kindex set annotate
22303 @item set annotate @var{level}
22304 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
22305 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
22306
22307 @item show annotate
22308 @kindex show annotate
22309 Show the current annotation level.
22310 @end table
22311
22312 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
22313
22314 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
22315
22316 @smallexample
22317 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
22318 GNU gdb 6.0
22319 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22320 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
22321 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
22322 under certain conditions.
22323 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22324 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
22325 for details.
22326 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
22327
22328 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22329 (@value{GDBP})
22330 ^Z^Zprompt
22331 @kbd{quit}
22332
22333 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22334 $
22335 @end smallexample
22336
22337 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
22338 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
22339 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
22340 output from @value{GDBN}.
22341
22342 @node Server Prefix
22343 @section The Server Prefix
22344 @cindex server prefix
22345
22346 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
22347 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
22348 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
22349 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
22350 a transparent manner.
22351
22352 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22353 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22354 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22355
22356 @node Prompting
22357 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
22358
22359 @cindex annotations for prompts
22360 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
22361 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
22362 over, etc.
22363
22364 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
22365 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
22366 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
22367 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
22368 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
22369 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
22370 features the following annotations:
22371
22372 @smallexample
22373 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22374 ^Z^Zprompt
22375 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22376 @end smallexample
22377
22378 The input types are
22379
22380 @table @code
22381 @findex pre-prompt annotation
22382 @findex prompt annotation
22383 @findex post-prompt annotation
22384 @item prompt
22385 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
22386
22387 @findex pre-commands annotation
22388 @findex commands annotation
22389 @findex post-commands annotation
22390 @item commands
22391 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
22392 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
22393
22394 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
22395 @findex overload-choice annotation
22396 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
22397 @item overload-choice
22398 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
22399
22400 @findex pre-query annotation
22401 @findex query annotation
22402 @findex post-query annotation
22403 @item query
22404 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
22405
22406 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
22407 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
22408 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
22409 @item prompt-for-continue
22410 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
22411 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
22412 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
22413 presence of annotations.
22414 @end table
22415
22416 @node Errors
22417 @section Errors
22418 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
22419
22420 @findex quit annotation
22421 @smallexample
22422 ^Z^Zquit
22423 @end smallexample
22424
22425 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
22426
22427 @findex error annotation
22428 @smallexample
22429 ^Z^Zerror
22430 @end smallexample
22431
22432 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
22433
22434 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
22435 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
22436 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
22437 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
22438 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
22439 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
22440 to the top level.
22441
22442 @findex error-begin annotation
22443 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
22444
22445 @smallexample
22446 ^Z^Zerror-begin
22447 @end smallexample
22448
22449 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
22450 message.
22451
22452 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
22453 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
22454 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
22455
22456 @node Invalidation
22457 @section Invalidation Notices
22458
22459 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
22460 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
22461 changed.
22462
22463 @table @code
22464 @findex frames-invalid annotation
22465 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
22466
22467 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
22468 have changed.
22469
22470 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
22471 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
22472
22473 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
22474 deleted a breakpoint.
22475 @end table
22476
22477 @node Annotations for Running
22478 @section Running the Program
22479 @cindex annotations for running programs
22480
22481 @findex starting annotation
22482 @findex stopping annotation
22483 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
22484 @code{step} or @code{continue},
22485
22486 @smallexample
22487 ^Z^Zstarting
22488 @end smallexample
22489
22490 is output. When the program stops,
22491
22492 @smallexample
22493 ^Z^Zstopped
22494 @end smallexample
22495
22496 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
22497 annotations describe how the program stopped.
22498
22499 @table @code
22500 @findex exited annotation
22501 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
22502 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
22503 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
22504
22505 @findex signalled annotation
22506 @findex signal-name annotation
22507 @findex signal-name-end annotation
22508 @findex signal-string annotation
22509 @findex signal-string-end annotation
22510 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
22511 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
22512 annotation continues:
22513
22514 @smallexample
22515 @var{intro-text}
22516 ^Z^Zsignal-name
22517 @var{name}
22518 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
22519 @var{middle-text}
22520 ^Z^Zsignal-string
22521 @var{string}
22522 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
22523 @var{end-text}
22524 @end smallexample
22525
22526 @noindent
22527 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
22528 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
22529 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
22530 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
22531 user's benefit and have no particular format.
22532
22533 @findex signal annotation
22534 @item ^Z^Zsignal
22535 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
22536 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
22537 terminated with it.
22538
22539 @findex breakpoint annotation
22540 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
22541 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
22542
22543 @findex watchpoint annotation
22544 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
22545 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
22546 @end table
22547
22548 @node Source Annotations
22549 @section Displaying Source
22550 @cindex annotations for source display
22551
22552 @findex source annotation
22553 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
22554
22555 @smallexample
22556 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
22557 @end smallexample
22558
22559 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
22560 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
22561 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
22562 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
22563 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
22564 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
22565 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
22566 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
22567 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
22568 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
22569 depend on the language).
22570
22571 @node GDB Bugs
22572 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
22573 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
22574 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
22575
22576 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
22577
22578 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
22579 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
22580 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
22581 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
22582
22583 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
22584 information that enables us to fix the bug.
22585
22586 @menu
22587 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
22588 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
22589 @end menu
22590
22591 @node Bug Criteria
22592 @section Have You Found a Bug?
22593 @cindex bug criteria
22594
22595 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
22596
22597 @itemize @bullet
22598 @cindex fatal signal
22599 @cindex debugger crash
22600 @cindex crash of debugger
22601 @item
22602 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
22603 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
22604
22605 @cindex error on valid input
22606 @item
22607 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
22608 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
22609 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
22610
22611 @cindex invalid input
22612 @item
22613 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
22614 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
22615 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
22616 for traditional practice''.
22617
22618 @item
22619 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
22620 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
22621 @end itemize
22622
22623 @node Bug Reporting
22624 @section How to Report Bugs
22625 @cindex bug reports
22626 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
22627
22628 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
22629 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
22630 contact that organization first.
22631
22632 You can find contact information for many support companies and
22633 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
22634 distribution.
22635 @c should add a web page ref...
22636
22637 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
22638 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
22639 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
22640 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
22641 be used.
22642
22643 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
22644 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
22645 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
22646 @samp{bug-gdb}.
22647
22648 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
22649 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
22650 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
22651 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
22652 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
22653 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
22654 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
22655 bug reports to the mailing list.
22656
22657 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
22658 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
22659 fact or leave it out, state it!
22660
22661 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
22662 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
22663 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
22664 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
22665 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22666 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22667 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22668 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22669 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22670
22671 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22672 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22673 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22674 self-contained.
22675
22676 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22677 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22678 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22679 bugs properly.
22680
22681 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22682
22683 @itemize @bullet
22684 @item
22685 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22686 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22687 version}.
22688
22689 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22690 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22691
22692 @item
22693 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22694 version number.
22695
22696 @item
22697 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22698 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22699
22700 @item
22701 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22702 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22703 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
22704 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
22705 those compilers.
22706
22707 @item
22708 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22709 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22710 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22711 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22712
22713 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22714 and then we might not encounter the bug.
22715
22716 @item
22717 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22718 reproduce the bug.
22719
22720 @item
22721 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22722 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22723
22724 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22725 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22726 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22727 a chance to make a mistake.
22728
22729 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22730 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22731 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22732 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22733 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22734 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22735 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22736 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22737
22738 @pindex script
22739 @cindex recording a session script
22740 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22741 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22742 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22743 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22744
22745 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22746 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22747
22748 @item
22749 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22750 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22751 it by context, not by line number.
22752
22753 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22754 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22755
22756 @end itemize
22757
22758 Here are some things that are not necessary:
22759
22760 @itemize @bullet
22761 @item
22762 A description of the envelope of the bug.
22763
22764 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22765 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22766 changes will not affect it.
22767
22768 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22769 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22770 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22771 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22772
22773 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22774 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22775 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22776 less time, and so on.
22777
22778 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22779 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22780
22781 @item
22782 A patch for the bug.
22783
22784 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22785 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22786 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22787 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22788
22789 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22790 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22791 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22792 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22793
22794 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22795 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22796 help us to understand.
22797
22798 @item
22799 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22800
22801 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22802 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22803 @end itemize
22804
22805 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22806 @c and consists of the two following files:
22807 @c rluser.texinfo
22808 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22809 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22810 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22811 @include rluser.texi
22812 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22813
22814
22815 @node Formatting Documentation
22816 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22817
22818 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22819 @cindex reference card
22820 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22821 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22822 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22823 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22824 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22825 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22826
22827 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22828 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22829
22830 @smallexample
22831 make refcard.dvi
22832 @end smallexample
22833
22834 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22835 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22836 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22837 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22838 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22839
22840 @cindex documentation
22841
22842 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22843 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22844 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22845 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22846 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22847 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22848
22849 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22850 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22851 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22852 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22853 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22854 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22855 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22856 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22857
22858 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22859 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22860 @code{makeinfo}.
22861
22862 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22863 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22864 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22865
22866 @smallexample
22867 cd gdb
22868 make gdb.info
22869 @end smallexample
22870
22871 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22872 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22873 Texinfo definitions file.
22874
22875 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22876 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22877 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22878 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22879 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22880 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22881 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22882
22883 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22884 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22885 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22886 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22887 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22888 directory.
22889
22890 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22891 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22892 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22893 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22894
22895 @smallexample
22896 make gdb.dvi
22897 @end smallexample
22898
22899 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22900
22901 @node Installing GDB
22902 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22903 @cindex installation
22904
22905 @menu
22906 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22907 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
22908 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22909 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22910 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22911 @end menu
22912
22913 @node Requirements
22914 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
22915 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22916
22917 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22918 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22919
22920 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
22921 @table @asis
22922 @item ISO C90 compiler
22923 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22924 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22925
22926 @end table
22927
22928 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
22929 @table @asis
22930 @item Expat
22931 @anchor{Expat}
22932 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22933 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22934 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22935 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
22936 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22937 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22938
22939 Expat is used for:
22940
22941 @itemize @bullet
22942 @item
22943 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
22944 @item
22945 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
22946 @item
22947 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
22948 @item
22949 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
22950 @end itemize
22951
22952 @item zlib
22953 @cindex compressed debug sections
22954 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
22955 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
22956 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
22957 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
22958 information in such binaries.
22959
22960 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
22961 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
22962 @url{http://zlib.net}.
22963
22964 @end table
22965
22966 @node Running Configure
22967 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
22968 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22969 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
22970 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22971 build the @code{gdb} program.
22972 @iftex
22973 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22974 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22975 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22976 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22977 @end iftex
22978
22979 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22980 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22981 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22982
22983 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22984 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22985
22986 @table @code
22987 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22988 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22989
22990 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22991 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22992
22993 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22994 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22995
22996 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22997 @sc{gnu} include files
22998
22999 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
23000 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
23001
23002 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
23003 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
23004
23005 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
23006 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
23007
23008 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
23009 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
23010
23011 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
23012 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
23013 @end table
23014
23015 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
23016 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
23017 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
23018
23019 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
23020 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
23021 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
23022 argument.
23023
23024 For example:
23025
23026 @smallexample
23027 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
23028 ./configure @var{host}
23029 make
23030 @end smallexample
23031
23032 @noindent
23033 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
23034 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
23035 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
23036 correct value by examining your system.)
23037
23038 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
23039 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
23040 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
23041 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
23042
23043 @need 750
23044 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
23045 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
23046 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
23047
23048 @smallexample
23049 sh configure @var{host}
23050 @end smallexample
23051
23052 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
23053 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
23054 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
23055 @file{configure}
23056 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
23057 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
23058
23059 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
23060 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
23061 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
23062 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
23063 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
23064 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
23065 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
23066 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
23067 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
23068
23069 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
23070 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
23071 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
23072 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
23073 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
23074
23075 @node Separate Objdir
23076 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
23077
23078 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
23079 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
23080 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
23081 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
23082 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
23083 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
23084 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
23085 program specified there.
23086
23087 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
23088 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
23089 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
23090 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
23091 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
23092 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
23093
23094 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
23095 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
23096
23097 @smallexample
23098 @group
23099 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
23100 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
23101 cd ../gdb-sun4
23102 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
23103 make
23104 @end group
23105 @end smallexample
23106
23107 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
23108 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
23109 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
23110 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
23111 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
23112 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
23113
23114 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
23115 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
23116 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
23117 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
23118 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
23119
23120 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
23121 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
23122 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
23123 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
23124 You specify a cross-debugging target by
23125 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
23126
23127 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
23128 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
23129 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
23130
23131 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
23132 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
23133 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
23134 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
23135 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
23136
23137 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
23138 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
23139 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
23140 with each other.
23141
23142 @node Config Names
23143 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
23144
23145 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
23146 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
23147 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
23148 of information in the following pattern:
23149
23150 @smallexample
23151 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
23152 @end smallexample
23153
23154 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
23155 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
23156 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
23157
23158 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
23159 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
23160 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
23161 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
23162 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
23163 abbreviations---for example:
23164
23165 @smallexample
23166 % sh config.sub i386-linux
23167 i386-pc-linux-gnu
23168 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
23169 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
23170 % sh config.sub hp9k700
23171 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
23172 % sh config.sub sun4
23173 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
23174 % sh config.sub sun3
23175 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
23176 % sh config.sub i986v
23177 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
23178 @end smallexample
23179
23180 @noindent
23181 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
23182 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
23183
23184 @node Configure Options
23185 @section @file{configure} Options
23186
23187 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
23188 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
23189 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
23190 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
23191
23192 @smallexample
23193 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
23194 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23195 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23196 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
23197 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
23198 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
23199 @var{host}
23200 @end smallexample
23201
23202 @noindent
23203 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
23204 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
23205 @samp{--}.
23206
23207 @table @code
23208 @item --help
23209 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
23210
23211 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
23212 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
23213 @file{@var{dir}}.
23214
23215 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
23216 Configure the source to install programs under directory
23217 @file{@var{dir}}.
23218
23219 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
23220 @need 2000
23221 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
23222 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
23223 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
23224 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
23225 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
23226 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
23227 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
23228 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
23229 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
23230 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
23231 @var{dirname}.
23232
23233 @item --norecursion
23234 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
23235 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
23236
23237 @item --target=@var{target}
23238 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
23239 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
23240 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
23241
23242 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
23243
23244 @item @var{host} @dots{}
23245 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
23246
23247 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
23248 @end table
23249
23250 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
23251 needed for special purposes only.
23252
23253 @node Maintenance Commands
23254 @appendix Maintenance Commands
23255 @cindex maintenance commands
23256 @cindex internal commands
23257
23258 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
23259 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
23260 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
23261 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
23262 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
23263
23264 @table @code
23265 @kindex maint agent
23266 @item maint agent @var{expression}
23267 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
23268 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
23269 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
23270
23271 @kindex maint info breakpoints
23272 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
23273 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
23274 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
23275 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
23276 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
23277 is shown:
23278
23279 @table @code
23280 @item breakpoint
23281 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
23282
23283 @item watchpoint
23284 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
23285
23286 @item longjmp
23287 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
23288 @code{longjmp} calls.
23289
23290 @item longjmp resume
23291 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
23292
23293 @item until
23294 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
23295
23296 @item finish
23297 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
23298
23299 @item shlib events
23300 Shared library events.
23301
23302 @end table
23303
23304 @kindex maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23305 @kindex maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23306 @cindex displaced stepping support
23307 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
23308 @item maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23309 @itemx maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23310 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
23311 if the target supports it. The default is on. Displaced stepping is
23312 a way to single-step over breakpoints without removing them from the
23313 inferior, by executing an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was
23314 originally at the breakpoint location. It is also known as
23315 out-of-line single-stepping.
23316
23317 @kindex maint check-symtabs
23318 @item maint check-symtabs
23319 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
23320
23321 @kindex maint cplus first_component
23322 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
23323 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
23324
23325 @kindex maint cplus namespace
23326 @item maint cplus namespace
23327 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
23328
23329 @kindex maint demangle
23330 @item maint demangle @var{name}
23331 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
23332
23333 @kindex maint deprecate
23334 @kindex maint undeprecate
23335 @cindex deprecated commands
23336 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
23337 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
23338 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
23339 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
23340 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
23341 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
23342 the replacement as part of the warning.
23343
23344 @kindex maint dump-me
23345 @item maint dump-me
23346 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
23347 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
23348 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
23349 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
23350
23351 @kindex maint internal-error
23352 @kindex maint internal-warning
23353 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23354 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23355 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
23356 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
23357 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
23358 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
23359 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
23360 @value{GDBN} session.
23361
23362 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
23363 used as the text of the error or warning message.
23364
23365 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
23366
23367 @smallexample
23368 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
23369 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
23370 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
23371 debugging may prove unreliable.
23372 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23373 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23374 (@value{GDBP})
23375 @end smallexample
23376
23377 @kindex maint packet
23378 @item maint packet @var{text}
23379 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
23380 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
23381 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
23382 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
23383 checksum.
23384
23385 @kindex maint print architecture
23386 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23387 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
23388 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
23389
23390 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
23391 @item maint print c-tdesc
23392 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
23393 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
23394 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
23395
23396 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
23397 @item maint print dummy-frames
23398 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
23399
23400 @smallexample
23401 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
23402 @dots{}
23403 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
23404 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
23405 58 return (a + b);
23406 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
23407 @dots{}
23408 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
23409 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
23410 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
23411 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
23412 (@value{GDBP})
23413 @end smallexample
23414
23415 Takes an optional file parameter.
23416
23417 @kindex maint print registers
23418 @kindex maint print raw-registers
23419 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
23420 @kindex maint print register-groups
23421 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23422 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23423 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23424 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23425 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
23426
23427 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
23428 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
23429 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
23430 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
23431 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
23432 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
23433
23434 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
23435 write the information.
23436
23437 @kindex maint print reggroups
23438 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23439 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
23440 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
23441 information.
23442
23443 The register groups info looks like this:
23444
23445 @smallexample
23446 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
23447 Group Type
23448 general user
23449 float user
23450 all user
23451 vector user
23452 system user
23453 save internal
23454 restore internal
23455 @end smallexample
23456
23457 @kindex flushregs
23458 @item flushregs
23459 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
23460
23461 @kindex maint print objfiles
23462 @cindex info for known object files
23463 @item maint print objfiles
23464 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
23465 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
23466 and symtabs.
23467
23468 @kindex maint print statistics
23469 @cindex bcache statistics
23470 @item maint print statistics
23471 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
23472 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
23473 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
23474 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
23475 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
23476 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
23477 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
23478 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
23479 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
23480 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
23481 lengths.
23482
23483 @kindex maint print target-stack
23484 @cindex target stack description
23485 @item maint print target-stack
23486 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
23487 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
23488 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
23489 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
23490 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
23491 address.
23492
23493 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
23494 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
23495
23496 @kindex maint print type
23497 @cindex type chain of a data type
23498 @item maint print type @var{expr}
23499 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
23500 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
23501 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
23502 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
23503 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
23504
23505 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23506 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23507 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23508 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23509 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
23510
23511 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
23512 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
23513 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
23514 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
23515 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
23516 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
23517 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
23518 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
23519 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
23520
23521 @kindex maint set profile
23522 @kindex maint show profile
23523 @cindex profiling GDB
23524 @item maint set profile
23525 @itemx maint show profile
23526 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
23527
23528 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
23529 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
23530 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
23531 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
23532 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
23533 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
23534 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
23535
23536 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
23537 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
23538
23539 @kindex maint set linux-async
23540 @kindex maint show linux-async
23541 @cindex asynchronous support
23542 @item maint set linux-async
23543 @itemx maint show linux-async
23544 Control the GNU/Linux native asynchronous support of @value{GDBN}.
23545
23546 GNU/Linux native asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
23547 the @samp{maint set linux-async} command to enable it.
23548
23549 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
23550 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
23551 @item maint show-debug-regs
23552 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
23553 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
23554 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
23555 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
23556 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
23557
23558 @kindex maint space
23559 @cindex memory used by commands
23560 @item maint space
23561 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
23562 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
23563 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
23564 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
23565 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23566
23567 @kindex maint time
23568 @cindex time of command execution
23569 @item maint time
23570 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
23571 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
23572 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
23573 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
23574 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
23575 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
23576 it's not possibly currently
23577 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
23578 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23579
23580 @kindex maint translate-address
23581 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
23582 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
23583 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
23584 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
23585 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
23586 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
23587 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
23588
23589 @end table
23590
23591 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
23592 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
23593
23594 @table @code
23595 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
23596 @kindex set watchdog
23597 @cindex watchdog timer
23598 @cindex timeout for commands
23599 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
23600 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
23601 reports and error and the command is aborted.
23602
23603 @item show watchdog
23604 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
23605 @end table
23606
23607 @node Remote Protocol
23608 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
23609
23610 @menu
23611 * Overview::
23612 * Packets::
23613 * Stop Reply Packets::
23614 * General Query Packets::
23615 * Register Packet Format::
23616 * Tracepoint Packets::
23617 * Host I/O Packets::
23618 * Interrupts::
23619 * Examples::
23620 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
23621 * Library List Format::
23622 * Memory Map Format::
23623 @end menu
23624
23625 @node Overview
23626 @section Overview
23627
23628 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
23629 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
23630 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
23631 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
23632
23633 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
23634 transmitted and received data, respectively.
23635
23636 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
23637 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
23638 @cindex remote serial protocol
23639 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
23640 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
23641 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
23642 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
23643
23644 @smallexample
23645 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23646 @end smallexample
23647 @noindent
23648
23649 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
23650 @noindent
23651 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
23652 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
23653 eight bit unsigned checksum).
23654
23655 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
23656 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
23657
23658 @smallexample
23659 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23660 @end smallexample
23661
23662 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
23663 @noindent
23664 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
23665 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
23666 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
23667
23668 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
23669 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
23670 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
23671 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
23672 retransmission):
23673
23674 @smallexample
23675 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23676 <- @code{+}
23677 @end smallexample
23678 @noindent
23679
23680 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
23681 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
23682 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
23683 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
23684
23685 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
23686 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
23687 exceptions).
23688
23689 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
23690 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
23691 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
23692 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
23693
23694 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
23695 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
23696 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
23697
23698 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
23699 @anchor{Binary Data}
23700 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
23701 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
23702 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
23703 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
23704 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
23705 binary data.
23706
23707 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
23708 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
23709 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
23710 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
23711 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
23712 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
23713 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
23714 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
23715 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
23716 (described next).
23717
23718 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
23719 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
23720 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
23721 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
23722 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
23723 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
23724 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
23725 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
23726 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
23727 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
23728 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
23729 3}} more times.
23730
23731 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
23732 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
23733 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
23734 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
23735 @samp{0*"00}.
23736
23737 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23738 error number. That number is not well defined.
23739
23740 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23741 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23742 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23743 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23744 on that response.
23745
23746 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23747 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23748 optional.
23749
23750 @node Packets
23751 @section Packets
23752
23753 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23754 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23755 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
23756 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23757
23758 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23759 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23760 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23761 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23762 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23763 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23764 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23765 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
23766 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23767 @var{baz}.
23768
23769 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23770 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23771
23772 Here are the packet descriptions.
23773
23774 @table @samp
23775
23776 @item !
23777 @cindex @samp{!} packet
23778 @anchor{extended mode}
23779 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23780 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23781 debugged.
23782
23783 Reply:
23784 @table @samp
23785 @item OK
23786 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23787 @end table
23788
23789 @item ?
23790 @cindex @samp{?} packet
23791 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23792 step and continue.
23793
23794 Reply:
23795 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23796
23797 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23798 @cindex @samp{A} packet
23799 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23800 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23801 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23802
23803 Reply:
23804 @table @samp
23805 @item OK
23806 The arguments were set.
23807 @item E @var{NN}
23808 An error occurred.
23809 @end table
23810
23811 @item b @var{baud}
23812 @cindex @samp{b} packet
23813 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23814 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23815
23816 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23817 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23818 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23819
23820 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23821 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23822 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23823 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23824 of view, nothing actually happened.}
23825
23826 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23827 @cindex @samp{B} packet
23828 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23829 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23830
23831 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23832 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23833
23834 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23835 @cindex @samp{c} packet
23836 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23837 resume at current address.
23838
23839 Reply:
23840 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23841
23842 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23843 @cindex @samp{C} packet
23844 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23845 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23846
23847 Reply:
23848 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23849
23850 @item d
23851 @cindex @samp{d} packet
23852 Toggle debug flag.
23853
23854 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23855 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23856
23857 @item D
23858 @cindex @samp{D} packet
23859 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23860 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23861
23862 Reply:
23863 @table @samp
23864 @item OK
23865 for success
23866 @item E @var{NN}
23867 for an error
23868 @end table
23869
23870 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23871 @cindex @samp{F} packet
23872 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23873 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23874 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
23875
23876 @item g
23877 @anchor{read registers packet}
23878 @cindex @samp{g} packet
23879 Read general registers.
23880
23881 Reply:
23882 @table @samp
23883 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23884 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23885 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23886 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23887 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
23888 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
23889 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23890 @item E @var{NN}
23891 for an error.
23892 @end table
23893
23894 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23895 @cindex @samp{G} packet
23896 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23897 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23898
23899 Reply:
23900 @table @samp
23901 @item OK
23902 for success
23903 @item E @var{NN}
23904 for an error
23905 @end table
23906
23907 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23908 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23909 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23910 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23911 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23912 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23913 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23914
23915 Reply:
23916 @table @samp
23917 @item OK
23918 for success
23919 @item E @var{NN}
23920 for an error
23921 @end table
23922
23923 @c FIXME: JTC:
23924 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23925 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23926 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23927 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23928 @c described. For example:
23929 @c
23930 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23931 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23932 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23933 @c
23934 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23935 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23936 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23937
23938 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23939 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23940 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23941 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23942 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23943 step starting at that address.
23944
23945 @item I
23946 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23947 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23948 step packet}.
23949
23950 @item k
23951 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23952 Kill request.
23953
23954 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23955 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23956 thread?)}.
23957
23958 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23959 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23960 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23961 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23962
23963 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23964 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23965 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23966 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23967 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23968 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23969 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23970 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23971
23972 Reply:
23973 @table @samp
23974 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23975 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23976 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23977 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23978 @item E @var{NN}
23979 @var{NN} is errno
23980 @end table
23981
23982 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23983 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23984 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23985 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23986 hexadecimal number.
23987
23988 Reply:
23989 @table @samp
23990 @item OK
23991 for success
23992 @item E @var{NN}
23993 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23994 written).
23995 @end table
23996
23997 @item p @var{n}
23998 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23999 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
24000 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
24001 register value is encoded.
24002
24003 Reply:
24004 @table @samp
24005 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
24006 the register's value
24007 @item E @var{NN}
24008 for an error
24009 @item
24010 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
24011 @end table
24012
24013 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
24014 @anchor{write register packet}
24015 @cindex @samp{P} packet
24016 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
24017 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
24018 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
24019
24020 Reply:
24021 @table @samp
24022 @item OK
24023 for success
24024 @item E @var{NN}
24025 for an error
24026 @end table
24027
24028 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
24029 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
24030 @cindex @samp{q} packet
24031 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
24032 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
24033 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
24034
24035 @item r
24036 @cindex @samp{r} packet
24037 Reset the entire system.
24038
24039 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
24040
24041 @item R @var{XX}
24042 @cindex @samp{R} packet
24043 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
24044 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24045
24046 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
24047
24048 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
24049 @cindex @samp{s} packet
24050 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
24051 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
24052
24053 Reply:
24054 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24055
24056 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
24057 @anchor{step with signal packet}
24058 @cindex @samp{S} packet
24059 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
24060 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
24061
24062 Reply:
24063 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24064
24065 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
24066 @cindex @samp{t} packet
24067 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
24068 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
24069 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
24070
24071 @item T @var{XX}
24072 @cindex @samp{T} packet
24073 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
24074
24075 Reply:
24076 @table @samp
24077 @item OK
24078 thread is still alive
24079 @item E @var{NN}
24080 thread is dead
24081 @end table
24082
24083 @item v
24084 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
24085 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
24086
24087 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
24088 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
24089 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
24090 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. If the stub is currently
24091 controlling a process, it is killed. The attached process is stopped.
24092
24093 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24094
24095 Reply:
24096 @table @samp
24097 @item E @var{nn}
24098 for an error
24099 @item @r{Any stop packet}
24100 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24101 @end table
24102
24103 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
24104 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
24105 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
24106 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
24107 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
24108 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
24109 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
24110 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
24111
24112 @table @samp
24113 @item c
24114 Continue.
24115 @item C @var{sig}
24116 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
24117 @item s
24118 Step.
24119 @item S @var{sig}
24120 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
24121 @end table
24122
24123 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
24124 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
24125
24126 Reply:
24127 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24128
24129 @item vCont?
24130 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
24131 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
24132
24133 Reply:
24134 @table @samp
24135 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
24136 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
24137 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
24138 @item
24139 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
24140 @end table
24141
24142 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
24143 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
24144 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
24145 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
24146
24147 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
24148 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
24149 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
24150 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
24151 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
24152 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
24153 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
24154 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
24155 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24156 packet is received.
24157
24158 Reply:
24159 @table @samp
24160 @item OK
24161 for success
24162 @item E @var{NN}
24163 for an error
24164 @end table
24165
24166 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24167 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
24168 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
24169 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
24170 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
24171 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
24172 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
24173 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
24174 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
24175 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
24176 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
24177 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
24178
24179
24180 Reply:
24181 @table @samp
24182 @item OK
24183 for success
24184 @item E.memtype
24185 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
24186 @item E @var{NN}
24187 for an error
24188 @end table
24189
24190 @item vFlashDone
24191 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
24192 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
24193 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
24194 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
24195 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
24196 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24197 request is completed.
24198
24199 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
24200 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
24201 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
24202 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
24203 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
24204 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
24205 state. If the stub is currently controlling a process, it is killed.
24206
24207 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24208
24209 Reply:
24210 @table @samp
24211 @item E @var{nn}
24212 for an error
24213 @item @r{Any stop packet}
24214 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24215 @end table
24216
24217 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24218 @anchor{X packet}
24219 @cindex @samp{X} packet
24220 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
24221 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
24222 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
24223
24224 Reply:
24225 @table @samp
24226 @item OK
24227 for success
24228 @item E @var{NN}
24229 for an error
24230 @end table
24231
24232 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24233 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24234 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
24235 @cindex @samp{z} packet
24236 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
24237 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
24238 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
24239 @var{length} bytes.
24240
24241 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
24242 separately.
24243
24244 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
24245 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
24246 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
24247 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
24248 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
24249 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
24250
24251 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24252 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24253 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
24254 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
24255 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
24256 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24257
24258 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
24259 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
24260 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
24261 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
24262 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
24263
24264 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
24265 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
24266 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
24267 target, is not defined.}
24268
24269 Reply:
24270 @table @samp
24271 @item OK
24272 success
24273 @item
24274 not supported
24275 @item E @var{NN}
24276 for an error
24277 @end table
24278
24279 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24280 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24281 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
24282 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
24283 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
24284 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24285
24286 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
24287 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
24288
24289 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
24290 movement.}
24291
24292 Reply:
24293 @table @samp
24294 @item OK
24295 success
24296 @item
24297 not supported
24298 @item E @var{NN}
24299 for an error
24300 @end table
24301
24302 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24303 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24304 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
24305 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
24306 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
24307
24308 Reply:
24309 @table @samp
24310 @item OK
24311 success
24312 @item
24313 not supported
24314 @item E @var{NN}
24315 for an error
24316 @end table
24317
24318 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24319 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24320 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
24321 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
24322 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
24323
24324 Reply:
24325 @table @samp
24326 @item OK
24327 success
24328 @item
24329 not supported
24330 @item E @var{NN}
24331 for an error
24332 @end table
24333
24334 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24335 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24336 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
24337 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
24338 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
24339
24340 Reply:
24341 @table @samp
24342 @item OK
24343 success
24344 @item
24345 not supported
24346 @item E @var{NN}
24347 for an error
24348 @end table
24349
24350 @end table
24351
24352 @node Stop Reply Packets
24353 @section Stop Reply Packets
24354 @cindex stop reply packets
24355
24356 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
24357 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
24358 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
24359 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
24360 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
24361 @value{GDBN} source code.
24362
24363 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
24364 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
24365 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
24366 components.
24367
24368 @table @samp
24369
24370 @item S @var{AA}
24371 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24372 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
24373 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
24374
24375 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
24376 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
24377 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24378 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
24379 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
24380 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
24381 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
24382 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
24383
24384 @itemize @bullet
24385 @item
24386 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
24387 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
24388 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
24389 two-digit hex number.
24390
24391 @item
24392 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
24393 hex.
24394
24395 @item
24396 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
24397 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
24398 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
24399 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
24400
24401 @item
24402 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
24403 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
24404 future.
24405 @end itemize
24406
24407 The currently defined stop reasons are:
24408
24409 @table @samp
24410 @item watch
24411 @itemx rwatch
24412 @itemx awatch
24413 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
24414 hex.
24415
24416 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
24417 @item library
24418 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
24419 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
24420 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
24421 @end table
24422
24423 @item W @var{AA}
24424 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
24425 applicable to certain targets.
24426
24427 @item X @var{AA}
24428 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
24429
24430 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
24431 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
24432 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
24433 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
24434 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
24435
24436 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
24437 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
24438 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
24439 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
24440 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
24441 system calls.
24442
24443 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
24444 this very system call.
24445
24446 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
24447 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
24448 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
24449 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24450 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
24451 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
24452
24453 @end table
24454
24455 @node General Query Packets
24456 @section General Query Packets
24457 @cindex remote query requests
24458
24459 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
24460 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
24461 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
24462 sending information to and from the stub.
24463
24464 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
24465 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
24466 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
24467 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
24468 conventions:
24469
24470 @itemize @bullet
24471 @item
24472 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
24473 @item
24474 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
24475 letter.
24476 @item
24477 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
24478 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
24479 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
24480 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
24481 @end itemize
24482
24483 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
24484 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
24485 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
24486 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
24487 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
24488 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
24489 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
24490 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
24491 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
24492 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
24493 packet.}.
24494
24495 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
24496 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
24497 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
24498 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
24499 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
24500
24501 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
24502
24503 @table @samp
24504
24505 @item qC
24506 @cindex current thread, remote request
24507 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
24508 Return the current thread id.
24509
24510 Reply:
24511 @table @samp
24512 @item QC @var{pid}
24513 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
24514 @item @r{(anything else)}
24515 Any other reply implies the old pid.
24516 @end table
24517
24518 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
24519 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
24520 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
24521 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
24522 Reply:
24523 @table @samp
24524 @item E @var{NN}
24525 An error (such as memory fault)
24526 @item C @var{crc32}
24527 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
24528 @end table
24529
24530 @item qfThreadInfo
24531 @itemx qsThreadInfo
24532 @cindex list active threads, remote request
24533 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
24534 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
24535 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
24536 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
24537 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
24538 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
24539 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
24540 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
24541
24542 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
24543
24544 Reply:
24545 @table @samp
24546 @item m @var{id}
24547 A single thread id
24548 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
24549 a comma-separated list of thread ids
24550 @item l
24551 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
24552 @end table
24553
24554 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
24555 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
24556 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
24557 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
24558 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
24559
24560 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
24561 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
24562 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
24563 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
24564 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
24565
24566 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
24567 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
24568
24569 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
24570 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
24571 information associated with the variable.)
24572
24573 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
24574 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
24575 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
24576 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
24577 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
24578 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
24579
24580 Reply:
24581 @table @samp
24582 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24583 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
24584 local storage requested.
24585
24586 @item E @var{nn}
24587 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24588
24589 @item
24590 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
24591 @end table
24592
24593 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
24594 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
24595 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
24596 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
24597 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
24598 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
24599 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
24600
24601 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
24602
24603 Reply:
24604 @table @samp
24605 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
24606 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
24607 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
24608 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
24609 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
24610 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
24611 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
24612 @end table
24613
24614 @item qOffsets
24615 @cindex section offsets, remote request
24616 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
24617 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
24618 image.
24619
24620 Reply:
24621 @table @samp
24622 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
24623 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
24624 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
24625 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
24626 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
24627 segments by the supplied offsets.
24628
24629 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
24630 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
24631 to the @code{Bss} section.}
24632
24633 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
24634 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
24635 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
24636 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
24637 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
24638 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
24639 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
24640 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
24641 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
24642 @end table
24643
24644 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
24645 @cindex thread information, remote request
24646 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
24647 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
24648 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
24649
24650 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
24651 (see below).
24652
24653 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
24654
24655 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
24656 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
24657 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24658 @anchor{QPassSignals}
24659 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
24660 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
24661 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
24662 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
24663 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
24664 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
24665 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
24666 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
24667 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
24668
24669 Reply:
24670 @table @samp
24671 @item OK
24672 The request succeeded.
24673
24674 @item E @var{nn}
24675 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24676
24677 @item
24678 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
24679 the stub.
24680 @end table
24681
24682 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
24683 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
24684 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24685 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24686
24687 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
24688 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
24689 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
24690 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
24691 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
24692 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
24693 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
24694 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
24695 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
24696
24697 Reply:
24698 @table @samp
24699 @item OK
24700 A command response with no output.
24701 @item @var{OUTPUT}
24702 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
24703 @item E @var{NN}
24704 Indicate a badly formed request.
24705 @item
24706 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
24707 @end table
24708
24709 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
24710 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24711 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24712 packets.)
24713
24714 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
24715 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
24716 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
24717 @anchor{qSearch memory}
24718 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
24719 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
24720 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
24721
24722 Reply:
24723 @table @samp
24724 @item 0
24725 The pattern was not found.
24726 @item 1,address
24727 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
24728 @item E @var{NN}
24729 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
24730 @item
24731 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
24732 @end table
24733
24734 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
24735 @cindex supported packets, remote query
24736 @cindex features of the remote protocol
24737 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
24738 @anchor{qSupported}
24739 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
24740 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
24741 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
24742 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
24743 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
24744 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
24745 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
24746 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
24747 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
24748 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
24749 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
24750 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
24751 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
24752 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
24753
24754 Reply:
24755 @table @samp
24756 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
24757 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
24758 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
24759 possible forms).
24760 @item
24761 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
24762 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
24763 @end table
24764
24765 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
24766 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
24767 are:
24768
24769 @table @samp
24770 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
24771 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
24772 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
24773 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
24774 @item @var{name}+
24775 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
24776 need an associated value.
24777 @item @var{name}-
24778 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
24779 @item @var{name}?
24780 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
24781 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
24782 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
24783 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
24784 @end table
24785
24786 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
24787 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
24788 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
24789 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
24790 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
24791
24792 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
24793 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
24794 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
24795 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
24796 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
24797 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
24798 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
24799 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
24800 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
24801 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
24802 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
24803 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
24804 all the features it supports.
24805
24806 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
24807 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
24808
24809 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
24810 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
24811 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
24812 form response.
24813
24814 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
24815 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
24816 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
24817 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
24818
24819 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
24820 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
24821 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
24822 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
24823 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
24824
24825 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24826
24827 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
24828 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24829 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24830 @item Feature Name
24831 @tab Value Required
24832 @tab Default
24833 @tab Probe Allowed
24834
24835 @item @samp{PacketSize}
24836 @tab Yes
24837 @tab @samp{-}
24838 @tab No
24839
24840 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24841 @tab No
24842 @tab @samp{-}
24843 @tab Yes
24844
24845 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
24846 @tab No
24847 @tab @samp{-}
24848 @tab Yes
24849
24850 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
24851 @tab No
24852 @tab @samp{-}
24853 @tab Yes
24854
24855 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
24856 @tab No
24857 @tab @samp{-}
24858 @tab Yes
24859
24860 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
24861 @tab No
24862 @tab @samp{-}
24863 @tab Yes
24864
24865 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
24866 @tab No
24867 @tab @samp{-}
24868 @tab Yes
24869
24870 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
24871 @tab No
24872 @tab @samp{-}
24873 @tab Yes
24874
24875 @end multitable
24876
24877 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24878
24879 @table @samp
24880 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
24881 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24882 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24883 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24884 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24885 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24886 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24887 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24888 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24889 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24890
24891 @item qXfer:auxv:read
24892 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24893 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24894
24895 @item qXfer:features:read
24896 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24897 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24898
24899 @item qXfer:libraries:read
24900 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
24901 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
24902
24903 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
24904 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24905 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24906
24907 @item qXfer:spu:read
24908 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
24909 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
24910
24911 @item qXfer:spu:write
24912 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
24913 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
24914
24915 @item QPassSignals
24916 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24917 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24918
24919 @end table
24920
24921 @item qSymbol::
24922 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24923 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24924 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24925 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24926
24927 Reply:
24928 @table @samp
24929 @item OK
24930 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24931 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24932 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24933 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24934 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24935 below.
24936 @end table
24937
24938 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24939 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24940
24941 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24942 target has previously requested.
24943
24944 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24945 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24946 will be empty.
24947
24948 Reply:
24949 @table @samp
24950 @item OK
24951 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24952 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24953 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24954 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24955 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24956 @end table
24957
24958 @item QTDP
24959 @itemx QTFrame
24960 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24961
24962 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24963 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24964 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24965 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24966 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24967 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24968 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24969 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24970 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24971 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24972
24973 Reply:
24974 @table @samp
24975 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24976 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24977 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24978 the thread's attributes.
24979 @end table
24980
24981 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24982 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24983 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24984 packets.)
24985
24986 @item QTStart
24987 @itemx QTStop
24988 @itemx QTinit
24989 @itemx QTro
24990 @itemx qTStatus
24991 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24992
24993 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24994 @cindex read special object, remote request
24995 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24996 @anchor{qXfer read}
24997 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24998 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24999 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
25000 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
25001 additional details about what data to access.
25002
25003 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
25004 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
25005 formats, listed below.
25006
25007 @table @samp
25008 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
25009 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
25010 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
25011 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
25012
25013 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25014 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25015
25016 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25017 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
25018 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
25019 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
25020 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
25021
25022 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25023 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25024
25025 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25026 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
25027 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
25028 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
25029 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
25030
25031 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
25032 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
25033 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
25034
25035 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25036 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25037
25038 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
25039 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
25040 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
25041 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
25042 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
25043
25044 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25045 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25046
25047 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25048 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
25049 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
25050 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
25051 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
25052 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
25053 in that context to be accessed.
25054
25055 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25056 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25057 @end table
25058
25059 Reply:
25060 @table @samp
25061 @item m @var{data}
25062 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
25063 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
25064 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
25065 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
25066 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
25067 request.
25068
25069 @item l @var{data}
25070 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
25071 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
25072 than the @var{length} in the request.
25073
25074 @item l
25075 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
25076 There is no more data to be read.
25077
25078 @item E00
25079 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
25080
25081 @item E @var{nn}
25082 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
25083 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
25084
25085 @item
25086 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
25087 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
25088 @end table
25089
25090 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
25091 @cindex write data into object, remote request
25092 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
25093 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
25094 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
25095 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
25096 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
25097 to access.
25098
25099 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
25100 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
25101 formats, listed below.
25102
25103 @table @samp
25104 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
25105 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
25106 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
25107 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
25108 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
25109 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
25110 in that context to be accessed.
25111
25112 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25113 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25114 @end table
25115
25116 Reply:
25117 @table @samp
25118 @item @var{nn}
25119 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
25120 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
25121
25122 @item E00
25123 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
25124
25125 @item E @var{nn}
25126 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
25127 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
25128
25129 @item
25130 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
25131 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
25132 @end table
25133
25134 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
25135 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
25136 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
25137 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
25138 must respond with an empty packet.
25139
25140 @end table
25141
25142 @node Register Packet Format
25143 @section Register Packet Format
25144
25145 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
25146 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
25147 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
25148 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
25149 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
25150 most-significant - least-significant.
25151
25152 @table @r
25153
25154 @item MIPS32
25155
25156 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
25157 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
25158 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
25159
25160 @item MIPS64
25161
25162 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
25163 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
25164 as @code{MIPS32}.
25165
25166 @end table
25167
25168 @node Tracepoint Packets
25169 @section Tracepoint Packets
25170 @cindex tracepoint packets
25171 @cindex packets, tracepoint
25172
25173 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
25174 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
25175
25176 @table @samp
25177
25178 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
25179 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
25180 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
25181 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
25182 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
25183 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
25184 tracepoint's actions.
25185
25186 Replies:
25187 @table @samp
25188 @item OK
25189 The packet was understood and carried out.
25190 @item
25191 The packet was not recognized.
25192 @end table
25193
25194 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
25195 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
25196 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
25197 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
25198 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
25199 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
25200 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
25201
25202 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
25203 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
25204 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
25205 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
25206 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
25207 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
25208 tracepoint actions.
25209
25210 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
25211 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
25212 following forms:
25213
25214 @table @samp
25215
25216 @item R @var{mask}
25217 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
25218 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
25219 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
25220 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
25221 not fit in a 32-bit word.
25222
25223 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
25224 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
25225 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
25226 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
25227 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
25228 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
25229 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
25230
25231 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
25232 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
25233 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
25234 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
25235 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
25236 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
25237 packet).
25238
25239 @end table
25240
25241 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
25242 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
25243 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
25244 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
25245 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
25246 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
25247 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
25248 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
25249
25250 Replies:
25251 @table @samp
25252 @item OK
25253 The packet was understood and carried out.
25254 @item
25255 The packet was not recognized.
25256 @end table
25257
25258 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
25259 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
25260 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
25261 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
25262
25263 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
25264 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
25265 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
25266 one of the following forms:
25267
25268 @table @samp
25269 @item F @var{f}
25270 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
25271 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
25272 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
25273
25274 @item T @var{t}
25275 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
25276 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
25277
25278 @end table
25279
25280 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
25281 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25282 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
25283 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
25284
25285 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
25286 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25287 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
25288 is a hexadecimal number.
25289
25290 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
25291 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25292 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
25293 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
25294 numbers.
25295
25296 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
25297 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
25298 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
25299
25300 @item QTStart
25301 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
25302 hits in the trace frame buffer.
25303
25304 @item QTStop
25305 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
25306
25307 @item QTinit
25308 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
25309
25310 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
25311 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
25312 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
25313 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
25314
25315 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
25316 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
25317 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
25318 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
25319
25320 @item qTStatus
25321 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
25322
25323 Replies:
25324 @table @samp
25325 @item T0
25326 There is no trace experiment running.
25327 @item T1
25328 There is a trace experiment running.
25329 @end table
25330
25331 @end table
25332
25333
25334 @node Host I/O Packets
25335 @section Host I/O Packets
25336 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
25337 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
25338
25339 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
25340 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
25341 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
25342 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
25343 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
25344 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
25345 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
25346 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
25347 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
25348 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
25349
25350 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
25351 its arguments. They have this format:
25352
25353 @table @samp
25354
25355 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
25356 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
25357 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
25358 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
25359 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
25360 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
25361 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
25362 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
25363 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
25364
25365 @end table
25366
25367 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
25368
25369 @table @samp
25370
25371 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
25372 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
25373 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
25374 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
25375 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
25376 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
25377 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
25378 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
25379 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
25380 @var{attachment}.
25381
25382 @item
25383 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
25384
25385 @end table
25386
25387 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
25388
25389 @table @samp
25390 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
25391 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
25392 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
25393 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
25394 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
25395 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
25396 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
25397
25398 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
25399 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
25400 -1 if an error occurs.
25401
25402 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
25403 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
25404 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
25405 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
25406 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
25407 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
25408 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
25409 @var{count} was zero.
25410
25411 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
25412 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
25413 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
25414 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
25415 some characters were escaped.
25416
25417 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
25418 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
25419 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
25420 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
25421 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
25422 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
25423 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
25424 error occurred.
25425
25426 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
25427 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
25428 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
25429
25430 @end table
25431
25432 @node Interrupts
25433 @section Interrupts
25434 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
25435
25436 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
25437 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
25438 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
25439 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
25440
25441 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
25442 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
25443 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
25444 interfaces.
25445
25446 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
25447 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
25448 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
25449 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
25450 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
25451 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
25452 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
25453 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
25454
25455 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
25456 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
25457 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
25458 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
25459 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
25460 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
25461 program is stopped will be discarded.
25462
25463 @node Examples
25464 @section Examples
25465
25466 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
25467 does not get any direct output:
25468
25469 @smallexample
25470 -> @code{R00}
25471 <- @code{+}
25472 @emph{target restarts}
25473 -> @code{?}
25474 <- @code{+}
25475 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25476 -> @code{+}
25477 @end smallexample
25478
25479 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
25480
25481 @smallexample
25482 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
25483 <- @code{+}
25484 -> @code{s}
25485 <- @code{+}
25486 @emph{time passes}
25487 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25488 -> @code{+}
25489 -> @code{g}
25490 <- @code{+}
25491 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
25492 -> @code{+}
25493 @end smallexample
25494
25495 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25496 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25497 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
25498
25499 @menu
25500 * File-I/O Overview::
25501 * Protocol Basics::
25502 * The F Request Packet::
25503 * The F Reply Packet::
25504 * The Ctrl-C Message::
25505 * Console I/O::
25506 * List of Supported Calls::
25507 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
25508 * Constants::
25509 * File-I/O Examples::
25510 @end menu
25511
25512 @node File-I/O Overview
25513 @subsection File-I/O Overview
25514 @cindex file-i/o overview
25515
25516 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
25517 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
25518 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
25519 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
25520 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
25521 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
25522
25523 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
25524 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
25525 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
25526 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
25527 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
25528
25529 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
25530 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
25531 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
25532 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
25533 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
25534 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
25535 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
25536
25537 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
25538 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
25539 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
25540 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
25541 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
25542
25543 @smallexample
25544 (@value{GDBP}) continue
25545 <- target requests 'system call X'
25546 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
25547 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
25548 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
25549 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
25550 @end smallexample
25551
25552 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
25553 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
25554 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
25555 system are not supported by this protocol.
25556
25557 @node Protocol Basics
25558 @subsection Protocol Basics
25559 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
25560
25561 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
25562 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
25563 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
25564 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
25565 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
25566 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
25567 to call the appropriate host system call:
25568
25569 @itemize @bullet
25570 @item
25571 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
25572
25573 @item
25574 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
25575 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
25576 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
25577 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
25578
25579 @end itemize
25580
25581 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
25582
25583 @itemize @bullet
25584 @item
25585 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
25586 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
25587 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
25588 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
25589 packet.
25590
25591 @item
25592 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
25593 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
25594
25595 @item
25596 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
25597
25598 @item
25599 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
25600
25601 @item
25602 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
25603 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
25604 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
25605 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
25606 packet.
25607
25608 @end itemize
25609
25610 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
25611 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
25612
25613 @itemize @bullet
25614 @item
25615 Return value.
25616
25617 @item
25618 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
25619
25620 @item
25621 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
25622
25623 @end itemize
25624
25625 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
25626 the latest continue or step action.
25627
25628 @node The F Request Packet
25629 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
25630 @cindex file-i/o request packet
25631 @cindex @code{F} request packet
25632
25633 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
25634
25635 @table @samp
25636 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
25637
25638 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
25639 This is just the name of the function.
25640
25641 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
25642 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
25643 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
25644 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
25645 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
25646 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
25647 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
25648
25649 @end table
25650
25651
25652
25653 @node The F Reply Packet
25654 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
25655 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
25656 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
25657
25658 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
25659
25660 @table @samp
25661
25662 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
25663
25664 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
25665
25666 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
25667 representation.
25668 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
25669
25670 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
25671 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
25672 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
25673
25674 @smallexample
25675 F0,0,C
25676 @end smallexample
25677
25678 @noindent
25679 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
25680
25681 @smallexample
25682 F-1,4,C
25683 @end smallexample
25684
25685 @noindent
25686 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
25687
25688 @end table
25689
25690
25691 @node The Ctrl-C Message
25692 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
25693 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
25694
25695 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
25696 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
25697 the target should behave as if it had
25698 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
25699 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
25700 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
25701 packet.
25702
25703 It's important for the target to know in which
25704 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
25705
25706 @itemize @bullet
25707 @item
25708 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
25709
25710 @item
25711 The system call on the host has been finished.
25712
25713 @end itemize
25714
25715 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
25716 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
25717 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
25718 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
25719 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
25720 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
25721
25722 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
25723 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
25724 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
25725 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
25726 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
25727 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
25728 or the full action has been completed.
25729
25730 @node Console I/O
25731 @subsection Console I/O
25732 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
25733
25734 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
25735 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
25736 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
25737 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
25738 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
25739 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
25740 conditions is met:
25741
25742 @itemize @bullet
25743 @item
25744 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
25745 @code{read}
25746 system call is treated as finished.
25747
25748 @item
25749 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
25750 newline.
25751
25752 @item
25753 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
25754 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
25755
25756 @end itemize
25757
25758 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
25759 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
25760 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
25761 is stopped at the user's request.
25762
25763
25764 @node List of Supported Calls
25765 @subsection List of Supported Calls
25766 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
25767
25768 @menu
25769 * open::
25770 * close::
25771 * read::
25772 * write::
25773 * lseek::
25774 * rename::
25775 * unlink::
25776 * stat/fstat::
25777 * gettimeofday::
25778 * isatty::
25779 * system::
25780 @end menu
25781
25782 @node open
25783 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
25784 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
25785
25786 @table @asis
25787 @item Synopsis:
25788 @smallexample
25789 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
25790 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
25791 @end smallexample
25792
25793 @item Request:
25794 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
25795
25796 @noindent
25797 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25798
25799 @table @code
25800 @item O_CREAT
25801 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
25802 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
25803 are concerned.
25804
25805 @item O_EXCL
25806 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
25807 an error and open() fails.
25808
25809 @item O_TRUNC
25810 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
25811 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
25812 truncated to zero length.
25813
25814 @item O_APPEND
25815 The file is opened in append mode.
25816
25817 @item O_RDONLY
25818 The file is opened for reading only.
25819
25820 @item O_WRONLY
25821 The file is opened for writing only.
25822
25823 @item O_RDWR
25824 The file is opened for reading and writing.
25825 @end table
25826
25827 @noindent
25828 Other bits are silently ignored.
25829
25830
25831 @noindent
25832 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25833
25834 @table @code
25835 @item S_IRUSR
25836 User has read permission.
25837
25838 @item S_IWUSR
25839 User has write permission.
25840
25841 @item S_IRGRP
25842 Group has read permission.
25843
25844 @item S_IWGRP
25845 Group has write permission.
25846
25847 @item S_IROTH
25848 Others have read permission.
25849
25850 @item S_IWOTH
25851 Others have write permission.
25852 @end table
25853
25854 @noindent
25855 Other bits are silently ignored.
25856
25857
25858 @item Return value:
25859 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
25860 occurred.
25861
25862 @item Errors:
25863
25864 @table @code
25865 @item EEXIST
25866 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
25867
25868 @item EISDIR
25869 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
25870
25871 @item EACCES
25872 The requested access is not allowed.
25873
25874 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25875 @var{pathname} was too long.
25876
25877 @item ENOENT
25878 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25879
25880 @item ENODEV
25881 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
25882
25883 @item EROFS
25884 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
25885 write access was requested.
25886
25887 @item EFAULT
25888 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
25889
25890 @item ENOSPC
25891 No space on device to create the file.
25892
25893 @item EMFILE
25894 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
25895
25896 @item ENFILE
25897 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
25898 has been reached.
25899
25900 @item EINTR
25901 The call was interrupted by the user.
25902 @end table
25903
25904 @end table
25905
25906 @node close
25907 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
25908 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
25909
25910 @table @asis
25911 @item Synopsis:
25912 @smallexample
25913 int close(int fd);
25914 @end smallexample
25915
25916 @item Request:
25917 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
25918
25919 @item Return value:
25920 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
25921
25922 @item Errors:
25923
25924 @table @code
25925 @item EBADF
25926 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
25927
25928 @item EINTR
25929 The call was interrupted by the user.
25930 @end table
25931
25932 @end table
25933
25934 @node read
25935 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
25936 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
25937
25938 @table @asis
25939 @item Synopsis:
25940 @smallexample
25941 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
25942 @end smallexample
25943
25944 @item Request:
25945 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25946
25947 @item Return value:
25948 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
25949 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
25950 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
25951
25952 @item Errors:
25953
25954 @table @code
25955 @item EBADF
25956 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25957 reading.
25958
25959 @item EFAULT
25960 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25961
25962 @item EINTR
25963 The call was interrupted by the user.
25964 @end table
25965
25966 @end table
25967
25968 @node write
25969 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
25970 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
25971
25972 @table @asis
25973 @item Synopsis:
25974 @smallexample
25975 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
25976 @end smallexample
25977
25978 @item Request:
25979 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25980
25981 @item Return value:
25982 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
25983 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
25984 is returned.
25985
25986 @item Errors:
25987
25988 @table @code
25989 @item EBADF
25990 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25991 writing.
25992
25993 @item EFAULT
25994 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25995
25996 @item EFBIG
25997 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25998 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
25999
26000 @item ENOSPC
26001 No space on device to write the data.
26002
26003 @item EINTR
26004 The call was interrupted by the user.
26005 @end table
26006
26007 @end table
26008
26009 @node lseek
26010 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
26011 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
26012
26013 @table @asis
26014 @item Synopsis:
26015 @smallexample
26016 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
26017 @end smallexample
26018
26019 @item Request:
26020 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
26021
26022 @var{flag} is one of:
26023
26024 @table @code
26025 @item SEEK_SET
26026 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
26027
26028 @item SEEK_CUR
26029 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
26030 bytes.
26031
26032 @item SEEK_END
26033 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
26034 bytes.
26035 @end table
26036
26037 @item Return value:
26038 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
26039 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
26040 value of -1 is returned.
26041
26042 @item Errors:
26043
26044 @table @code
26045 @item EBADF
26046 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
26047
26048 @item ESPIPE
26049 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
26050
26051 @item EINVAL
26052 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
26053
26054 @item EINTR
26055 The call was interrupted by the user.
26056 @end table
26057
26058 @end table
26059
26060 @node rename
26061 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
26062 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
26063
26064 @table @asis
26065 @item Synopsis:
26066 @smallexample
26067 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
26068 @end smallexample
26069
26070 @item Request:
26071 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
26072
26073 @item Return value:
26074 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26075
26076 @item Errors:
26077
26078 @table @code
26079 @item EISDIR
26080 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
26081 directory.
26082
26083 @item EEXIST
26084 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
26085
26086 @item EBUSY
26087 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
26088 process.
26089
26090 @item EINVAL
26091 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
26092 of itself.
26093
26094 @item ENOTDIR
26095 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
26096 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
26097 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
26098
26099 @item EFAULT
26100 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
26101
26102 @item EACCES
26103 No access to the file or the path of the file.
26104
26105 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26106
26107 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
26108
26109 @item ENOENT
26110 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
26111
26112 @item EROFS
26113 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
26114
26115 @item ENOSPC
26116 The device containing the file has no room for the new
26117 directory entry.
26118
26119 @item EINTR
26120 The call was interrupted by the user.
26121 @end table
26122
26123 @end table
26124
26125 @node unlink
26126 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
26127 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
26128
26129 @table @asis
26130 @item Synopsis:
26131 @smallexample
26132 int unlink(const char *pathname);
26133 @end smallexample
26134
26135 @item Request:
26136 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
26137
26138 @item Return value:
26139 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26140
26141 @item Errors:
26142
26143 @table @code
26144 @item EACCES
26145 No access to the file or the path of the file.
26146
26147 @item EPERM
26148 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
26149
26150 @item EBUSY
26151 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
26152 being used by another process.
26153
26154 @item EFAULT
26155 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26156
26157 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26158 @var{pathname} was too long.
26159
26160 @item ENOENT
26161 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
26162
26163 @item ENOTDIR
26164 A component of the path is not a directory.
26165
26166 @item EROFS
26167 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
26168
26169 @item EINTR
26170 The call was interrupted by the user.
26171 @end table
26172
26173 @end table
26174
26175 @node stat/fstat
26176 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
26177 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
26178 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
26179
26180 @table @asis
26181 @item Synopsis:
26182 @smallexample
26183 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
26184 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
26185 @end smallexample
26186
26187 @item Request:
26188 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
26189 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
26190
26191 @item Return value:
26192 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26193
26194 @item Errors:
26195
26196 @table @code
26197 @item EBADF
26198 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
26199
26200 @item ENOENT
26201 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
26202 path is an empty string.
26203
26204 @item ENOTDIR
26205 A component of the path is not a directory.
26206
26207 @item EFAULT
26208 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26209
26210 @item EACCES
26211 No access to the file or the path of the file.
26212
26213 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26214 @var{pathname} was too long.
26215
26216 @item EINTR
26217 The call was interrupted by the user.
26218 @end table
26219
26220 @end table
26221
26222 @node gettimeofday
26223 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
26224 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
26225
26226 @table @asis
26227 @item Synopsis:
26228 @smallexample
26229 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
26230 @end smallexample
26231
26232 @item Request:
26233 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
26234
26235 @item Return value:
26236 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
26237
26238 @item Errors:
26239
26240 @table @code
26241 @item EINVAL
26242 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
26243
26244 @item EFAULT
26245 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26246 @end table
26247
26248 @end table
26249
26250 @node isatty
26251 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
26252 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
26253
26254 @table @asis
26255 @item Synopsis:
26256 @smallexample
26257 int isatty(int fd);
26258 @end smallexample
26259
26260 @item Request:
26261 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
26262
26263 @item Return value:
26264 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
26265
26266 @item Errors:
26267
26268 @table @code
26269 @item EINTR
26270 The call was interrupted by the user.
26271 @end table
26272
26273 @end table
26274
26275 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
26276 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
26277 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
26278 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
26279 needed.
26280
26281
26282 @node system
26283 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
26284 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
26285
26286 @table @asis
26287 @item Synopsis:
26288 @smallexample
26289 int system(const char *command);
26290 @end smallexample
26291
26292 @item Request:
26293 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
26294
26295 @item Return value:
26296 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
26297 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
26298 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
26299 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
26300 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
26301 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
26302 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
26303
26304 @item Errors:
26305
26306 @table @code
26307 @item EINTR
26308 The call was interrupted by the user.
26309 @end table
26310
26311 @end table
26312
26313 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
26314 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
26315 the host is simplified before it's returned
26316 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
26317 is discarded, and the return value consists
26318 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
26319
26320 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
26321 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
26322 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
26323
26324 @table @code
26325 @item set remote system-call-allowed
26326 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
26327 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
26328 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
26329
26330 @item show remote system-call-allowed
26331 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
26332 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
26333 protocol.
26334 @end table
26335
26336 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26337 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26338 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26339
26340 @menu
26341 * Integral Datatypes::
26342 * Pointer Values::
26343 * Memory Transfer::
26344 * struct stat::
26345 * struct timeval::
26346 @end menu
26347
26348 @node Integral Datatypes
26349 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
26350 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26351
26352 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
26353 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
26354 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
26355
26356 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
26357 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
26358
26359 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
26360
26361 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
26362 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
26363
26364 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
26365
26366 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
26367 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
26368 byte order.
26369
26370 @node Pointer Values
26371 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
26372 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
26373
26374 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
26375 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
26376 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
26377 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
26378
26379 @smallexample
26380 @code{1aaf/12}
26381 @end smallexample
26382
26383 @noindent
26384 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
26385 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
26386 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
26387 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
26388
26389 @smallexample
26390 @code{123456/d}
26391 @end smallexample
26392
26393 @node Memory Transfer
26394 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
26395 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
26396
26397 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
26398 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
26399 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
26400 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
26401 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
26402 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
26403 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
26404
26405
26406 @node struct stat
26407 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
26408 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
26409
26410 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
26411 is defined as follows:
26412
26413 @smallexample
26414 struct stat @{
26415 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
26416 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
26417 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
26418 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
26419 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
26420 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
26421 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
26422 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
26423 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
26424 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
26425 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
26426 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
26427 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
26428 @};
26429 @end smallexample
26430
26431 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26432 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26433 structure is of size 64 bytes.
26434
26435 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
26436 range of values.
26437
26438 @table @code
26439
26440 @item st_dev
26441 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
26442
26443 @item st_ino
26444 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26445
26446 @item st_mode
26447 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
26448 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
26449
26450 @item st_uid
26451 @itemx st_gid
26452 @itemx st_rdev
26453 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26454
26455 @item st_atime
26456 @itemx st_mtime
26457 @itemx st_ctime
26458 These values have a host and file system dependent
26459 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
26460 support exact timing values.
26461 @end table
26462
26463 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
26464 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
26465 continuing.
26466
26467 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
26468 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
26469 get truncated on the target.
26470
26471 @node struct timeval
26472 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
26473 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
26474
26475 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
26476 is defined as follows:
26477
26478 @smallexample
26479 struct timeval @{
26480 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
26481 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
26482 @};
26483 @end smallexample
26484
26485 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26486 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26487 structure is of size 8 bytes.
26488
26489 @node Constants
26490 @subsection Constants
26491 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
26492
26493 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
26494 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
26495 values before and after the call as needed.
26496
26497 @menu
26498 * Open Flags::
26499 * mode_t Values::
26500 * Errno Values::
26501 * Lseek Flags::
26502 * Limits::
26503 @end menu
26504
26505 @node Open Flags
26506 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
26507 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
26508
26509 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
26510
26511 @smallexample
26512 O_RDONLY 0x0
26513 O_WRONLY 0x1
26514 O_RDWR 0x2
26515 O_APPEND 0x8
26516 O_CREAT 0x200
26517 O_TRUNC 0x400
26518 O_EXCL 0x800
26519 @end smallexample
26520
26521 @node mode_t Values
26522 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
26523 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
26524
26525 All values are given in octal representation.
26526
26527 @smallexample
26528 S_IFREG 0100000
26529 S_IFDIR 040000
26530 S_IRUSR 0400
26531 S_IWUSR 0200
26532 S_IXUSR 0100
26533 S_IRGRP 040
26534 S_IWGRP 020
26535 S_IXGRP 010
26536 S_IROTH 04
26537 S_IWOTH 02
26538 S_IXOTH 01
26539 @end smallexample
26540
26541 @node Errno Values
26542 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
26543 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
26544
26545 All values are given in decimal representation.
26546
26547 @smallexample
26548 EPERM 1
26549 ENOENT 2
26550 EINTR 4
26551 EBADF 9
26552 EACCES 13
26553 EFAULT 14
26554 EBUSY 16
26555 EEXIST 17
26556 ENODEV 19
26557 ENOTDIR 20
26558 EISDIR 21
26559 EINVAL 22
26560 ENFILE 23
26561 EMFILE 24
26562 EFBIG 27
26563 ENOSPC 28
26564 ESPIPE 29
26565 EROFS 30
26566 ENAMETOOLONG 91
26567 EUNKNOWN 9999
26568 @end smallexample
26569
26570 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
26571 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
26572
26573 @node Lseek Flags
26574 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
26575 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
26576
26577 @smallexample
26578 SEEK_SET 0
26579 SEEK_CUR 1
26580 SEEK_END 2
26581 @end smallexample
26582
26583 @node Limits
26584 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
26585 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
26586
26587 All values are given in decimal representation.
26588
26589 @smallexample
26590 INT_MIN -2147483648
26591 INT_MAX 2147483647
26592 UINT_MAX 4294967295
26593 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
26594 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
26595 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
26596 @end smallexample
26597
26598 @node File-I/O Examples
26599 @subsection File-I/O Examples
26600 @cindex file-i/o examples
26601
26602 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26603 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
26604
26605 @smallexample
26606 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
26607 @emph{request memory read from target}
26608 -> @code{m1234,6}
26609 <- XXXXXX
26610 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
26611 -> @code{F6}
26612 @end smallexample
26613
26614 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26615 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
26616
26617 @smallexample
26618 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26619 @emph{request memory write to target}
26620 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26621 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
26622 -> @code{F6}
26623 @end smallexample
26624
26625 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
26626 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
26627
26628 @smallexample
26629 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26630 -> @code{F-1,9}
26631 @end smallexample
26632
26633 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
26634 host is called:
26635
26636 @smallexample
26637 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26638 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
26639 <- @code{T02}
26640 @end smallexample
26641
26642 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
26643 host is called:
26644
26645 @smallexample
26646 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26647 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26648 <- @code{T02}
26649 @end smallexample
26650
26651 @node Library List Format
26652 @section Library List Format
26653 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
26654
26655 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
26656 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
26657 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
26658 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
26659 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
26660 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
26661 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26662 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
26663 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
26664 are loaded.
26665
26666 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
26667 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
26668 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
26669 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
26670
26671 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
26672 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
26673 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
26674 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
26675 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
26676 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
26677
26678 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26679 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
26680
26681 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
26682 offset, looks like this:
26683
26684 @smallexample
26685 <library-list>
26686 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
26687 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
26688 </library>
26689 </library-list>
26690 @end smallexample
26691
26692 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
26693 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
26694
26695 @smallexample
26696 <library-list>
26697 <library name="sharedlib.o">
26698 <section address="0x10000000"/>
26699 <section address="0x20000000"/>
26700 <section address="0x30000000"/>
26701 </library>
26702 </library-list>
26703 @end smallexample
26704
26705 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
26706
26707 @smallexample
26708 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
26709 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
26710 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
26711 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
26712 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26713 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
26714 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26715 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
26716 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26717 @end smallexample
26718
26719 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
26720 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
26721 section for each library.
26722
26723 @node Memory Map Format
26724 @section Memory Map Format
26725 @cindex memory map format
26726
26727 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
26728 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
26729 memory map.
26730
26731 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26732 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
26733 lists memory regions.
26734
26735 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26736 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
26737
26738 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
26739
26740 @smallexample
26741 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26742 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
26743 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
26744 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
26745 <memory-map>
26746 region...
26747 </memory-map>
26748 @end smallexample
26749
26750 Each region can be either:
26751
26752 @itemize
26753
26754 @item
26755 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
26756 bytes from there:
26757
26758 @smallexample
26759 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26760 @end smallexample
26761
26762
26763 @item
26764 A region of read-only memory:
26765
26766 @smallexample
26767 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26768 @end smallexample
26769
26770
26771 @item
26772 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
26773 bytes in length:
26774
26775 @smallexample
26776 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
26777 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
26778 </memory>
26779 @end smallexample
26780
26781 @end itemize
26782
26783 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
26784 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
26785 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
26786
26787 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
26788
26789 @smallexample
26790 <!-- ................................................... -->
26791 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
26792 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
26793 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
26794 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
26795 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
26796 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
26797 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
26798 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
26799 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
26800 and its type, or device. -->
26801 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
26802 start CDATA #REQUIRED
26803 length CDATA #REQUIRED
26804 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
26805 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
26806 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
26807 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26808 @end smallexample
26809
26810 @include agentexpr.texi
26811
26812 @node Target Descriptions
26813 @appendix Target Descriptions
26814 @cindex target descriptions
26815
26816 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
26817 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
26818 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
26819
26820 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
26821 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
26822 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
26823 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
26824 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
26825 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
26826 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
26827
26828 @itemize @bullet
26829 @item
26830 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
26831 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
26832 @item
26833 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
26834 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
26835 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
26836 @item
26837 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
26838 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
26839 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
26840 @end itemize
26841
26842 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
26843 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
26844 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
26845 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
26846 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
26847
26848 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26849 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
26850
26851 @menu
26852 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
26853 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
26854 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
26855 descriptions.
26856 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
26857 @end menu
26858
26859 @node Retrieving Descriptions
26860 @section Retrieving Descriptions
26861
26862 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
26863 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
26864 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
26865 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
26866 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
26867 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
26868 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
26869 Format}.
26870
26871 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
26872 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
26873 specify a file are:
26874
26875 @table @code
26876 @cindex set tdesc filename
26877 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
26878 Read the target description from @var{path}.
26879
26880 @cindex unset tdesc filename
26881 @item unset tdesc filename
26882 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
26883 will use the description supplied by the current target.
26884
26885 @cindex show tdesc filename
26886 @item show tdesc filename
26887 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
26888 @end table
26889
26890
26891 @node Target Description Format
26892 @section Target Description Format
26893 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
26894
26895 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
26896 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
26897 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
26898 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
26899 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
26900 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
26901 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
26902
26903 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
26904 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
26905 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
26906 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
26907
26908 Here is a simple target description:
26909
26910 @smallexample
26911 <target version="1.0">
26912 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
26913 </target>
26914 @end smallexample
26915
26916 @noindent
26917 This minimal description only says that the target uses
26918 the x86-64 architecture.
26919
26920 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
26921 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
26922 are explained further below.
26923
26924 @smallexample
26925 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26926 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
26927 <target version="1.0">
26928 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
26929 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
26930 </target>
26931 @end smallexample
26932
26933 @noindent
26934 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
26935 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
26936 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
26937 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
26938 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
26939 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
26940 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
26941 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
26942 the version mismatch.
26943
26944 @subsection Inclusion
26945 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
26946 @cindex XInclude
26947 @ifnotinfo
26948 @cindex <xi:include>
26949 @end ifnotinfo
26950
26951 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
26952 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
26953 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
26954 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
26955 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
26956
26957 @smallexample
26958 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
26959 @end smallexample
26960
26961 @noindent
26962 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
26963 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
26964 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
26965 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
26966 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
26967 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
26968 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
26969 original description.
26970
26971 @subsection Architecture
26972 @cindex <architecture>
26973
26974 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
26975
26976 @smallexample
26977 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
26978 @end smallexample
26979
26980 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
26981 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
26982 Debugging Target}).
26983
26984 @subsection Features
26985 @cindex <feature>
26986
26987 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
26988 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
26989 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
26990 has this form:
26991
26992 @smallexample
26993 <feature name="@var{name}">
26994 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
26995 @var{reg}@dots{}
26996 </feature>
26997 @end smallexample
26998
26999 @noindent
27000 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
27001 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
27002 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
27003 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
27004
27005 @subsection Types
27006
27007 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
27008 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
27009 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
27010 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
27011 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
27012
27013 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
27014 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
27015 Types must be defined before they are used.
27016
27017 @cindex <vector>
27018 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
27019 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
27020 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
27021 @var{count}:
27022
27023 @smallexample
27024 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
27025 @end smallexample
27026
27027 @cindex <union>
27028 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
27029 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
27030 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
27031 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
27032
27033 @smallexample
27034 <union id="@var{id}">
27035 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
27036 @dots{}
27037 </union>
27038 @end smallexample
27039
27040 @subsection Registers
27041 @cindex <reg>
27042
27043 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
27044
27045 @smallexample
27046 <reg name="@var{name}"
27047 bitsize="@var{size}"
27048 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
27049 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
27050 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
27051 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
27052 @end smallexample
27053
27054 @noindent
27055 The components are as follows:
27056
27057 @table @var
27058
27059 @item name
27060 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
27061
27062 @item bitsize
27063 The register's size, in bits.
27064
27065 @item regnum
27066 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
27067 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
27068 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
27069 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
27070 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
27071 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
27072 in order of increasing register number.
27073
27074 @item save-restore
27075 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
27076 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
27077 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
27078 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
27079 ABI.
27080
27081 @item type
27082 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
27083 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
27084 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
27085 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
27086 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
27087 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
27088
27089 @item group
27090 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
27091 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
27092 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
27093 in @code{info registers}.
27094
27095 @end table
27096
27097 @node Predefined Target Types
27098 @section Predefined Target Types
27099 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
27100
27101 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
27102 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
27103 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
27104 types. The currently supported types are:
27105
27106 @table @code
27107
27108 @item int8
27109 @itemx int16
27110 @itemx int32
27111 @itemx int64
27112 @itemx int128
27113 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
27114
27115 @item uint8
27116 @itemx uint16
27117 @itemx uint32
27118 @itemx uint64
27119 @itemx uint128
27120 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
27121
27122 @item code_ptr
27123 @itemx data_ptr
27124 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
27125 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
27126 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
27127 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
27128 may be marked as data pointers.
27129
27130 @item ieee_single
27131 Single precision IEEE floating point.
27132
27133 @item ieee_double
27134 Double precision IEEE floating point.
27135
27136 @item arm_fpa_ext
27137 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
27138
27139 @end table
27140
27141 @node Standard Target Features
27142 @section Standard Target Features
27143 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
27144
27145 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
27146 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
27147 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
27148 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
27149 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
27150 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
27151 can recognize them.
27152
27153 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
27154 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
27155 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
27156 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
27157 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
27158 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
27159 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
27160 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
27161
27162 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
27163 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
27164 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
27165
27166 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
27167 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
27168 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
27169 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
27170
27171 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
27172 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
27173 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
27174
27175 @menu
27176 * ARM Features::
27177 * MIPS Features::
27178 * M68K Features::
27179 * PowerPC Features::
27180 @end menu
27181
27182
27183 @node ARM Features
27184 @subsection ARM Features
27185 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
27186
27187 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
27188 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
27189 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
27190
27191 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
27192 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
27193
27194 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
27195 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
27196 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
27197 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
27198
27199 @node MIPS Features
27200 @subsection MIPS Features
27201 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
27202
27203 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
27204 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
27205 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
27206 on the target.
27207
27208 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
27209 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
27210 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27211
27212 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
27213 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
27214 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
27215 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27216
27217 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
27218 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
27219 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
27220
27221 @node M68K Features
27222 @subsection M68K Features
27223 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
27224
27225 @table @code
27226 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
27227 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
27228 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
27229 One of those features must be always present.
27230 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
27231 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
27232 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
27233 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
27234
27235 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
27236 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
27237 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
27238 @samp{fpiaddr}.
27239 @end table
27240
27241 @node PowerPC Features
27242 @subsection PowerPC Features
27243 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
27244
27245 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
27246 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
27247 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
27248 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27249
27250 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
27251 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
27252
27253 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
27254 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
27255 and @samp{vrsave}.
27256
27257 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
27258 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
27259 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
27260 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
27261 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
27262 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
27263 user.
27264
27265 @include gpl.texi
27266
27267 @raisesections
27268 @include fdl.texi
27269 @lowersections
27270
27271 @node Index
27272 @unnumbered Index
27273
27274 @printindex cp
27275
27276 @tex
27277 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
27278 % meantime:
27279 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
27280 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
27281 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
27282 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
27283 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
27284 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
27285 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
27286 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
27287 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
27288 \page\colophon
27289 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
27290 @end tex
27291
27292 @bye
This page took 0.648757 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.